1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.96"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
54 .set drivernamemax "64"
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
61 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
62 . provided in the xfpt library.
63 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
65 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
67 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
69 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
70 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
72 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
73 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
75 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
76 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
77 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
87 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
88 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
92 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
93 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
94 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
96 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
97 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
101 . --- A macro for a plain variable, including the .vitem and .vindex
107 . --- A macro for a "tainted" marker, done as a one-element table
109 .itable none 0 0 1 10pt left
114 . --- A macro for a tainted variable, adding a taint-marker
120 . --- A macro for a cmdline option, including a .oindex
121 . --- 1st arg is the option name, undecorated (we do that here).
122 . --- 2nd arg, optional, text (decorated as needed) to be appended to the name
124 .vitem &%$1%&$=2+&~$2+
128 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
129 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
130 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
134 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
138 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
146 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
147 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
148 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
149 . --- ID that ties them together.
150 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
151 . --- head, or list-item.
154 &<indexterm role="concept">&
155 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
157 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
163 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
164 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
166 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
172 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
176 &<indexterm role="option">&
177 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
179 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
184 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
185 . --- head, or varlist item.
188 &<indexterm role="variable">&
189 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
191 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
197 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
201 . use this for a concept-index entry for a header line
203 .cindex "&'$1'& header line"
204 .cindex "header lines" $1
206 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
209 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
210 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
212 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
216 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
217 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
221 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
222 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
223 <revhistory><revision>
225 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
226 </revision></revhistory>
229 </year><holder>The Exim Maintainers</holder></copyright>
234 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
235 . These implement index entries of the form "x, see y" and "x, see also y".
236 . However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
237 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
238 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
240 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
244 <indexterm role="$2">
245 <primary>$3</primary>
247 <secondary>$5</secondary>
249 <$1><emphasis>$4</emphasis></$1>
254 . NB: for the 4-arg variant the ordering is awkward
256 .seeother see "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
259 .seeother seealso "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
262 .see variable "<emphasis>$1</emphasis>, <emphasis>$2</emphasis>, etc." "numerical variables"
263 .see concept address rewriting rewriting
264 .see concept "Bounce Address Tag Validation" BATV
265 .see concept "Client SMTP Authorization" CSA
266 .see concept "CR character" "carriage return"
267 .see concept CRL "certificate revocation list"
268 .seealso concept de-tainting "tainted data"
269 .see concept delivery "bounce message" "failure report"
270 .see concept dialup "intermittently connected hosts"
271 .see concept exiscan "content scanning"
272 .see concept fallover fallback
273 .see concept filter "Sieve filter" Sieve
274 .see concept headers "header lines"
275 .see concept ident "RFC 1413"
276 .see concept "LF character" "linefeed"
277 .seealso concept maximum limit
278 .see concept monitor "Exim monitor"
279 .see concept "no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis>" "entry for xxx"
280 .see concept NUL "binary zero"
281 .see concept "passwd file" "/etc/passwd"
282 .see concept "process id" pid
283 .see concept RBL "DNS list"
284 .see concept redirection "address redirection"
285 .see concept "return path" "envelope sender"
286 .see concept scanning "content scanning"
288 .see concept string expansion expansion
289 .see concept "top bit" "8-bit characters"
290 .see concept variables "expansion, variables"
291 .see concept "zero, binary" "binary zero"
294 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
295 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
296 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
297 . chapter "Introduction"
298 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
300 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
301 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
302 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
303 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
305 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
306 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
307 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
308 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
309 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
310 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
311 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
313 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
314 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
315 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
317 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
318 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
319 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
321 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
322 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
323 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
324 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
325 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
327 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
328 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
329 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
330 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
331 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
333 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
334 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
335 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
336 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
340 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
341 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
344 .cindex "documentation"
345 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
346 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
347 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
348 capable of showing a change indicator.
351 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
352 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
353 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
354 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
355 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
356 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
357 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
360 .cindex "books about Exim"
361 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
362 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
363 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
364 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
366 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
367 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
368 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
369 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
371 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
372 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
373 Debian-specific features in the file
374 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
375 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
378 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
379 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
381 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
382 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
383 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
384 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
385 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
387 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
388 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
389 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
390 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
392 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
393 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
395 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
396 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
397 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
401 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
402 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
403 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
404 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
405 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
406 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
407 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
408 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
411 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
412 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
413 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
417 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
420 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
421 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
422 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
426 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
427 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
428 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
429 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
430 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
431 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
432 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
435 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
436 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
437 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
438 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
441 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
442 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
443 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
446 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
447 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
448 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
449 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
452 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
453 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
454 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
455 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
456 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
459 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
461 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
464 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
465 .cindex "bug reports"
466 .cindex "reporting bugs"
467 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
468 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
469 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
470 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
474 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
476 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
477 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
478 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
479 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
481 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
483 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
484 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
486 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
487 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
488 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
490 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
491 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
492 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
493 here are top-level directories.
495 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
496 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
498 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
499 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
500 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
501 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
505 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
507 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
508 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
509 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
510 most portable to old systems.
512 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
513 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
514 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
515 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
516 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
517 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
518 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
519 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
520 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
521 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
522 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
524 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
525 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
526 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
527 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
529 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
531 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
535 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
536 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
537 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
539 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
540 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
541 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
542 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
544 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
545 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
546 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
547 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
549 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
550 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
553 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
555 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
556 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
557 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
558 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
559 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
560 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
561 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
563 .cindex "domainless addresses"
564 .cindex "address" "without domain"
565 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
566 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
567 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
568 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
571 .cindex "transport" "external"
572 .cindex "external transports"
573 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
574 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
575 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
576 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
577 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
578 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
580 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
581 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
582 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
585 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
586 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
587 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
588 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
589 a number of common scanners are provided.
593 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
594 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
595 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
596 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
597 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
598 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
601 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
602 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
603 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
604 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
605 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
606 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
607 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
608 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
609 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
610 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
611 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
612 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
614 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
615 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
616 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
617 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
621 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
622 .cindex "terminology definitions"
623 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
624 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
625 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
626 below) by a blank line.
628 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
629 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
630 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
631 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
632 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
633 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
634 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
635 rise to further bounce messages.
637 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
638 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
639 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
642 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
643 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
644 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
647 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
648 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
649 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
651 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
652 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
653 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
654 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
655 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
656 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
657 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
658 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
660 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
661 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
662 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
663 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
664 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
665 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
668 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
669 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
670 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
671 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
672 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
674 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
675 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
676 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
677 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
678 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
679 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
681 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
682 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
685 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
686 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
687 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
688 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
689 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
691 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
692 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
693 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
694 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
695 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
697 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
698 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
699 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
700 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
701 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
702 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
709 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
710 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
712 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
713 .cindex "incorporated code"
714 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
717 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
720 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
721 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE2 library, copyright
722 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE2 is not longer shipped with
723 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE2 shipped with your system,
724 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
725 &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
727 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
728 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
729 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
730 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
731 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
732 following statements:
735 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
737 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
738 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
739 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
741 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
742 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
743 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
744 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
745 restrictions applied to it).
748 .cindex "SPA authentication"
749 .cindex "Samba project"
750 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
751 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
752 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
753 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
757 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
758 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
759 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
760 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
761 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
762 conditions expressed therein.
765 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
767 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
768 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
772 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
773 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
775 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
776 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
777 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
780 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
781 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
782 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
783 details, please contact
785 Office of Technology Transfer
786 Carnegie Mellon University
788 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
789 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
790 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
793 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
796 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
797 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
799 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
800 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
801 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
802 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
803 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
804 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
805 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
810 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
813 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
814 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
815 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
816 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
819 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
820 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
824 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
825 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
826 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
827 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
828 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
829 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
830 software without specific, written prior permission.
832 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
833 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
834 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
835 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
836 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
837 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
842 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
843 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
844 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
845 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
846 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
850 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
851 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
852 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
862 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
863 "Receiving and delivering mail"
866 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
867 .cindex "design philosophy"
868 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
869 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
870 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
871 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
872 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
873 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
876 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
877 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
878 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
879 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
880 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
881 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
882 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
885 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
886 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
887 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
888 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
889 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
890 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
891 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
892 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
893 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
896 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
897 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
899 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
900 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
901 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
902 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
904 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
905 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
906 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
907 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
908 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
910 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
911 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
912 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
914 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
915 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
916 runs at the start of every delivery process.
921 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
922 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
923 .cindex "Sieve filter"
924 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
925 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
926 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
927 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
928 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
929 of filtering are available:
932 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
935 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
936 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
939 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
943 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
944 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
945 .cindex "format" "of message id"
946 .cindex "id of message"
951 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
952 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
953 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
954 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
955 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
956 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
957 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
958 not always case-sensitive.
960 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
961 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
962 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
963 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
964 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
965 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
969 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
970 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
971 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
972 way of representing the date and time of day).
974 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
975 received the message.
977 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
979 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
980 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
981 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
982 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
983 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
985 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
986 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
991 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
992 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
993 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
994 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
995 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
998 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
999 .cindex "receiving mail"
1000 .cindex "message" "reception"
1001 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1002 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1003 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1004 there are several possibilities:
1007 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1008 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1009 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1011 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1012 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1013 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1014 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1015 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1016 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1018 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1019 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1020 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1021 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1022 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1024 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1025 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1026 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1027 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1031 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1032 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1033 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1034 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1035 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1036 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1037 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1038 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1039 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1040 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1041 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1042 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1043 users to change sender addresses.
1045 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1046 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1047 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1048 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1049 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1050 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1051 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1053 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1054 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1055 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1056 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1057 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1058 message is received.
1064 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1065 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1066 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1067 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1068 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1069 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1070 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1071 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1073 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1074 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1075 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1076 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1077 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1078 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1079 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1080 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1081 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1082 affect file system performance.
1084 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1085 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1086 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1087 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1088 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1090 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1091 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1092 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1093 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1094 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1095 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1096 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1097 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1098 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1099 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1100 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1101 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1105 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1106 .cindex "message" "life of"
1107 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1108 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1109 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1110 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1111 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1112 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1113 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1115 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1116 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1117 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1118 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1119 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1122 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1123 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1124 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1125 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1126 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1128 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1129 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1130 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1131 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1132 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1133 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1134 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1135 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1136 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1137 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1140 .cindex "journal file"
1141 .cindex "file" "journal"
1142 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1143 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1144 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1145 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1146 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1147 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1148 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1149 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1151 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1152 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1153 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1154 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1155 deliveries caused by crashes.
1159 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1160 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1161 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1162 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1163 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1164 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1165 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1166 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1167 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1169 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1170 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1171 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1172 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1173 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1174 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1175 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1176 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1177 the driver's features in general.
1179 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1180 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1181 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1182 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1185 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1186 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1187 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1188 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1189 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1190 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1192 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1193 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1194 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1195 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1196 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1197 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1199 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1200 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1201 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1204 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1205 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1206 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1207 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1208 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1209 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1210 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1211 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1212 configured to fail the address.
1214 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1215 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1216 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1217 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1218 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1219 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1221 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1222 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1223 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1224 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1225 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1226 the address is bounced.
1230 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1231 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1232 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1233 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1234 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1235 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1236 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1237 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1239 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1240 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1241 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1242 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1243 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1244 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1245 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1246 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1251 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1252 .cindex "router" "running details"
1253 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1254 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1255 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1256 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1257 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1258 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1262 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1263 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1264 original address ceases
1265 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1266 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1267 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1268 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1269 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1272 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1273 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1274 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1275 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1276 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1278 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1279 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1280 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1281 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1282 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1284 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1285 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1286 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1287 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1288 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1290 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1291 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1292 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1294 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1295 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1296 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1297 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1299 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1300 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1303 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1304 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1305 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1306 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1307 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1309 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1310 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1311 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1312 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1313 facility for this purpose.
1316 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1317 .cindex "case of local parts"
1318 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1319 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1320 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1321 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1322 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1323 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1324 routed addresses are shown.
1328 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1329 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1330 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1331 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1332 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1333 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1336 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1337 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1338 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1339 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1340 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1341 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1342 of any other conditions.
1344 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1345 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1346 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1348 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1349 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1350 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1351 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1352 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1354 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1355 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1356 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1357 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1358 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1360 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1361 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1362 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1364 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1365 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1368 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1369 of domains that it defines.
1370 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
1371 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
1372 A match verifies the variable &$domain$& (which carries tainted data)
1373 and assigns an untainted value to the &$domain_data$& variable.
1374 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1375 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1376 refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&.
1378 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1379 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1382 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1383 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1384 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1385 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1386 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1387 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1388 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1389 the set of local parts that it defines.
1390 A match verifies the variable &$local_part$& (which carries tainted data)
1391 and assigns an untainted value to the &$local_part_data$& variable.
1392 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1393 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1394 refer to section &<<SECTlocparlis>>&.
1396 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1397 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1399 If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1400 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1401 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1402 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1403 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1404 &$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1405 and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1408 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1409 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1411 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1412 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1413 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1414 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1415 remaining preconditions.
1418 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1419 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1420 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1421 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1422 could lead to confusion.
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1429 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430 specified files is tested.
1433 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1434 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1435 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1436 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1438 Note that while using
1439 this option for address matching technically works,
1440 it does not set any de-tainted values.
1441 Such values are often needed, either for router-specific options or
1442 for transport options.
1443 Using the &%domains%& and &%local_parts%& options is usually the most
1444 convenient way to obtain them.
1448 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1449 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1450 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1451 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1452 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1453 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1454 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1458 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1459 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1460 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1463 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1464 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1465 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1466 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1467 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1469 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1470 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1472 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1473 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1474 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1475 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1476 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1477 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1480 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1481 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1482 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1483 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1484 processed entirely independently of each other.
1486 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1487 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1488 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1489 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1490 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1491 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1492 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1493 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1494 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1496 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1497 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1498 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1499 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1500 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1501 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1502 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1503 addresses to the same domain.
1505 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1506 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1507 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1508 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1509 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1510 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1511 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1512 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1514 .cindex "queue runner"
1515 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1516 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1517 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1518 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1519 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1520 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1521 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1522 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1523 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1525 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1526 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1527 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1528 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1529 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1530 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1532 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1533 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1534 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1535 messages to other addresses.
1537 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1538 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1539 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1542 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1543 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1544 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1550 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1551 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1552 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1553 .cindex "queue runner"
1554 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1555 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1556 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1557 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1558 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1559 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1560 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1561 passed its retry time.
1562 You can run several queue runners at once.
1564 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1565 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1566 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1567 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1568 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1573 .subsection "Temporary delivery failure" SECID20
1574 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1575 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1576 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1577 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1578 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1579 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1580 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1581 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1584 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1585 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1586 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1588 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1589 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1590 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1591 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1592 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1597 .subsection "Permanent delivery failure" SECID21
1598 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1599 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1600 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1601 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1602 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1603 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1604 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1605 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1606 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1607 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1609 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1610 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1611 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1614 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1615 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1616 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1617 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1618 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1619 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1620 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1625 .subsection "Failures to deliver bounce messages" SECID22
1626 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1627 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1628 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1629 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1630 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1631 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1632 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1639 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1641 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1642 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1644 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1645 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1646 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1647 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1650 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1651 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1653 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1654 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1655 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1656 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1660 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1661 following subdirectories are created:
1664 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1665 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1666 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1667 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1668 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1669 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1670 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1673 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1674 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1675 that may be useful to some sites.
1678 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1679 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1680 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1681 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1682 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1683 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1685 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1686 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1687 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1688 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1689 overridden if necessary.
1690 .cindex compiler requirements
1691 .cindex compiler version
1692 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1695 .section "PCRE2 library" "SECTpcre"
1696 .cindex "PCRE2 library"
1697 Exim no longer has an embedded regular-expression library as the vast majority of
1698 modern systems include PCRE2 as a system library, although you may need to
1699 install the PCRE2 package or the PCRE2 development package for your operating
1700 system. If your system has a normal PCRE2 installation the Exim build
1701 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1702 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE2_LIBS
1703 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1704 or set PCRE2_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1705 If your operating system has no
1706 PCRE2 support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE2
1707 from &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
1708 More information on PCRE2 is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1710 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1711 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1712 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1713 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1714 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1715 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1716 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1718 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1719 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1720 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1721 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1722 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1723 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1724 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1725 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1727 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1728 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1729 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1730 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1731 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1732 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1733 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1734 Berkeley DB library.
1736 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1737 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1741 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1742 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1744 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1745 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1746 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1747 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1748 filename is used unmodified.
1750 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1751 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1752 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1753 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1755 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1756 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1757 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1759 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1760 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1761 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while,
1762 but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 5.&'x'&.
1763 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased,
1764 and Exim no longer supports versions before 3.&'x'&.
1765 All versions of Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1766 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1767 page with far newer versions listed.
1768 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1769 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1770 suited to Exim's usage model.
1772 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1773 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1774 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1775 operates on a single file.
1779 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1780 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1781 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1782 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1783 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1787 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1788 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1789 You can set USE_NDBM if needed to override an operating system default.
1791 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1792 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1793 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1794 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1795 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1796 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1798 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1799 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1800 in one of these lines:
1804 DBMLIB = -lgdbm -lgdbm_compat
1806 The last of those was for a Linux having GDBM provide emulated NDBM facilities.
1807 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1808 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1809 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1810 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1813 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1814 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1816 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1817 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1821 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1822 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1823 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1824 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1825 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1826 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1827 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1828 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1829 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1830 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1831 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1832 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1834 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1835 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1836 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1837 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1838 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1839 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1841 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1842 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1843 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1844 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1845 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1846 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1849 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1850 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1851 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1852 facilities, you need to set
1854 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1856 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1857 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1860 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1861 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1862 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1863 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1864 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1865 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1866 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1868 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1869 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1870 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1871 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1872 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1877 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1878 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1880 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1881 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1882 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1883 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1884 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1885 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1886 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1888 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1889 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1890 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1891 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1892 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1896 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1900 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1901 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1902 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1903 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1904 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1905 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1906 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1907 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1908 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1911 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1912 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1915 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1921 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1924 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1926 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1927 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1930 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1931 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1933 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1934 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1937 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1939 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1940 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1943 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1945 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1946 library and include files. For example:
1949 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1950 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1952 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1953 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1956 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1959 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1960 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1961 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1966 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1968 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1969 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1970 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1971 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1972 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1973 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1974 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1975 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1976 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1977 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1978 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1979 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1982 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1983 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1984 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1986 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1987 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1989 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1991 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1992 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1993 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1994 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1995 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1996 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
2000 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
2001 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
2002 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
2003 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
2004 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
2005 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
2008 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2009 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2010 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2011 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2012 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2014 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2019 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2020 .cindex "lookup modules"
2021 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2022 .cindex ".so building"
2023 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2024 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2026 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2027 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2029 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2031 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2032 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2033 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2034 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2035 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2036 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2038 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2039 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2040 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2049 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2050 .cindex "build directory"
2051 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2052 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2053 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2054 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2055 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2056 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2057 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2059 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2060 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2061 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2062 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2063 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2064 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2065 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2066 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2068 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2069 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2070 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2074 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2075 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2076 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2077 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2078 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2079 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2080 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2084 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2085 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2086 given in addition to the short output.
2090 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2091 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2092 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2093 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2094 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2095 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2096 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2099 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2100 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2102 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2103 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2104 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2105 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2107 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2108 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2109 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2110 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2111 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2112 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2113 and are often not needed.
2115 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2116 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2117 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2118 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2119 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2120 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2121 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2122 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2123 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2126 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2127 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2128 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2129 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2133 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2134 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2135 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2136 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2137 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2138 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2139 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2140 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2141 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2142 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2143 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2144 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2145 containing the lines
2150 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2151 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2153 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2154 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2155 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2158 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2159 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2160 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2161 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2162 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2163 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2164 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2165 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2166 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2167 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2173 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2174 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2175 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2176 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2177 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2178 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2179 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2180 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2183 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2184 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2185 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2186 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2187 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2188 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2189 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2190 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2191 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2192 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2193 syntax. For instance:
2196 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2198 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2199 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2200 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2203 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2204 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2205 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2209 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2210 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2212 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2213 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2214 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2215 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2216 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2217 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2220 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2221 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2223 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2224 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2227 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2228 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2230 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2231 definition of all three of these variables into your
2232 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2235 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2236 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2237 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2238 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2240 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2241 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2242 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2243 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2244 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2247 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2248 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2249 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2250 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2251 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2254 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2256 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2257 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2258 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2259 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2260 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2261 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2265 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2266 .cindex "building Eximon"
2267 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2268 where the files that are involved are
2270 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2271 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2272 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2273 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2274 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2275 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2277 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2278 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2279 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2280 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2281 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2282 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2283 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2287 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2288 .cindex "installing Exim"
2289 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2290 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2291 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2292 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2293 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2294 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2295 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2296 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2297 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2298 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2299 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2300 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2302 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2303 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2304 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2305 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2306 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2307 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2308 alternative files, no default is installed.
2310 .cindex "system aliases file"
2311 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2312 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2313 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2314 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2315 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2316 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2317 and outputs a comment to the user.
2319 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2320 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2321 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2322 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2323 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2325 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2326 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2327 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2328 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2329 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2332 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2333 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2336 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2338 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2339 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2340 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2341 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2342 but this usage is deprecated.
2344 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2345 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2346 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2347 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2348 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2349 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2351 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2352 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2353 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2354 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2355 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2356 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2357 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2359 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2360 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2361 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2364 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2366 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2367 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2368 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2369 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2372 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2374 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2375 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2378 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2379 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2381 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2385 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2387 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2389 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2390 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2391 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2393 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2398 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2399 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2400 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2401 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2402 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2405 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2406 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2407 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2411 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2412 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2413 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2414 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2415 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2421 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2422 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2423 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2424 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2425 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2429 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2430 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2431 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2432 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2433 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2436 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2438 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2440 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2442 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2443 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2444 user agent. For example:
2446 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2447 From: user@your.domain.example
2448 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2449 Subject: Testing Exim
2451 This is a test message.
2454 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2455 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2456 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2458 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2459 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2460 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2461 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2462 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2463 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2465 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2467 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2468 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2469 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2470 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2471 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2473 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2474 .cindex "lock files"
2475 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2476 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2477 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2478 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2479 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2480 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2481 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2482 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2483 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2484 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2485 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2486 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2488 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2489 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2490 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2491 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2492 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2495 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2496 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2497 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2498 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2502 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2503 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2504 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2505 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2506 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2507 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2508 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2509 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2510 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2511 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2512 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2513 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2514 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2516 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2517 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2518 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2519 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2520 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2521 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2524 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2525 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2526 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2527 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2529 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2530 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2531 favourite user agent.
2533 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2534 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2535 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2536 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2537 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2538 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2542 .section "Running the daemon" SECTdaemonLaunch
2543 The most common command line for launching the Exim daemon looks like
2547 This starts a daemon which
2549 listens for incoming smtp connections, launching handler processes for
2552 starts a queue-runner process every five minutes, to inspect queued messages
2553 and run delivery attempts on any that have arrived at their retry time
2555 Should a queue run take longer than the time between queue-runner starts,
2556 they will run in parallel.
2557 Numbers of jobs of the various types are subject to policy controls
2558 defined in the configuration.
2561 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2562 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2563 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2564 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2565 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2566 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2567 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2568 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2569 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2570 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2576 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2577 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2578 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2580 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2582 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2583 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2584 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2585 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2586 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2588 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2590 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2592 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2593 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2594 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2599 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2600 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2602 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2603 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2604 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2605 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2606 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2607 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2608 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2609 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2610 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2613 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2615 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2616 were present before any other options.
2617 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2619 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2620 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2621 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2624 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2625 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2626 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2630 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2631 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2632 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2635 .cindex "queue runner"
2636 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2637 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2638 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2640 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2641 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2642 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2643 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2644 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2645 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2646 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2647 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2650 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2651 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2652 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2653 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2654 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2655 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2658 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2659 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2660 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2661 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2662 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2663 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2665 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2666 .cindex "envelope from"
2667 .cindex "envelope sender"
2668 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2669 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2670 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2671 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2672 users to set envelope senders.
2676 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2677 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2678 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2680 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2681 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2682 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2683 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2684 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2685 that are available to trusted users.
2687 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2688 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2689 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2690 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2691 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2693 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2694 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2695 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2696 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2698 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2699 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2700 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2701 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2703 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2704 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2709 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2710 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2711 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2717 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2718 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2719 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2720 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2721 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2722 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2723 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2724 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2726 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2727 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2728 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2729 . creates a man page for the options.
2730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2733 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2739 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2740 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2741 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2742 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2745 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2746 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2750 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2757 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2760 .cmdopt -B <&'type'&>
2762 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2763 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2764 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2765 clean; it ignores this option.
2769 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2770 .cindex "queue runner"
2771 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2772 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2773 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2775 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2776 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2777 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2778 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2780 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2781 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2782 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2783 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2785 When a listening daemon
2786 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2787 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2788 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2789 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2790 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2791 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2794 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2795 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2796 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2800 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2801 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2802 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2803 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2804 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2805 .cindex reload configuration
2806 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2807 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2808 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2809 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2810 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2811 because these are reread each time they are used.
2814 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2815 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2818 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2819 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2820 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2821 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2822 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2823 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2825 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2826 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2827 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2828 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2829 test data. A line history is supported.
2831 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2832 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2833 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2834 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2835 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2836 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2837 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2839 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2840 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2841 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2842 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2844 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2845 defined and macros will be expanded.
2846 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2847 available to admin users.
2850 The word &"set"& at the start of a line, followed by a single space,
2851 is recognised specially as defining a value for a variable.
2852 The syntax is otherwise the same as the ACL modifier &"set ="&.
2855 .cmdopt -bem <&'filename'&>
2856 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2857 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2858 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2859 of a file. For example:
2861 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2863 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2864 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2865 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2866 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2867 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2868 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2869 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2872 .cmdopt -bF <&'filename'&>
2873 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2874 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2875 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2876 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2877 system filters are recognized.
2879 .cmdopt -bf <&'filename'&>
2880 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2881 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2882 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2883 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2884 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2885 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2886 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2887 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2890 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2891 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2892 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2894 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2896 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2897 variables that are used by the user filter.
2899 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2904 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2905 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2906 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2909 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2910 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2911 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2912 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2914 When testing a filter file,
2915 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2916 .cindex "envelope from"
2917 .cindex "envelope sender"
2918 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2919 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2920 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2921 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2922 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2925 .cmdopt -bfd <&'domain'&>
2926 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2927 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2928 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2931 .cmdopt -bfl <&'local&~part'&>
2932 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2933 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2934 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2935 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2936 actually being delivered.
2938 .cmdopt -bfp <&'prefix'&>
2939 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2940 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2941 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2944 .cmdopt -bfs <&'suffix'&>
2945 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2946 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2947 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2950 .cmdopt -bh <&'IP&~address'&>
2951 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2952 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2953 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2954 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2955 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2956 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2957 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2958 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2959 after a full stop. For example:
2961 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2962 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2964 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2965 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2966 conversion to the canonical form is
2967 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2969 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2970 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2971 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2972 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2973 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2977 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2978 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2979 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2982 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2983 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2984 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2986 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2987 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2988 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2989 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2990 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2991 session were authenticated.
2993 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2994 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2995 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2997 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2998 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2999 specialized SMTP test program such as
3000 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
3002 .cmdopt -bhc <&'IP&~address'&>
3003 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
3004 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
3005 updating the callout cache database.
3008 .cindex "alias file" "building"
3009 .cindex "building alias file"
3010 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
3011 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
3012 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
3013 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3014 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3017 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3018 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3019 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3020 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3021 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3022 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3025 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3027 .cindex "querying exim information"
3028 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3029 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3030 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3031 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3032 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3035 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3036 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3037 recognised DSCP names.
3040 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3041 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3042 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3043 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3044 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3045 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3046 way to guarantee a correct response.
3049 .cindex "local message reception"
3050 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3051 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3052 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3053 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3054 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3055 if no other conflicting option is present.
3057 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3058 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3059 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3060 suppressing this for special cases.
3062 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3063 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3065 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3066 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3067 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3070 .cindex "message" "format"
3071 .cindex "format" "message"
3072 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3073 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3074 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3075 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3076 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3078 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3079 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3081 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3082 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3083 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3084 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3085 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3087 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3088 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3089 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3090 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3091 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3093 .cmdopt -bmalware <&'filename'&>
3094 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3095 .cindex "malware scan test"
3096 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3097 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3098 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3099 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3100 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3101 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3102 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3104 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3105 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3106 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3107 This option requires admin privileges.
3109 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3110 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3111 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3114 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3115 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3116 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3117 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3118 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3119 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3120 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3122 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3123 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3124 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3125 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3126 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3128 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3129 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3130 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3131 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3135 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3136 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3137 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3138 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3139 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3140 arguments, for example:
3142 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3144 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3145 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3146 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3147 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3148 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3149 users, the output is as in this example:
3151 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3153 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3154 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3156 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3157 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3158 backward compatibility.)
3159 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3160 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3162 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3163 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3164 name will not be output.
3166 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3167 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3168 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3169 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3170 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3171 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3172 written directly into the spool directory.
3174 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3176 exim -bP +local_domains
3178 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3179 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3181 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3182 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3183 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3184 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3185 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3186 that driver are output. For example:
3188 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3190 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3191 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3192 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3193 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3194 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3197 .cindex "environment"
3198 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3199 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3202 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3203 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3204 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3205 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3206 The output format is one item per line.
3207 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3208 the exit status will be nonzero.
3211 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3212 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3213 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3214 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3215 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3216 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3217 to allow any user to see the queue.
3219 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3221 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3222 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3225 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3226 .cindex "size" "of message"
3227 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3228 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3229 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3230 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3231 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3232 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3233 before the sender address.
3235 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3236 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3237 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3239 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3240 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3241 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3242 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3243 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3248 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3249 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3250 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3255 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3256 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3257 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3258 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3262 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3263 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3264 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3265 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3268 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3271 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3275 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3276 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3277 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3278 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3282 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3283 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3284 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3285 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3286 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3288 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3289 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3291 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3292 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3293 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3294 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3295 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3296 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3297 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3298 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3299 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3301 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3302 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3306 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3307 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3308 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3309 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3310 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3311 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3312 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3315 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3316 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3317 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3318 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3319 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3320 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3321 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3322 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3323 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3325 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3326 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3327 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3329 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3330 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3331 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3332 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3334 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3335 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3336 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3338 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3339 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3340 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3341 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3342 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3344 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3345 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3348 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3349 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3350 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3351 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3352 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3353 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3354 messages to the MTA.
3357 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3358 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3359 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3360 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3361 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3362 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3363 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3367 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3368 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3369 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3370 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3371 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3372 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3373 the listening daemon.
3376 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3377 .cindex "address" "testing"
3378 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3379 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3380 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3381 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3382 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3384 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3385 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3387 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3388 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3391 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3392 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3393 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3394 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3395 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3398 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3399 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3400 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3401 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3403 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3404 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3405 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3406 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3409 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3410 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3412 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3413 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3414 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3415 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3416 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3417 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3421 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3422 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3423 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3424 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3425 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3426 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3428 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3429 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3430 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3431 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3432 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3433 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3434 dynamic testing facilities.
3437 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3438 .cindex "address" "verification"
3439 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3440 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3441 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3442 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3443 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3444 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3446 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3447 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3448 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3450 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3451 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3453 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3454 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3457 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3458 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3459 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3460 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3461 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3463 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3464 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3465 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3466 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3467 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3468 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3471 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3472 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3473 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3476 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3477 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3478 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3479 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3481 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3482 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3483 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3484 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3487 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3488 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3494 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3495 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3496 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3497 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3499 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3500 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3501 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3502 each port only when the first connection is received.
3504 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3505 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3507 .cmdopt -C <&'filelist'&>
3508 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3509 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3510 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3511 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3512 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3513 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3514 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3515 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3516 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3518 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3519 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3520 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3521 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3522 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3523 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3524 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3525 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3526 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3528 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3529 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3530 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3531 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3532 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3533 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3534 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3536 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3537 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3538 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3539 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3540 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3541 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3542 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3544 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3545 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3546 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3549 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3550 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3551 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3552 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3553 specified by this option.
3556 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3558 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3559 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3560 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3561 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3562 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3563 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3565 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3566 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3567 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3568 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3569 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3570 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3571 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3573 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3574 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3575 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3581 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3582 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3585 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3587 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3588 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3591 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3593 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3594 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3595 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3596 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3597 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3598 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3599 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3602 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3603 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3604 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3605 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3606 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3607 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3608 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3610 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
3611 .irow acl "ACL interpretation"
3612 .irow auth "authenticators"
3613 .irow deliver "general delivery logic"
3614 .irow dns "DNS lookups (see also resolver)"
3615 .irow dnsbl "DNS black list (aka RBL) code"
3616 .irow exec "arguments for &[execv()]& calls"
3617 .irow expand "detailed debugging for string expansions"
3618 .irow filter "filter handling"
3619 .irow hints_lookup "hints data lookups"
3620 .irow host_lookup "all types of name-to-IP address handling"
3621 .irow ident "ident lookup"
3622 .irow interface "lists of local interfaces"
3623 .irow lists "matching things in lists"
3624 .irow load "system load checks"
3625 .irow local_scan "can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3626 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)"
3627 .irow lookup "general lookup code and all lookups"
3628 .irow memory "memory handling"
3629 .irow noutf8 "modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing"
3630 .irow pid "modifier: add pid to debug output lines"
3631 .irow process_info "setting info for the process log"
3632 .irow queue_run "queue runs"
3633 .irow receive "general message reception logic"
3634 .irow resolver "turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output"
3635 .irow retry "retry handling"
3636 .irow rewrite "address rewriting""
3637 .irow route "address routing"
3638 .irow timestamp "modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines"
3639 .irow tls "TLS logic"
3640 .irow transport "transports"
3641 .irow uid "changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid"
3642 .irow verify "address verification logic"
3643 .irow all "almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&"
3645 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3646 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3647 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3648 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3649 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3650 turn everything off.
3652 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3653 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3654 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3655 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3656 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3659 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3660 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3661 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3662 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3663 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3666 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3667 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3670 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3671 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3672 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3673 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3674 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3675 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3677 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3678 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3680 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3682 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3683 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3684 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3685 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3688 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3689 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3690 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3693 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3694 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3695 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3696 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3697 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3698 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3699 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3700 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3703 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3704 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3705 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3706 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3707 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3709 .cmdopt -F <&'string'&>
3710 .cindex "sender" "name"
3711 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3712 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3713 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3714 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3715 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3716 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3718 .cmdopt -f <&'address'&>
3719 .cindex "sender" "address"
3720 .cindex "address" "sender"
3721 .cindex "trusted users"
3722 .cindex "envelope from"
3723 .cindex "envelope sender"
3724 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3725 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3726 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3727 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3730 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3731 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3732 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3733 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3736 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3737 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3738 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3739 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3740 examples of shell commands:
3742 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3743 exim -f "" user@domain
3745 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3746 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3749 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3750 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3751 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3752 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3755 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3756 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3757 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3758 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3759 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3760 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3763 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3764 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3766 control = suppress_local_fixups
3768 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3769 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3772 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3775 .cmdopt -h <&'number'&>
3776 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3777 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3778 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3782 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3783 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3784 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3785 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message.
3786 Solaris 2.4 (SunOS 5.4) Sendmail has a similar &%-i%& processing option
3787 &url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf),
3788 p. 1M-529), and therefore a &%-oi%& command line option, which both are used
3789 by its &'mailx'& command.
3791 .cmdopt -L <&'tag'&>
3792 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3793 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3794 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3795 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3796 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3797 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3799 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3801 .cmdopt -M <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3802 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3803 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3804 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3805 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3806 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3807 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3808 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3811 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3812 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3813 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3814 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3815 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3816 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3818 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3819 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3820 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3821 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3823 .cmdopt -Mar <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3824 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3825 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3826 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3827 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3828 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3829 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3830 can be used only by an admin user.
3832 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&&&
3834 &~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3835 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3837 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3838 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3839 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3840 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3841 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3842 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3843 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3844 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3847 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3848 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3849 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3852 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3853 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3854 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3857 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3858 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-d%& option
3859 to pass on an information string on the purpose of the process.
3861 .cmdopt -MCG <&'queue&~name'&>
3862 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3863 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3864 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3867 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3868 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3869 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3872 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3873 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3874 which Exim is connected advertised limits on numbers of mails, recipients or
3876 The limits are given by the following three arguments.
3879 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3880 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3881 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3884 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3885 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the connection
3886 t a remote server is via a SOCKS proxy, using addresses and ports given by
3887 the following four arguments.
3889 .cmdopt -MCQ <&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3890 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3891 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3892 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3893 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3894 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3895 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3897 .cmdopt -MCq <&'recipient&~address'&>&~<&'size'&>
3898 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3899 by Exim to implement quota checking for local users.
3902 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3903 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3904 ESMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3908 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3909 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3910 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3912 .vitem &%-MCr%&&~<&'SNI'&> &&&
3916 These options are not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3917 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MCt%& option, and passes on the fact that
3918 a TLS Server Name Indication was sent as part of the channel establishment.
3919 The argument gives the SNI string.
3920 The "r" variant indicates a DANE-verified connection.
3922 .cmdopt -MCt <&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3923 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3924 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3925 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3926 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3928 .cmdopt -Mc <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3929 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3930 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3931 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3932 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3933 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3934 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3935 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3936 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3937 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3938 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3939 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3940 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3941 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3943 .cmdopt -Mes <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3944 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3945 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3946 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3947 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3948 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3949 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3950 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3951 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3953 .cmdopt -Mf <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3954 .cindex "freezing messages"
3955 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3956 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3957 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3958 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3959 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3960 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3963 .cmdopt -Mg <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3964 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3965 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3966 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3967 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3968 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3969 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3970 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3971 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3974 .cmdopt -MG <&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3976 .cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
3977 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
3978 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
3979 queue to the given named queue.
3980 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
3981 string to define the default queue.
3982 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
3983 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
3985 .cmdopt -Mmad <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3986 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3987 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3988 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3989 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3990 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3992 .cmdopt -Mmd <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3993 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3994 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3995 .cindex "removing recipients"
3996 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3997 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3998 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3999 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4000 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4001 can be used only by an admin user.
4003 .cmdopt -Mrm <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4004 .cindex "removing messages"
4005 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4006 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4007 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4008 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4009 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4010 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4011 placed in the queue.
4016 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4017 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4018 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4022 .cmdopt -Mset <&'message&~id'&>
4023 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4024 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4025 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4026 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4027 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4028 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4029 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4030 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4031 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4033 .cmdopt -Mt <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4034 .cindex "thawing messages"
4035 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4036 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4037 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4038 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4039 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4040 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4043 .cmdopt -Mvb <&'message&~id'&>
4044 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4045 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4046 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4047 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4049 .cmdopt -Mvc <&'message&~id'&>
4050 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4051 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4052 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4053 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4054 only by an admin user.
4056 .cmdopt -Mvh <&'message&~id'&>
4057 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4058 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4059 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4060 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4061 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4063 .cmdopt -Mvl <&'message&~id'&>
4064 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4065 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4066 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4067 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4070 This is a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail
4071 (&url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf)
4072 p. 1M-258), so Exim treats it that way too.
4075 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4076 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4077 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4078 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4079 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4080 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4081 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4084 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4085 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4086 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4087 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4088 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4089 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4090 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4094 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4095 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4096 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4097 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4099 .cmdopt -O <&'data'&>
4100 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4103 .cmdopt -oA <&'file&~name'&>
4104 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4105 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4106 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4110 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4111 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4112 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4113 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4114 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4115 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4118 .cindex "background delivery"
4119 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4120 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4121 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4122 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4123 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4124 processes to finish.
4126 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4127 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4128 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4129 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4131 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4132 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4133 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4134 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4137 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4138 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4139 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4140 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4141 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4142 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4144 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4145 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4148 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4149 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4151 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4152 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4153 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4154 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4158 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4162 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4163 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4164 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4165 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4166 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4167 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4168 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4169 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4170 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4171 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4175 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4176 .cindex "first pass routing"
4177 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4178 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4179 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4180 configuration file is in effect.
4182 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4183 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4184 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4185 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4186 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4187 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4188 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4189 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4190 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4194 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4195 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4196 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4199 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4201 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4202 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4203 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4204 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4207 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4208 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4209 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4210 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4211 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4214 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4215 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4216 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4217 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4218 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4221 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4222 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4226 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4227 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4231 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4232 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4233 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4234 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4235 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4236 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4239 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4241 .cmdopt -oMa <&'host&~address'&>
4242 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4243 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4244 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4245 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4246 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4247 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4249 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4250 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4252 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4254 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4255 followed by a colon and the port number:
4257 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4259 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4260 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4261 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4262 whichever one is last.
4264 .cmdopt -oMaa <&'name'&>
4265 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4266 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4267 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4268 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4269 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4270 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4272 .cmdopt -oMai <&'string'&>
4273 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4274 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4275 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4276 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4277 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4278 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4280 .cmdopt -oMas <&'address'&>
4281 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4282 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4283 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4284 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4285 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4286 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4287 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4288 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4290 .cmdopt -oMi <&'interface&~address'&>
4291 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4292 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4293 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4294 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4295 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4297 .cmdopt -oMm <&'message&~reference'&>
4298 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4299 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4300 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4301 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4302 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4303 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4304 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4306 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4307 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4308 is sending the bounce.
4310 .cmdopt -oMr <&'protocol&~name'&>
4311 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4312 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4313 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4314 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4315 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4316 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4317 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4318 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4319 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4320 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4322 .cmdopt -oMs <&'host&~name'&>
4323 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4324 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4325 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4326 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4327 uses the name it is given.
4329 .cmdopt -oMt <&'ident&~string'&>
4330 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4331 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4332 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4333 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4334 used, when there is no default.
4337 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4338 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4339 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4340 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4343 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4344 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4345 whatever that means.
4347 .cmdopt -oP <&'path'&>
4348 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4349 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4350 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4351 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4352 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4353 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4354 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4357 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4358 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4359 This option is not intended for general use.
4360 The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4361 combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4362 It causes the pid file to be removed.
4364 .cmdopt -or <&'time'&>
4365 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4366 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4367 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4368 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4369 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4371 .cmdopt -os <&'time'&>
4372 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4373 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4374 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4375 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4376 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4377 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4380 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4382 .cmdopt -oX <&'number&~or&~string'&>
4383 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4384 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4385 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4386 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4387 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4388 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4389 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4390 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4393 .cindex "daemon notifier socket"
4394 This option controls the creation of an inter-process communications endpoint
4396 It is only relevant when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option is also
4398 Normally the daemon creates this socket, unless a &%-oX%& and &*no*& &%-oP%&
4399 option is also present.
4400 If this option is given then the socket will not be created. This could be
4401 required if the system is running multiple daemons.
4403 The socket is currently used for
4405 fast ramp-up of queue runner processes
4407 obtaining a current queue size
4411 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4412 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4413 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4414 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4418 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4419 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4420 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4421 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4424 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4426 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4428 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4430 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4431 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4432 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4433 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4434 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4435 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4438 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4439 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4440 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4441 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4442 and &%-S%& options).
4444 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4445 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4446 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4447 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4448 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4449 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4450 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4453 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4454 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4455 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4456 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4457 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4460 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4461 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4462 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4463 this to be repeated periodically.
4465 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4466 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4467 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4468 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4470 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4471 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4472 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4474 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4475 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4476 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4477 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4481 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4482 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4483 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4484 .cindex "first pass routing"
4485 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
4486 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4487 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4488 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4491 Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4492 If that is so and the &%queue_fast_ramp%& option is true then
4493 in the first phase of the run,
4494 once a threshold number of messages are routed for a given host,
4495 a delivery process is forked in parallel with the rest of the scan.
4497 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4498 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4499 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4500 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4501 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4502 delivered down a single SMTP
4503 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4504 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4505 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4506 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4507 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4510 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4512 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4513 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4514 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4515 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4516 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4518 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4520 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4521 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4522 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4523 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4524 their retry times are tried.
4526 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4528 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4529 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4532 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4534 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4535 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4536 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4539 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4542 .cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4543 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4544 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4545 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4546 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4547 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4548 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4550 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4551 will specify a queue to operate on.
4554 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4556 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4559 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4560 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4561 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4562 starting message id. For example:
4564 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4566 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4567 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4568 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4570 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4572 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4573 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4574 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4575 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4576 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4577 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4579 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4580 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4581 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4582 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4583 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4584 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4585 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4586 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4587 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4589 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4591 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4592 process every 30 minutes.
4594 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4595 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4597 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4599 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4602 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4604 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4606 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4608 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4609 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4610 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4611 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4612 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4613 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4614 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4616 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4617 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4618 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4619 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4620 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4621 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4623 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4624 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4626 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4628 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4629 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4630 applied to each queue run.
4632 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4633 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4634 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4635 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4636 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4637 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4638 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4639 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4640 address will be skipped.
4642 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4643 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4644 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4647 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4648 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4649 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4650 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4651 an arbitrary command instead.
4654 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4656 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4658 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4659 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4660 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4661 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4662 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4663 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4665 .cmdopt -Tqt <&'times'&>
4666 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4667 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4668 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4671 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4675 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4676 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4677 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4678 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4679 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4681 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4682 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4683 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4684 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4685 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4686 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4687 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4688 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4689 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4690 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4691 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4693 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4694 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4695 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4696 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4697 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4698 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4700 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4701 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4702 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4703 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4704 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4705 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4706 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4707 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4708 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4711 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4712 compatibility with Sendmail.
4714 .cmdopt -tls-on-connect
4715 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4716 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4717 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4718 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4719 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4720 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4724 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4725 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4726 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4727 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4728 set. Exim ignores this option.
4731 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4732 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4733 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4734 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4735 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4736 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4740 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4741 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4742 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4745 .cmdopt -X <&'logfile'&>
4746 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4747 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4749 .cmdopt -z <&'log-line'&>
4750 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4751 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4752 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4760 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4761 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4762 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4763 . creates a man page for the options.
4764 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4767 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4774 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4775 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4778 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4779 "The runtime configuration file"
4781 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4782 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4783 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4784 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4785 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4786 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4787 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4788 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4789 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4792 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4793 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4794 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4795 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4796 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4797 actually alter the string.
4799 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4800 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4801 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4802 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4803 existing file in the list.
4806 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4807 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4808 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4809 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4810 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4811 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4812 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4813 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4814 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4815 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4817 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4818 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4819 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4820 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4821 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4823 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4824 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4825 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4826 compromise the Exim user account.
4828 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4829 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4830 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4831 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4832 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4833 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4838 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4839 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4840 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4841 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4842 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4843 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4844 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4845 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4846 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4847 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4848 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4850 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4851 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4852 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4853 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4854 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4855 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4856 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4857 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4858 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4861 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4862 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4863 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4864 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4865 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4867 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4868 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4869 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4870 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4871 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4872 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4874 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4875 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4876 necessarily be discarded.
4877 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4878 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4879 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4880 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4881 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4882 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4884 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4885 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4886 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4887 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4888 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4889 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4890 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4892 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4893 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4894 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4898 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4899 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4900 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4901 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4902 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4903 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4904 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4905 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4908 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4911 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4912 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4913 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4915 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4916 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4917 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4919 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4920 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4921 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4923 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4924 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4925 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4926 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4929 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4930 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4931 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4933 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4934 want to use this feature, you must set
4936 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4938 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4939 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4942 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4943 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4944 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4945 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4947 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4948 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4949 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4950 and does not introduce a comment.
4952 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4953 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4954 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4955 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4956 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4958 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4959 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4960 change settings as required.
4962 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4963 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4964 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4965 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4966 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4971 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4972 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4973 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4974 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4975 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4976 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
4979 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
4980 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
4982 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
4983 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4984 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4985 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4986 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
4989 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4990 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4991 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4992 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4994 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4995 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4998 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5001 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5002 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5007 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5008 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5009 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5010 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5011 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5012 definition, and must be of the form
5014 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5016 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5017 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5018 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5019 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5020 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5022 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5023 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5024 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5026 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5027 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5028 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5029 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5030 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5031 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5032 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5035 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5036 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5038 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5039 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5040 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5041 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5042 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5043 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5046 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5047 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5048 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5053 MAC == updated value
5055 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5056 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5057 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5058 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5062 MAC == MAC and something added
5064 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5065 from a number of other files.
5067 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5068 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5069 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5070 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5071 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5076 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5077 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5078 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5079 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5081 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5082 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5084 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5086 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5088 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5089 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5090 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5093 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5094 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5095 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5096 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5097 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5100 The following classes of macros are defined:
5102 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5103 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5104 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5105 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5106 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5107 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5108 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5109 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5110 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5111 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5112 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5113 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5116 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5119 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5120 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5121 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5122 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5123 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5124 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5125 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5127 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5128 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5129 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5133 message_size_limit = 50M
5135 message_size_limit = 100M
5138 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5139 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5140 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5141 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5142 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5144 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5145 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5146 in this line"& will always be true.
5148 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5149 to clarify complicated nestings.
5153 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5154 .cindex "common option syntax"
5155 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5156 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5157 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5158 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5159 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5160 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5161 space) and then the value. For example:
5163 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5165 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5166 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5167 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5168 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5169 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5170 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5171 word &"hide"&. For example:
5173 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5175 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5177 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5179 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5180 all instances of the same driver.
5182 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5183 that are found in option settings.
5186 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5187 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5188 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5189 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5190 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5191 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5192 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5193 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5194 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5195 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5196 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5197 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5202 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5207 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5212 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5213 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5214 .cindex "format" "integer"
5215 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5216 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5217 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5218 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5221 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5222 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5223 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5225 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5226 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5227 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5231 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5232 .cindex "integer format"
5233 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5234 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5235 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5236 Such options are always output in octal.
5239 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5240 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5241 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5242 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5243 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5247 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5248 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5249 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5250 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5251 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5261 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5262 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5263 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5267 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5268 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5269 .cindex "format" "string"
5270 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5271 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5272 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5273 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5274 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5275 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5276 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5277 therefore equivalent:
5279 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5280 trusted_users = uucp:\
5281 # This comment line is ignored
5284 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5285 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5286 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5287 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5288 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5291 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5292 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5293 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5295 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5296 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5300 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5301 character, that character replaces the pair.
5303 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5304 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5305 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5306 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5307 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5308 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5311 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5312 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5313 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5314 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5315 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5316 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5317 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5318 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5319 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5320 within a quoted configuration string.
5323 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5324 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5325 .cindex "format" "user name"
5326 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5327 .cindex "format" "group name"
5328 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5329 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5330 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5331 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5334 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5335 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5336 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5337 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5338 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5339 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5340 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5341 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5342 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5343 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5344 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5346 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5347 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5348 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5349 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5350 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5351 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5354 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5356 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5358 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5359 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The spaces around the first
5360 colon in the example above are necessary. If they were not there, the list would
5361 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5363 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5364 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5365 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5366 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5367 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5368 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5369 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5370 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5372 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5374 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5375 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5376 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5378 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5379 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5380 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5381 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5382 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5383 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5384 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5385 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5386 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5388 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5390 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5391 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5392 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5393 the value in quotes. For example:
5395 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5397 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5398 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5399 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5400 enclosing an empty list item.
5404 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5405 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5406 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5407 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5409 senders = user@domain :
5411 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5412 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5413 items, the second of which is empty:
5415 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5417 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5418 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5419 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5420 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5424 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5425 is at the end of the list.
5430 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5431 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5432 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5433 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5434 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5435 a sequence of lines like this:
5437 <&'instance name'&>:
5442 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5443 followed by three options settings:
5448 transport = local_delivery
5450 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5451 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5452 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5453 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5454 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5455 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5457 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5458 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5460 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5461 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5462 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5463 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5464 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5467 .cindex "generic options"
5468 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5469 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5470 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5471 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5472 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5473 .cindex "private options"
5474 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5475 they all have default values.
5477 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5478 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5479 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5481 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5482 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5483 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5484 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5485 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5486 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5487 configuration lines:
5492 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5493 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5494 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5495 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5501 command_timeout = 10s
5503 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5504 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5507 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5508 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5509 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5517 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5518 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5520 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5521 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5522 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5523 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5524 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5525 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5526 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5527 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5528 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5529 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5530 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5534 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5535 All macros should be defined before any options.
5537 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5539 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5541 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5542 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5543 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5544 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5546 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5547 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5548 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5551 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5552 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5553 in the file, after the macros.
5554 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5556 # primary_hostname =
5558 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5559 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5560 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5561 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5563 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5565 domainlist local_domains = @
5566 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5567 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5569 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5570 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5571 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5572 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5574 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5575 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5578 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5579 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5580 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5581 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5582 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5583 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5585 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5586 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5587 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5588 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5589 domain is permitted.
5591 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5592 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5593 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5594 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5595 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5596 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5598 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5599 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5600 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5602 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5604 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5605 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5607 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5608 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5609 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5610 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5611 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5612 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5613 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5614 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5615 contents of a message to be checked.
5617 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5619 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5620 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5622 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5623 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5624 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5625 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5627 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5629 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5630 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5631 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5633 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5634 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5635 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5636 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5637 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5638 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5639 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5641 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5643 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5644 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5646 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5647 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5648 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5649 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5650 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5651 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5652 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5653 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5654 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5655 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5656 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5657 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5658 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5659 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5660 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5661 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5663 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5664 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5665 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5666 which should be used in preference to 587.
5667 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5669 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5671 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5674 # qualify_recipient =
5676 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5677 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5678 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5679 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5680 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5681 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5683 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5684 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5685 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5686 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5688 # allow_domain_literals
5690 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5691 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5692 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5693 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5694 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5695 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5697 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5701 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5702 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5703 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5704 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5705 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5706 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5707 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5708 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5710 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5711 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5716 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5717 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5718 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5719 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5720 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5721 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5724 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5725 1413 (hence their names):
5728 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5730 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5731 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5732 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5733 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5734 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5735 information, you can change this.
5737 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5738 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5743 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5744 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5745 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5746 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5748 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5749 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5751 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5752 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5754 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5757 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5758 +tls_certificate_verified
5761 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5763 # percent_hack_domains =
5765 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5766 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5767 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5769 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5770 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5771 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5772 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5773 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5774 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5775 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5776 always bounce messages.
5778 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5779 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5781 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5782 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5783 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5784 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5785 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5787 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5788 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5789 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5790 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5791 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5794 # split_spool_directory = true
5797 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5798 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5799 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5800 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5801 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5802 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5803 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5805 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5808 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5809 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5810 that are not 8-bit clean.
5812 # accept_8bitmime = false
5815 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5816 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5817 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5818 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5819 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the &%timezone%& runtime
5820 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5822 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5823 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5827 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5828 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5829 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5830 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5831 It starts with the line
5835 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5836 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5837 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5839 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5840 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5841 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5842 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5843 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5844 result of the ACL processing.
5848 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5853 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5854 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5855 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5856 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5857 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5858 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5860 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5861 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5862 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5865 deny domains = +local_domains
5866 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5867 message = Restricted characters in address
5869 deny domains = !+local_domains
5870 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5871 message = Restricted characters in address
5873 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5874 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5875 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5876 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5877 in Internet mail addresses.
5879 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5880 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5881 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5882 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5883 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5884 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5885 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5886 policy of being as safe as possible.
5888 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5889 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5890 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5891 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5892 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5893 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5895 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5896 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5897 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5898 have to modify this rule.
5900 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5901 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5902 common convention of local parts constructed as
5903 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5904 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5905 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5906 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5907 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5908 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5910 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5911 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5912 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5913 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5914 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5915 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5916 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5918 accept local_parts = postmaster
5919 domains = +local_domains
5921 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5922 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5923 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5924 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5925 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5927 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5928 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5929 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5931 require verify = sender
5933 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5934 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5935 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5936 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5937 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5938 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5939 discusses the details of address verification.
5941 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5942 control = submission
5944 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5945 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5946 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5947 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5948 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5949 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5950 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5951 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5952 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5954 accept authenticated = *
5955 control = submission
5957 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5958 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5959 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5960 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5961 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5962 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5964 require message = relay not permitted
5965 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5967 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5968 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5970 require verify = recipient
5972 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5973 fails, the address is rejected.
5975 # deny dnslists = black.list.example
5976 # message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5977 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5980 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5981 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5982 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5983 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5985 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5986 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5987 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5990 # require verify = csa
5992 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5993 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5998 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5999 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6003 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6004 of this ACL are commented out:
6007 # message = This message contains a virus \
6010 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6011 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6012 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6013 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6015 # warn spam = nobody
6016 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6017 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6018 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6019 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6021 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6022 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6023 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6024 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6025 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6026 whatever the spam score.
6030 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6033 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6034 .cindex "default" "routers"
6035 .cindex "routers" "default"
6036 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6041 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6042 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6043 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6044 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6045 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6048 # driver = ipliteral
6049 # domains = !+local_domains
6050 # transport = remote_smtp
6052 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6053 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6054 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6055 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6056 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6058 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6059 macro has been defined, per
6061 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6070 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6071 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6072 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6073 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6077 driver = manualroute
6078 domains = ! +local_domains
6079 transport = smarthost_smtp
6080 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6081 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6084 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6085 specified by the line
6087 domains = ! +local_domains
6089 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6090 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6091 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6092 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6093 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6094 passed on to the following routers.
6096 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6097 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6098 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6099 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6101 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6102 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6103 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6104 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6105 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6106 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6107 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6112 domains = ! +local_domains
6113 transport = remote_smtp
6114 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6117 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6119 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6120 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6121 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6122 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6123 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6125 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6126 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6127 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6128 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6129 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6130 the address fails and is bounced.
6132 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6133 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6134 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6135 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6136 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6137 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6138 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6145 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6147 file_transport = address_file
6148 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6150 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6151 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6152 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6153 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6154 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6157 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6158 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6159 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6160 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6165 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6166 # local_part_suffix_optional
6167 file = $home/.forward
6172 file_transport = address_file
6173 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6174 reply_transport = address_reply
6176 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6177 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6178 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6179 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6180 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6183 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6184 # local_part_suffix_optional
6186 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6187 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6188 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6189 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6190 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6191 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6192 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6194 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6195 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6196 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6197 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6199 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6200 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6201 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6202 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6203 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6204 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6205 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6207 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6208 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6209 There are two reasons for doing this:
6212 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6213 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6216 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6217 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6218 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6219 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6223 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6224 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6225 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6226 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6228 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6229 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6230 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6232 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6234 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6240 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6241 # local_part_suffix_optional
6242 transport = local_delivery
6244 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6245 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6246 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6247 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6248 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6251 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6252 .cindex "default" "transports"
6253 .cindex "transports" "default"
6254 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6255 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6256 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6260 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6264 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6269 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6270 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6271 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6272 with over-long lines.
6274 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6275 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6276 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6277 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6279 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6280 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6281 usual federated system.
6286 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6290 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6291 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6292 hosts_require_tls = *
6293 tls_verify_hosts = *
6294 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this this will have no effect,
6295 # but if you have to comment it out then this will at least log whether
6296 # you succeed or not:
6297 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6299 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6300 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6301 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6302 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6303 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6304 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6306 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6307 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6310 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6317 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6318 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6319 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6320 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6321 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6322 then no other options are defined.
6323 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6324 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6325 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6326 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6327 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6328 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6329 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6330 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6331 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6332 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6333 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6335 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6337 All other options are defaulted.
6341 file = /var/mail/$local_part_data
6348 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6349 traditional BSD mailbox format.
6351 We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6352 as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6353 Instead we use &$local_part_data$&,
6354 the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6355 (done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6357 By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6358 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6359 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6360 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6361 show how this can be done.
6363 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6364 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6365 similarly-named options above.
6371 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6372 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6373 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6374 be returned to the sender.
6382 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6383 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6384 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6389 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6394 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6395 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6396 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6397 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6398 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6399 introduced by the line
6403 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6406 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6408 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6409 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6410 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6411 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6412 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6414 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6415 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6416 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6419 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6420 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6424 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6425 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6429 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6430 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6431 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6433 begin authenticators
6435 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6436 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6437 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6438 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6439 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6440 to support most MUA software.
6442 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6445 # driver = plaintext
6446 # server_set_id = $auth2
6447 # server_prompts = :
6448 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6449 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6451 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6454 # driver = plaintext
6455 # server_set_id = $auth1
6456 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6457 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6458 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6461 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6462 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6463 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6464 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6465 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6466 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6467 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6468 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6470 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6471 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6472 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6473 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6475 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6476 usercode and password are in different positions.
6477 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6479 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6483 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6484 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6486 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6488 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6490 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6491 uses the PCRE2 regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6492 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6493 regular expressions is discussed in
6494 online Perl manpages, in
6495 many Perl reference books, and also in
6496 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6497 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6498 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6499 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6500 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6502 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6503 are supported by PCRE2 is included in the PCRE2 distribution, and no further
6504 description is included here. The PCRE2 functions are called from Exim using
6505 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE2 options set), except that
6506 the PCRE2_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6509 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6510 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6511 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6512 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6514 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6516 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6517 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6518 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6519 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6520 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6521 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6524 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6525 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6526 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6527 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6528 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6529 match anywhere in the subject string.
6531 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6532 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6534 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6536 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6539 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6541 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6542 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6546 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6549 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6550 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6551 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6552 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6553 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6554 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6557 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6558 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6559 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6560 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6561 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6562 The key for the lookup is &*specified*& as part of the string to be expanded.
6564 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6565 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6566 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6567 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6568 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6569 Depending on the lookup type (see below)
6570 the key for the lookup may need to be &*specified*& as above
6571 or may be &*implicit*&,
6572 given by the context in which the list is being checked.
6575 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6576 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6577 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6578 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6579 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6580 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6582 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6583 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6584 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6585 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6586 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6588 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6589 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6592 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6593 The key for an expansion-style lookup must be given explicitly.
6594 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6595 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6596 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6597 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6599 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6600 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6602 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6603 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6604 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6605 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a lookup expansion""
6606 The result of the expansion is not tainted.
6609 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6610 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6612 The file could contains lines like this:
6617 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6618 matches the list item.
6620 The key for a list-style lookup is implicit, from the lookup context, if
6621 the lookup is a single-key type (see below).
6622 For query-style lookup types the query must be given explicitly.
6625 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6626 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6628 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6630 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6631 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6632 causes a second lookup to occur.
6634 The lookup type may optionally be followed by a comma
6635 and a comma-separated list of options.
6636 Each option is a &"name=value"& pair.
6637 Whether an option is meaningful depends on the lookup type.
6639 All lookups support the option &"cache=no_rd"&.
6640 If this is given then the cache that Exim manages for lookup results
6641 is not checked before doing the lookup.
6642 The result of the lookup is still written to the cache.
6644 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6645 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6646 lookup is permitted.
6649 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6650 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6651 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6652 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6655 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6656 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6657 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6658 .cindex "tainted data" "single-key lookups"
6659 The file string may not be tainted.
6661 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6662 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a single-key lookup"
6663 All single-key lookups support the option &"ret=key"&.
6664 If this is given and the lookup
6665 (either underlying implementation or cached value)
6666 returns data, the result is replaced with a non-tainted
6667 version of the lookup key.
6670 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6671 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6672 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6673 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6674 .cindex "tainted data" "quoting for lookups"
6675 If tainted data is used in the query then it should be quuted by
6676 using the &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& expansion operator
6677 appropriate for the lookup.
6680 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6681 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6682 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6687 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6688 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6689 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6694 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6695 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6696 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6697 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6700 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6701 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6702 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6703 The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6704 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6705 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6706 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6707 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6708 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6710 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6711 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6712 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6713 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6715 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6716 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6717 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6718 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6721 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6722 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6723 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6724 Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6725 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6726 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6727 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6729 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6730 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6731 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6732 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6733 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6734 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6735 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6738 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6739 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6741 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6742 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6743 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6744 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6745 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6746 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6747 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6750 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6751 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6752 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6754 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6755 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6756 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6757 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6758 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6759 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6760 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6761 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6762 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6763 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6766 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6767 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6768 The given file must be an absolute directory path; this is searched for an entry
6769 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function.
6770 The key may not contain any forward slash characters.
6771 If &[lstat()]& succeeds then so does the lookup.
6772 .cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6773 The result is regarded as untainted.
6775 Options for the lookup can be given by appending them after the word "dsearch",
6776 separated by a comma. Options, if present, are a comma-separated list having
6777 each element starting with a tag name and an equals.
6779 Two options are supported, for the return value and for filtering match
6781 The "ret" option requests an alternate result value of
6782 the entire path for the entry. Example:
6784 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,ret=full {/etc}}
6786 The default result is just the requested entry.
6787 The "filter" option requests that only directory entries of a given type
6788 are matched. The match value is one of "file", "dir" or "subdir" (the latter
6789 not matching "." or ".."). Example:
6791 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,filter=file {/etc}}
6793 The default matching is for any entry type, including directories
6796 An example of how this
6797 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6798 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6800 .subsection iplsearch
6801 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6802 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6803 The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6804 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6805 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6806 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6807 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6809 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6810 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6811 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6812 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6814 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6815 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6816 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6817 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6818 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6820 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6821 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6822 lookup types support only literal keys.
6824 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6825 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6826 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6828 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6829 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6830 notation before executing the lookup.)
6832 One option is supported, "ret=full", to request the return of the entire line
6833 rather than omitting the key portion.
6834 Note however that the key portion will have been de-quoted.
6838 .cindex json "lookup type"
6839 .cindex JSON expansions
6840 The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6841 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6842 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6843 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6844 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6845 of the JSON structure.
6846 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6847 nunbered array element is selected.
6848 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6849 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6850 or array; for the latter two a string-representation of the JSON
6852 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6858 .cindex database lmdb
6859 The given file is an LMDB database.
6860 LMDB is a memory-mapped key-value store,
6861 with API modeled loosely on that of BerkeleyDB.
6862 See &url(https://symas.com/products/lightning-memory-mapped-database/)
6863 for the feature set and operation modes.
6865 Exim provides read-only access via the LMDB C library.
6866 The library can be obtained from &url(https://github.com/LMDB/lmdb)
6867 or your operating system package repository.
6868 To enable LMDB support in Exim set LOOKUP_LMDB=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
6870 You will need to separately create the LMDB database file,
6871 possibly using the &"mdb_load"& utility.
6875 .cindex "linear search"
6876 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6877 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6878 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6879 The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6880 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6881 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6882 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6883 in the file is used.
6885 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6886 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6887 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6888 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6889 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6894 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6895 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6896 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6897 wildcarding of any kind.
6899 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6900 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6901 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6902 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6903 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6904 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6905 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6906 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6907 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6910 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6911 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6912 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6913 The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6914 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6915 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6916 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6917 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6919 .subsection (n)wildlsearch
6920 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6921 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6922 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6923 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6924 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6925 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6926 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6927 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6928 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6930 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6931 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6932 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6933 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6936 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6938 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6939 *fish data for anythingfish
6942 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6943 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6945 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6947 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6948 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6949 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6951 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6953 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6954 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6955 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6957 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6960 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6961 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6962 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6963 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6964 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6966 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6967 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6968 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6969 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6970 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6973 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6974 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6975 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6978 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6980 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6983 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6984 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6985 be followed by optional colons.
6987 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6988 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6989 lookup types support only literal keys.
6992 .cindex "spf lookup type"
6993 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
6994 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6995 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method).
6996 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6999 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
7000 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
7001 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
7002 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
7003 many of them are given in later sections.
7006 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7007 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
7008 This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
7009 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
7010 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
7013 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7014 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7015 This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
7018 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
7019 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7020 This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
7021 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
7022 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
7023 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
7024 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
7027 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7028 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7029 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7030 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7033 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7034 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7035 This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
7036 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
7039 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7040 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7041 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
7042 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7045 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
7046 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
7047 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
7048 This is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
7049 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
7050 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
7051 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
7052 password value. For example:
7054 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
7058 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7059 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7060 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7061 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7064 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7065 .cindex lookup Redis
7066 The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7067 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7070 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7071 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7072 The format of the query is
7073 an SQL statement that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7076 This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7077 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7080 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
7081 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7082 &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7083 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7084 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7085 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7086 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7087 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7088 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7090 require condition = \
7091 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7093 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7094 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7095 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7096 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7100 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7101 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7102 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7103 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7104 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7105 options such as a list of local domains.
7107 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7108 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7109 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7110 or may give up altogether.
7114 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7115 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7116 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7117 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7118 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7119 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7120 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7121 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7123 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7124 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7125 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7127 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7128 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7129 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7131 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7132 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7133 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7134 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7135 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7136 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7137 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7138 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7139 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7140 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7142 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7144 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7145 looks up these keys, in this order:
7151 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7152 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7153 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7154 Exim move on to try the next key.
7158 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7159 .cindex "partial matching"
7160 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7161 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7162 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7163 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7164 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7165 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7166 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7167 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7168 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7169 a key in a DBM file is
7171 *.dates.fict.example
7173 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7174 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7175 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7178 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7179 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7180 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7182 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7183 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7184 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7185 partial matching keys
7186 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7187 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7188 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7190 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7191 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7192 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7193 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7194 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7195 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7198 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7199 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7200 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7201 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7202 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7203 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7205 2250.dates.fict.example
7206 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7207 *.dates.fict.example
7210 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7213 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7214 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7215 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7216 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7217 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7218 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7220 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7222 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7223 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7224 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7225 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7227 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7229 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7230 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7232 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7233 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7234 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7237 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7239 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7240 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7242 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7243 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7244 for &"*"& on its own.
7246 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7250 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7251 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7252 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7253 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7254 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7255 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7256 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7258 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7259 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7260 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7261 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7262 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7267 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7268 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7269 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7270 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7271 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7272 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7273 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7275 If an option &"cache=no_rd"& is used on the lookup then
7276 the cache is only written to, cached data is not used for the operation
7277 and a real lookup is done.
7279 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7280 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7281 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7282 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7283 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7284 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7286 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7287 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7293 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7294 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7295 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7296 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7297 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7298 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7302 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7303 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7305 [name="$local_part"]
7307 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7308 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7309 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7310 of the following form is provided:
7312 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7314 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7316 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7318 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7319 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7320 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7325 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7326 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7327 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7328 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7329 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7330 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7331 an expansion string could contain:
7333 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7335 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7336 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7337 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7338 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7340 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7341 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7342 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7344 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7345 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7346 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7347 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7348 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7350 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7352 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7353 white space is ignored.
7354 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7355 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7356 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7358 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7359 When the type is PTR,
7360 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7361 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7363 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7365 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7366 altered and nothing is added.
7368 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7369 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7370 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7371 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7372 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7373 The field separator can be modified as above.
7375 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7376 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7377 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7378 unless a field separator is specified.
7379 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7381 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7383 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7384 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7385 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7387 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7388 white space is ignored.
7390 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7391 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7392 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7393 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7396 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7399 .subsection "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" SECTdnsdb_mod
7400 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7401 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7402 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7403 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7404 each followed by a comma,
7405 that may appear before the record type.
7407 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7408 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7409 a defer-option modifier.
7410 The possible keywords are
7411 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7412 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7413 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7414 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7415 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7416 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7417 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7419 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7420 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7422 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7423 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7425 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7426 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7427 The possible keywords are
7428 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7429 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7431 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7432 is not labelled as authenticated data
7433 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7434 The default is &"lax"&.
7436 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7438 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7439 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7440 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7441 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7443 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7445 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7446 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7447 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7449 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7450 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7452 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7453 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7454 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7457 .subsection "Pseudo dnsdb record types" SECID66
7458 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7459 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7460 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7461 the pseudo-type MXH:
7463 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7465 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7468 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7469 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7470 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7471 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7472 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7473 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7474 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7475 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7477 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7478 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7480 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7481 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7482 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7484 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7485 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7486 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7487 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7488 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7491 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7492 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7493 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7494 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7495 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7496 result of a successful lookup such as:
7498 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7500 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7501 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7502 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7504 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7505 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7506 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7507 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7509 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7513 .subsection "Multiple dnsdb lookups" SECID67
7514 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7515 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7516 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7517 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7519 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7520 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7521 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7523 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7524 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7525 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7526 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7528 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7529 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7530 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7535 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7536 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7537 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7538 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7539 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7540 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7541 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7542 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7543 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7544 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7545 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7546 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7548 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7549 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7550 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7551 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7552 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7554 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7555 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7557 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7558 the way they handle the results of a query:
7561 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7564 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7565 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7567 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7568 from all of them are returned.
7572 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7573 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7574 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7575 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7578 .subsection "Format of LDAP queries" SECTforldaque
7579 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7580 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7581 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7583 data = ${lookup ldap \
7584 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7585 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7587 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7588 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7589 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7590 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7592 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7593 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7594 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7596 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7597 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7598 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7599 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7600 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7601 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7602 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7603 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7607 .subsection "LDAP quoting" SECID68
7608 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7609 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7610 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7611 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7612 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7614 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7615 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7623 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7624 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7628 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7630 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7634 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7636 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7638 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7640 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7641 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7642 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7646 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7647 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7648 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7650 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7654 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7656 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7658 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7660 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7661 authentication below.
7664 .subsection "LDAP connections" SECID69
7665 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7666 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7667 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7668 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7671 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7673 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7674 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7675 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7676 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7677 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7678 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7679 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7680 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7681 failures, and timeouts.
7683 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7684 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7685 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7686 doubled. For example
7688 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7690 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7691 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7692 the local host) is used.
7694 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7695 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7696 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7697 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7700 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7701 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7702 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7703 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7705 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7707 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7708 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7710 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7712 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7713 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7714 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7715 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7716 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7717 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7718 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7721 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7722 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7723 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7726 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7729 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7733 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7734 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7738 .subsection "LDAP authentication and control information" SECID70
7739 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7740 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7741 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7742 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7743 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7744 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7745 them. The following names are recognized:
7746 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
7747 .irow DEREFERENCE "set the dereferencing parameter"
7748 .irow NETTIME "set a timeout for a network operation"
7749 .irow USER "set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind"
7750 .irow PASS "set the password, likewise"
7751 .irow REFERRALS "set the referrals parameter"
7752 .irow SERVERS "set alternate server list for this query only"
7753 .irow SIZE "set the limit for the number of entries returned"
7754 .irow TIME "set the maximum waiting time for a query"
7756 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7757 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7758 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7759 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7761 .cindex LDAP timeout
7762 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7763 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7764 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7765 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7766 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7767 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7768 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7769 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7770 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7771 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7773 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7774 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7776 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7777 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7778 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7779 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7780 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7781 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7782 alternate list (colon-separated).
7784 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7785 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7788 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7789 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7792 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7793 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7794 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7795 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7797 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7798 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7799 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7801 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7802 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7803 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7804 quoting has two advantages:
7807 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7808 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7810 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7813 For example, a setting such as
7815 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7817 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7819 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7820 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7821 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7822 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7826 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7827 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7832 .subsection "Format of data returned by LDAP" SECID71
7833 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7834 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7835 as a sequence of values, for example
7837 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7839 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7840 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7841 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7842 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7843 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7846 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7847 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7848 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7849 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7851 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7852 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7853 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7854 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7855 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7856 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7857 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7858 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7859 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7861 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7862 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7863 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7864 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7865 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7868 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7871 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7874 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7875 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7877 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7878 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7880 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7881 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7884 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7885 results of LDAP lookups.
7886 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7887 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7888 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7889 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7890 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7891 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7896 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7897 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7898 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7899 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7900 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7901 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7902 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7903 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7905 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7907 might return the string
7909 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7910 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7912 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7914 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7920 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7921 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7922 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7926 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7927 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7928 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7929 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7930 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7931 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7932 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7933 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7934 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7935 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7936 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7937 .cindex lookup Redis
7938 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7940 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7943 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7946 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7947 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7949 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7954 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7956 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7957 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7958 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7962 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7963 with a newline between the data for each row.
7966 .subsection "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" SECID72
7967 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7968 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7969 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7970 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7971 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7972 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7973 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7974 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7975 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7976 .cindex lookup Redis
7977 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7978 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7979 or &%redis_servers%&
7980 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7982 .oindex &%mysql_servers%&
7983 .oindex &%pgsql_servers%&
7984 .oindex &%oracle_servers%&
7985 .oindex &%ibase_servers%&
7986 .oindex &%redis_servers%&
7987 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7988 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7989 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7991 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7992 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7993 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7994 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7996 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7998 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7999 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
8000 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
8002 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
8003 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
8005 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
8006 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
8007 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
8008 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
8009 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
8010 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
8012 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
8013 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
8014 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8016 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
8017 host, database number, and password.
8019 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
8020 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
8021 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
8023 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
8025 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
8028 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
8029 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
8030 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
8031 itself are escaped with backslashes.
8033 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
8034 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
8036 .subsection "Specifying the server in the query" SECTspeserque
8037 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
8038 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
8039 done by appending a comma-separated option to the query type:
8041 &`,servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&
8043 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
8045 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
8046 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
8047 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
8050 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
8052 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
8053 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
8054 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
8056 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
8057 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
8058 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
8061 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
8065 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8067 ${lookup mysql,servers=master {UPDATE ...} }
8069 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8070 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8071 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8073 ${lookup pgsql,servers=master/db/name/pw {UPDATE ...} }
8076 An older syntax places the servers specification before the query,
8077 semicolon separated:
8079 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8081 The new version avoids potential issues with tainted
8082 arguments in the query, for explicit expansion.
8083 &*Note*&: server specifications in list-style lookups are still problematic.
8086 .subsection "Special MySQL features" SECID73
8087 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8088 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8089 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8090 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8091 the default value is &"exim"&.
8092 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8094 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8095 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8097 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8098 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8100 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8103 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8104 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8106 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8107 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8108 is zero because no rows are affected.
8111 .subsection "Special PostgreSQL features" SECID74
8112 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8113 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8114 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8115 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8118 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8120 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8121 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8122 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8124 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8125 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8128 .subsection "More about SQLite" SECTsqlite
8129 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8130 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8131 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8132 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8133 daemon as in the other SQL databases.
8135 .oindex &%sqlite_dbfile%&
8136 There are two ways of
8137 specifying the file.
8138 The first is is by using the &%sqlite_dbfile%& main option.
8139 The second, which allows separate files for each query,
8140 is to use an option appended, comma-separated, to the &"sqlite"&
8141 lookup type word. The option is the word &"file"&, then an equals,
8143 The filename in this case cannot contain whitespace or open-brace charachters.
8145 A deprecated method is available, prefixing the query with the filename
8146 separated by white space.
8148 .cindex "tainted data" "sqlite file"
8149 the query cannot use any tainted values, as that taints
8150 the entire query including the filename - resulting in a refusal to open
8153 In all the above cases the filename must be an absolute path.
8155 Here is a lookup expansion example:
8157 sqlite_dbfile = /some/thing/sqlitedb
8159 ${lookup sqlite {select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8161 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8163 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;\
8164 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8166 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8167 quote, which it doubles.
8169 .cindex timeout SQLite
8170 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8171 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8172 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8173 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8174 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8175 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8176 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8179 .subsection "More about Redis" SECTredis
8180 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8181 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8182 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8185 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8186 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8189 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8190 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8191 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8192 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8195 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8196 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8197 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8204 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8205 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8207 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8208 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8209 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8210 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8211 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8212 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8213 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8214 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8215 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8217 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8218 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8219 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8220 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8222 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8223 support all the complexity available in
8224 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8228 .section "Results of list checking" SECTlistresults
8229 The primary result of doing a list check is a truth value.
8230 In some contexts additional information is stored
8231 about the list element that matched:
8234 A &%hosts%& ACL condition
8235 will store a result in the &$host_data$& variable.
8237 A &%local_parts%& router option or &%local_parts%& ACL condition
8238 will store a result in the &$local_part_data$& variable.
8240 A &%domains%& router option or &%domains%& ACL condition
8241 will store a result in the &$domain_data$& variable.
8243 A &%senders%& router option or &%senders%& ACL condition
8244 will store a result in the &$sender_data$& variable.
8246 A &%recipients%& ACL condition
8247 will store a result in the &$recipient_data$& variable.
8250 The detail of the additional information depends on the
8251 type of match and is given below as the &*value*& information.
8256 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8257 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8258 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8260 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8261 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8264 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8265 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8266 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8267 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8268 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8271 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8272 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8273 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8275 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8276 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8277 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8278 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8279 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8281 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8282 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8284 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8285 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8286 senders based on the receiving domain.
8291 .subsection "Negated items in lists" SECID76
8292 .cindex "list" "negation"
8293 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8294 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8295 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8296 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8297 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8298 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8300 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8301 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8302 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8303 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8304 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8306 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8308 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8309 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8310 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8312 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8314 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8315 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8316 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8318 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8319 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8324 .subsection "File names in lists" SECTfilnamlis
8325 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8326 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8327 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8328 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8329 filenames are not allowed,
8330 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8331 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8335 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8336 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8338 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8339 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8340 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8342 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8346 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8347 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8348 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8349 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8351 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8352 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8354 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8356 and the file contains the lines
8361 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8362 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8366 .subsection "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" SECID77
8367 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8368 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8369 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8370 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8371 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8372 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8373 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8375 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8376 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8377 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8378 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8383 .subsection "Named lists" SECTnamedlists
8384 .cindex "named lists"
8385 .cindex "list" "named"
8386 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8387 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8388 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8389 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8390 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8391 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8392 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8394 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8396 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8397 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8398 configured with the line
8400 domains = +local_domains
8402 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8403 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8407 domains = ! +local_domains
8408 transport = remote_smtp
8411 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8412 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8413 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8414 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8416 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8417 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8419 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8421 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8422 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8423 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8425 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8426 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8427 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8429 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8430 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8432 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8433 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8434 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8436 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8438 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8439 referenced lists if you can.
8441 .cindex "hiding named list values"
8442 .cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8443 Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8444 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8445 line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8446 word &"hide"&. For example:
8448 hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8452 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8453 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8454 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8456 domains = +local_domains
8458 on several of your routers
8459 or in several ACL statements,
8460 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8461 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8462 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8463 the same each time they are referenced.
8465 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8466 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8467 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8468 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8472 .subsection "Named lists compared with macros" SECID78
8473 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8474 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8475 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8476 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8479 ALIST = host1 : host2
8480 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8482 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8484 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8486 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8489 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8490 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8492 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8494 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8498 .subsection "Named list caching" SECID79
8499 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8500 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8501 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8502 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8503 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8504 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8505 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8506 message. For example:
8508 domainlist special_domains = \
8509 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8511 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8512 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8513 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8514 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8515 same list each time.
8517 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8518 cache the result anyway. For example:
8520 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8522 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8523 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8527 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8528 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8529 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8530 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8531 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8534 .cindex "primary host name"
8535 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8536 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8537 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8538 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8539 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8540 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8541 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8542 differ only in their names.
8544 The value for a match will be the primary host name.
8548 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8549 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8550 .cindex "domain literal"
8551 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8552 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8553 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8554 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8555 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8556 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial;
8557 see the &%allow_domain_literals%& main option.
8559 The value for a match will be the string &`@[]`&.
8564 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8565 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8566 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8567 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8568 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8569 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8570 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8571 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8572 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8573 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8574 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8576 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8577 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8578 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8579 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8580 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8582 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8583 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8584 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8585 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8586 on a router). For example:
8588 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8590 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8591 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8593 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8594 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8595 contain negative items.
8597 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8598 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8599 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8601 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8602 an.other.domain : ...
8604 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8605 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8607 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8608 an.other.domain ? ...
8610 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting &`@mx_`&).
8614 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8615 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8616 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8617 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8618 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8619 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8620 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8621 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8622 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8625 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the asterisk).
8626 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the matched string
8627 and &$1$& to the variable portion which the asterisk matched.
8630 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8631 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8632 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8633 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8634 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8635 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8636 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8637 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8638 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8640 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8641 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8642 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8643 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8644 expression by expansion, of course).
8646 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the circumflex).
8647 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the string matching the regular expression,
8648 and &$1$& (onwards) to any submatches identified by parentheses.
8653 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8654 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8655 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8656 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8657 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8658 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8660 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8662 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8663 key. In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used; Exim is interested
8664 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8665 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8666 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the value is preserved in the
8667 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8668 other statements in the same ACL.
8669 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8670 .cindex "de-tainting" "using ACL domains condition"
8671 The value will be untainted.
8673 &*Note*&: If the data result of the lookup (as opposed to the key)
8674 is empty, then this empty value is stored in &$domain_data$&.
8675 The option to return the key for the lookup, as the value,
8676 may be what is wanted.
8680 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8681 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8683 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8685 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8686 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8689 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8690 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8691 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8692 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8693 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8694 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8698 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8699 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8700 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8701 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8703 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8704 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8706 In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8707 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8708 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8709 &%domains%& option on a router, the value is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8710 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8711 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8712 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
8713 The value will be untainted.
8716 If the pattern starts with the name of a lookup type
8717 of either kind (single-key or query-style) it may be
8718 followed by a comma and options,
8719 The options are lookup-type specific and consist of a comma-separated list.
8720 Each item starts with a tag and and equals "=" sign.
8723 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8724 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8725 between the pattern and the domain.
8727 The value for a match will be the list element string.
8728 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8729 Note that this is commonly untainted
8730 (depending on the way the list was created).
8731 Specifically, explicit text in the configuration file in not tainted.
8732 This is a useful way of obtaining an untainted equivalent to
8733 the domain, for later operations.
8735 However if the list (including one-element lists)
8736 is created by expanding a variable containing tainted data,
8737 it is tainted and so will the match value be.
8741 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8743 domainlist funny_domains = \
8746 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8747 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8748 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8749 nis;domains.byname : \
8750 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8752 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8753 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8754 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8755 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8756 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8761 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8762 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8763 .cindex "list" "host list"
8764 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8765 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8766 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8767 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8768 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8769 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8770 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8773 .subsection "Special host list patterns" SECID80
8774 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8775 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8776 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8777 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8778 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8781 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8782 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8783 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8787 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by IP address" SECThoslispatip
8788 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8789 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8790 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8791 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8792 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8793 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8796 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8797 inspecting its IP address:
8800 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8801 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8802 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8803 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8804 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8805 with the IP address of the subject host.
8807 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8808 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8809 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8810 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8811 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8814 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8815 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8816 domain name, as just described.
8819 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8820 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8821 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8822 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8823 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8824 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8825 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8826 that can never match a client host.
8829 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8830 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8831 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8832 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8834 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8838 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8839 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length, for
8844 , it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8845 host under the given mask. This allows an entire network of hosts to be
8846 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8847 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8848 significant end of the address.
8850 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8851 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8852 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8853 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8857 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8858 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8861 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8863 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8864 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8866 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8867 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8870 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8872 could make use of a file containing
8877 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8878 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8879 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8881 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8884 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8890 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8892 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8893 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8894 address, the pattern takes this form:
8896 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8900 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8902 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8903 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8904 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8905 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8906 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8907 returned by the lookup is not used.
8909 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8910 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8911 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8912 patterns of this form:
8914 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8918 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8920 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8921 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8922 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8923 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8924 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8926 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8927 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8928 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8929 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8930 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8931 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8932 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8933 converted using colons and not dots.
8934 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8935 addresses are always used.
8936 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8938 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8939 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8940 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8943 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8944 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8945 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8946 case the IP address is used on its own.
8950 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by host name" SECThoslispatnam
8951 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8952 .cindex "unknown host name"
8953 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8954 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8955 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8956 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8957 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8960 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8961 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8962 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8963 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8964 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8965 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8966 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8968 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8969 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8971 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8972 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8973 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8974 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8975 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8976 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8977 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8978 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8979 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8981 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8982 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8984 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8985 .cindex "alias for host"
8986 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8987 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8990 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8991 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8992 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8993 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8994 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8997 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8998 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8999 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
9000 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
9001 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
9002 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
9003 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
9008 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
9009 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
9010 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
9011 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
9012 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9014 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
9016 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
9017 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
9018 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
9025 .subsection "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" SECTbehipnot
9026 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
9027 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
9028 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
9029 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
9030 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
9032 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
9033 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
9035 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
9036 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
9037 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
9038 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
9039 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
9040 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
9041 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
9042 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
9043 not recognized in an indirected file).
9046 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
9047 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
9049 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
9051 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
9052 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
9055 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
9056 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
9059 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
9062 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
9063 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
9064 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
9067 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
9068 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
9071 .subsection "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
9073 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
9075 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
9076 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
9077 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
9080 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
9081 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
9082 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
9084 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
9086 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
9087 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
9088 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
9089 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
9090 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
9091 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
9092 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
9095 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
9096 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
9098 accept hosts = *.friend.example
9099 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
9101 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
9102 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
9103 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
9108 .subsection "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
9110 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
9111 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
9112 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
9113 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
9114 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
9115 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
9116 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
9117 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
9118 host lists such as whitelists.
9122 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
9124 .cindex "unknown host name"
9125 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9126 If a pattern is of the form
9128 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
9132 dbm;/host/accept/list
9134 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
9135 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
9138 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
9139 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
9140 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
9141 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
9142 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
9143 lookup, both using the same file.
9147 .subsection "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" SECID81
9148 If a pattern is of the form
9150 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
9152 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
9153 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
9154 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
9156 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
9157 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
9159 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
9160 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
9161 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
9164 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
9165 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
9166 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
9168 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
9169 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
9170 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
9171 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
9172 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
9173 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
9179 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
9180 .cindex "list" "address list"
9181 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
9182 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
9183 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9184 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9185 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9186 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9187 using this option setting:
9191 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9192 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9193 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9194 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9196 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9199 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9201 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9202 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9203 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9204 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9205 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9206 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9207 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9209 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9210 *@+hostile_domains:\
9211 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9212 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9214 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9215 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9216 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9217 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9218 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9220 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9221 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9222 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9223 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9224 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9226 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9229 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9230 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9234 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9235 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9236 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9237 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9238 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9239 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9240 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9242 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9243 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9245 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9246 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9249 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9250 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9251 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9254 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9255 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9256 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9258 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9259 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9260 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9261 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9263 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9264 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9266 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9267 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9268 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9269 default. For example, with this lookup:
9271 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9273 the file could contains lines like this:
9275 user1@domain1.example
9278 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9281 nimrod@jaeger.example
9285 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9286 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9288 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9290 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9291 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9293 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9294 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9295 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9299 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9300 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9305 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9306 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9307 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9308 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9309 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9310 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9311 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9312 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9313 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9315 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9316 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9317 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9318 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9319 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9322 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9324 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9326 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9328 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9330 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9331 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9332 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9333 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9334 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9335 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9337 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9340 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9343 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9344 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9345 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9346 might have entries like
9348 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9349 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9352 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9353 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9354 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9355 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9357 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9358 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9359 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9362 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9363 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9364 can only return a single list of local parts.
9367 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9368 in these two examples:
9371 senders = *@+my_list
9373 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9374 example it is a named domain list.
9379 .subsection "Case of letters in address lists" SECTcasletadd
9380 .cindex "case of local parts"
9381 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9382 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9383 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9384 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9385 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9386 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9387 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9388 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9391 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9392 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9393 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9394 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9395 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9396 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9397 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9400 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9401 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9402 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9403 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9404 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9405 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9406 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9407 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9411 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9412 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9413 .cindex "local part" "list"
9414 These behave in the same way as domain and host lists, with the following
9417 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9418 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9419 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9420 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9421 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9422 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9423 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9424 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9426 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9427 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9428 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9429 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9430 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9431 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9432 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9434 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9439 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9440 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9442 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9443 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9444 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9445 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9447 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9448 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9449 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9450 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9451 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9452 escape character, as described in the following section.
9454 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9455 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9456 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9457 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9458 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9460 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9461 .cindex "tainted data" definition
9462 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9463 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9464 is not permitted (including acessing a file using a tainted name).
9466 Common ways of obtaining untainted equivalents of variables with
9468 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
9469 come down to using the tainted value as a lookup key in a trusted database.
9470 This database could be the filesystem structure,
9471 or the password file,
9472 or accessed via a DBMS.
9473 Specific methods are indexed under &"de-tainting"&.
9477 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9478 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9479 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9480 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9481 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9482 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9483 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9484 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9486 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9487 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9488 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9489 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9491 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9493 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9494 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9499 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9500 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9501 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9502 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9503 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9504 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9505 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9508 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9509 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9510 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9513 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9514 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9515 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9517 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9518 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9519 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9520 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9521 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9522 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9523 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9527 When reading lines from the standard input,
9528 macros can be defined and ACL variables can be set.
9532 set acl_m_myvar = bar
9534 Such macros and variables can then be used in later input lines.
9537 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9538 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9539 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9542 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9543 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9544 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9545 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9547 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9549 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9550 Exim message identifier. For example:
9552 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9554 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9555 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9558 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9559 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9560 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9561 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9562 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9563 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9564 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9565 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9566 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9567 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9568 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9569 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9575 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9576 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9577 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9578 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9579 white space is significant.
9582 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9583 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9584 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9589 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9590 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9591 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9592 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9593 given, the expansion fails.
9595 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9596 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9597 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9598 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9602 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9603 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9604 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9605 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9606 string easier to understand.
9608 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9609 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9610 expansion item below.
9613 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9614 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9615 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9616 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9617 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9618 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9619 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9620 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9621 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9622 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9623 the result of the expansion.
9624 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9625 the expansion result is an empty string.
9626 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9629 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9630 .cindex authentication "results header"
9631 .chindex Authentication-Results:
9632 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9633 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9634 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9636 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9637 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9638 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9647 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9649 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9651 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9654 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9655 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9656 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9657 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9658 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9659 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9660 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9661 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9665 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9666 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9671 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9675 If the field is found,
9676 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9677 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9678 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9679 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9681 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9682 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9685 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9687 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9688 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9690 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9691 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9692 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9693 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9694 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9695 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9696 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9697 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9699 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9700 take an optional modifier of "int"
9701 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9702 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9703 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9705 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9706 newline-separated by default,
9707 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9708 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9709 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9711 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9712 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9713 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9714 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9715 if so the element tags are omitted.
9717 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9719 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9720 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9722 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9723 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9727 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9728 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9729 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9731 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9734 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9735 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9736 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9737 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9738 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9739 must have the following type:
9741 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9743 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9744 function should return one of the following values:
9746 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9747 into the expanded string that is being built.
9749 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9750 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9752 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9753 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9755 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9757 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9758 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9759 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9762 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9763 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9764 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9765 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9767 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9768 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9769 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9771 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9772 appear, for example:
9774 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9776 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9777 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9779 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9781 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9784 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9785 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9788 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9789 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9790 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9791 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9792 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9793 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9794 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9795 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9797 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9800 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9801 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9802 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9803 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9804 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9805 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9806 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9807 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9808 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9810 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9811 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9812 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9815 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9816 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9818 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9819 appear, for example:
9821 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9823 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9824 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9826 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9827 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9828 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9829 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9830 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9831 .cindex JSON expansions
9832 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9833 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9834 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9835 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9837 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9840 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9841 the spaces are optional.
9842 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9843 For the &"json"& variant,
9844 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9846 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9847 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9848 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9850 The results of matching are handled as above.
9853 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9854 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9855 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9856 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9857 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9858 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9859 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9860 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9861 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9862 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9863 <&'string3'&> as before.
9865 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9866 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9867 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9868 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9869 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9870 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9871 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9872 provided. For example:
9874 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9878 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9880 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9881 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9884 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9885 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9886 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9887 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9888 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9889 .cindex JSON expansions
9890 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9891 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9893 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9894 there is no choice of field separator.
9895 For the &"json"& variant,
9896 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9898 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9899 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9902 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9903 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9904 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9906 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9907 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9909 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9912 Any modification of &$value$& by this evaluation is discarded.
9914 If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9915 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9916 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9917 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9919 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9921 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9922 to what it was before.
9923 See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
9926 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9927 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9928 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9929 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9930 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9931 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9933 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9934 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9935 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9936 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9938 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9940 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9941 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9942 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9943 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9944 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9946 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9948 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9949 letters appear. For example:
9951 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9952 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9953 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9956 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9957 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9958 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9959 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9960 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9961 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9962 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9963 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9964 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9965 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9966 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9967 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9968 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9969 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9970 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9971 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9972 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9976 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9977 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9978 lines) may be present.
9980 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9981 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9984 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9985 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9986 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9989 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9990 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9991 are multiple headers with a given name.
9992 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9993 list-processing facilities can be used.
9994 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9995 the content is &"raw"&.
9998 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9999 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
10000 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
10001 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
10002 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
10003 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
10004 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
10005 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
10008 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
10009 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
10010 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
10011 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
10012 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
10013 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
10016 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
10017 command of the following form:
10019 headers charset "UTF-8"
10021 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
10022 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
10023 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
10024 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
10025 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
10028 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
10029 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
10030 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
10031 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
10033 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
10034 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
10035 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
10036 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
10037 router or transport are not accessible.
10039 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
10040 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
10041 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
10042 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
10043 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
10044 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
10045 point they are added.
10046 When any of the above ACLs are
10047 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
10049 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
10050 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
10051 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
10052 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
10053 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
10054 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
10055 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
10058 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
10059 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
10060 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
10061 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
10062 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
10063 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
10064 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
10065 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
10067 .cindex "tainted data" "message headers"
10068 When the headers are from an incoming message,
10069 the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
10072 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10073 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
10075 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
10076 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
10077 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
10078 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
10079 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
10080 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
10081 present. For example:
10083 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
10085 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
10088 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
10090 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
10091 an Exim configuration:
10093 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
10095 In a router or a transport you could then have:
10098 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
10099 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
10100 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
10102 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
10103 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
10104 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
10105 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
10106 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
10107 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
10110 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10111 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
10112 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
10113 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
10114 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
10115 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
10117 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
10119 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
10120 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
10121 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
10122 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
10123 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
10125 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
10126 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
10127 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
10129 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
10133 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
10138 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
10139 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
10140 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
10141 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
10142 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
10143 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
10147 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10148 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10149 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10150 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
10151 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
10152 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
10153 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
10154 some of the braces:
10156 ${length_<n>:<string>}
10158 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
10159 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
10160 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
10161 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10164 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
10165 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10166 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
10167 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
10168 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
10169 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10170 apart from an optional leading minus,
10171 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
10173 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10174 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10176 The first field of the list is numbered one.
10177 If the number is negative, the fields are
10178 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
10179 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
10180 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
10182 If the modulus of the
10183 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
10184 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
10188 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
10192 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
10194 yields &"result: 42"&.
10196 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
10197 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10199 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
10202 .vitem &*${listquote{*&<&'separator'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10203 .cindex quoting "for list"
10204 .cindex list quoting
10205 This item doubles any occurrence of the separator character
10206 in the given string.
10207 An empty string is replaced with a single space.
10208 This converts the string into a safe form for use as a list element,
10209 in a list using the given separator.
10212 .vitem "&*${lookup&~{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
10213 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10214 "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10215 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10216 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10217 .cindex "file" "lookups"
10218 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10219 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10220 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10221 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10222 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10224 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10225 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10226 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10227 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10228 out by the system administrator.
10230 .vindex "&$value$&"
10231 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10232 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10233 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10234 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10235 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10236 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10237 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10238 original lookup fails.
10240 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10241 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10242 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10243 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10244 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10245 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10246 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10247 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10249 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10250 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10251 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10252 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10254 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10255 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10256 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10257 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10259 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10261 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10263 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10264 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10266 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10271 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10272 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10274 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10275 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10277 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10278 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10279 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10280 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10282 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10284 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10285 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10286 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10288 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10289 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10290 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10291 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10292 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10293 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10294 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10296 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10298 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10299 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10300 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10301 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10304 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10306 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10310 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10311 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10312 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10313 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10314 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10315 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10316 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10317 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10319 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10320 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the entire expansion is
10321 forced to fail, in the same way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item
10322 does (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). Whatever you return is evaluated
10323 in a scalar context, thus the return value is a scalar. For example, if you
10324 return a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10327 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10328 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10329 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10331 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10332 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10335 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10336 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10337 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10338 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10339 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10340 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10341 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10342 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10344 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10345 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10346 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10347 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10348 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10349 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10350 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10351 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10352 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10353 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10355 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10356 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10357 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10358 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10360 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10361 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10362 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10363 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10364 is the expansion of the third argument.
10366 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10367 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10368 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10370 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10371 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10372 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10373 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10374 The filename and end-of-line (eol) string are first expanded separately. The file is
10375 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10376 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10377 newlines are left in the string.
10378 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10379 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10380 the string expansion fails.
10382 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10383 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10387 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10388 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10389 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10390 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10391 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10392 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10393 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10396 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10397 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10399 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10400 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10401 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10402 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10403 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10406 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10408 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10409 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10410 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10411 (unless it is an empty string; no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10412 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10413 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10414 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10416 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10419 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10420 and must be present if any options are given.
10421 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10424 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10427 The following option names are recognised:
10430 Defines if the result data can be cached for use by a later identical
10431 request in the same process.
10432 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10433 If not, all cached results for this connection specification
10434 will be invalidated.
10438 Defines whether or not a write-shutdown is done on the connection after
10439 sending the request. Values are &"yes"& (the default) or &"no"&
10440 (preferred, eg. by some webservers).
10444 Controls the use of TLS on the connection.
10445 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10446 If it is enabled, a shutdown as described above is never done.
10450 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10451 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10452 turns them into spaces:
10454 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10456 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10457 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10458 addition, the following errors can occur:
10461 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10463 Failure to connect the socket;
10465 Failure to write the request string;
10467 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10470 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10471 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10472 errors occurs. For example:
10474 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10477 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10478 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10479 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10480 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10481 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10483 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10484 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10487 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10488 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10489 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10490 .vindex "&$value$&"
10492 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10493 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10494 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10495 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10496 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10497 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10498 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10499 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10500 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10501 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10503 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10505 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10508 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10510 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10511 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10514 . A bit of a special-case logic error in writing an expansion;
10515 . probably not worth including in the mainline of documentation.
10516 . If only we had footnotes (the html output variant is the problem).
10519 . &*Note*&: if an &'expansion condition'& is used in <&'string3'&>
10520 . and that condition modifies &$value$&,
10521 . then the string expansions dependent on the condition cannot use
10522 . the &$value$& of the reduce iteration.
10525 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10526 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10527 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10529 .vitem "&*${run <&'options'&> {*&<&'command&~arg&~list'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10530 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10531 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10532 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10533 This item runs an external command, as a subprocess.
10534 One option is supported after the word &'run'&, comma-separated.
10536 If the option &'preexpand'& is not used,
10537 the command string is split into individual arguments by spaces
10538 and then each argument is expanded.
10539 Then the command is run
10540 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10541 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10542 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10543 The command name may not be tainted, but the remaining arguments can be.
10545 &*Note*&: if tainted arguments are used, they are supplied by a
10546 potential attacker;
10547 a careful assessment for security vulnerabilities should be done.
10549 If the option &'preexpand'& is used,
10550 the command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The result is
10551 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10553 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10554 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10555 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10556 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10557 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10558 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10559 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10560 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10561 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10563 Neither the command nor any argument may be tainted.
10565 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10566 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10567 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10568 .vindex "&$value$&"
10569 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10570 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10571 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10572 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10573 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10576 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10577 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10578 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10579 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10581 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10582 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10583 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10586 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10587 log_message = Output of id: $value
10589 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10590 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10592 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10595 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10596 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10597 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10599 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10600 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10604 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10605 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10608 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10609 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10610 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10611 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10613 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10614 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10617 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10618 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10619 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10620 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10621 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10622 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10623 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10624 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10626 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10628 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10629 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10630 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10632 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10634 yields &"defabc"&, and
10636 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10638 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10639 the regular expression from string expansion.
10641 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10642 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10645 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10646 .cindex sorting "a list"
10647 .cindex list sorting
10648 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10649 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10650 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10651 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10652 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10653 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10654 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10655 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10656 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10657 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10658 to give values for comparison.
10660 The item result is a sorted list,
10661 with the original list separator,
10662 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10666 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10668 sorts a list of numbers, and
10670 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10672 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10676 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
10677 SRS encoding. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
10681 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'start'&>&*}{*&<&'len'&>&*}{*&<&'subject'&>&*}}*&
10682 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10683 .cindex "substring extraction"
10684 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10685 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10686 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10687 if <&'start'&> and <&'len'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10688 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10690 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<subject>}
10692 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10693 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10696 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10697 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10698 length required. For example
10700 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10702 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10703 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10704 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10705 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10707 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10708 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10709 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10711 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10713 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10714 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10715 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10717 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10719 yields an empty string, but
10721 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10725 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10726 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10727 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10728 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10731 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10733 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10735 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10739 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10740 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10741 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10742 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10743 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10744 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10745 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10746 replacement list. For example
10748 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10750 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10751 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10752 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10755 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10761 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10762 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10763 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10764 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10765 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10766 following operations can be performed:
10769 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10770 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10771 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10772 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10773 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10774 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10776 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10779 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10780 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10781 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10782 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10783 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10784 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10785 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10786 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10787 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10789 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10790 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10791 character. For example:
10793 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10795 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10796 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10797 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10798 separator explicitly:
10800 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10803 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10804 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10805 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10808 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10809 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10810 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10811 email address separator. For the example header line:
10813 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10815 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10816 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10817 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10818 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10819 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10820 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10821 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10823 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10824 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10826 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10827 Last:user@example.com
10828 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10830 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10834 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10835 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10836 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10837 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10838 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10839 Only lowercase letters are used.
10841 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10842 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10843 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10844 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10845 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10847 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10848 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10849 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10850 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10851 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10852 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10853 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10854 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10855 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10857 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10858 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10859 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10860 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10861 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10862 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10865 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10866 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10867 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10868 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10869 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10870 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10872 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10873 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10876 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10877 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10878 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10879 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10880 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10883 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10884 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10885 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10886 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10887 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10890 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10891 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10892 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10893 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10894 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10895 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10896 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10898 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10899 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10900 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10901 If the string contains any characters with the most significant bit set,
10902 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10903 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10906 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10907 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10908 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10909 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10910 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10911 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10912 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10913 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10914 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10915 C programming language):
10917 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10918 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10919 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10920 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10921 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10923 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10925 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10926 space is permitted before or after operators.
10928 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10929 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10930 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10931 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10932 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10934 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10936 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10937 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10940 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10941 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10942 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10943 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10944 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10945 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10946 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10947 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10948 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10949 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10950 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10953 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10957 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10960 {$recipients_count} \
10961 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10964 message = Too many bad recipients
10966 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10967 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10970 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10971 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10972 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10975 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10977 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10978 and then re-expands what it has found.
10981 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10983 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10984 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10985 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10986 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10987 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10988 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10989 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10990 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10991 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10993 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10994 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10995 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10996 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10997 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10998 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10999 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
11002 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11003 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
11004 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
11005 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
11006 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
11007 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11009 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11011 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
11012 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
11016 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
11017 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
11018 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
11019 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
11020 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
11021 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
11025 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11026 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
11027 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
11028 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
11029 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
11030 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
11031 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
11034 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11035 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
11036 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11037 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
11038 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
11039 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11040 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11042 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11043 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
11044 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11045 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
11046 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
11047 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
11048 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
11049 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11050 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11053 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11054 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11055 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11056 .cindex "lower casing"
11057 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11058 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
11059 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
11063 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11065 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11066 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
11067 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
11068 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
11069 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
11070 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
11072 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
11074 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
11075 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
11076 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
11077 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11080 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11081 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
11082 .cindex "list" "item count"
11083 .cindex "list" "count of items"
11084 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
11085 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
11088 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
11089 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
11090 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
11091 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
11092 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
11093 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
11094 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
11095 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
11096 matching list is returned.
11097 &*Note*&: Neither string-expansion of lists referenced by named-list syntax elements,
11098 nor expansion of lookup elements, is done by the &%listnamed%& operator.
11101 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11102 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
11103 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
11104 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
11105 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
11107 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11110 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*& &&&
11111 &*${mask_n:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
11112 .cindex "masked IP address"
11113 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
11114 .cindex "CIDR notation"
11115 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
11116 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
11117 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
11118 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
11119 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
11120 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
11121 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
11123 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
11125 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&.
11127 Since this operation is expected to
11128 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the
11131 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
11132 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
11134 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
11138 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
11140 If the optional form &*mask_n*& is used, IPv6 address result are instead
11141 returned in normailsed form, using colons and with zero-compression.
11142 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
11145 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11147 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
11148 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11149 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
11150 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
11151 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
11153 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11154 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11157 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11158 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
11159 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
11160 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
11161 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
11162 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11164 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11166 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
11169 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11170 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
11171 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
11172 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
11173 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
11174 is an empty string or
11175 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
11176 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
11177 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
11178 respectively For example,
11186 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
11187 variable or a message header.
11189 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11190 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
11191 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
11192 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
11193 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
11194 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
11195 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
11197 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
11198 will likely use the quoting form.
11199 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
11202 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11203 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
11204 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
11205 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
11206 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
11208 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
11214 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
11215 yields an unchanged string.
11218 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
11219 .cindex "random number"
11220 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
11221 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
11222 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
11223 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
11224 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
11225 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
11226 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
11227 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
11231 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
11232 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
11233 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
11234 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
11235 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
11236 for DNS. For example,
11238 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
11239 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
11244 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
11248 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11249 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11250 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
11251 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
11252 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
11253 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
11254 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
11255 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
11256 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
11259 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
11261 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
11262 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
11266 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11267 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11268 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
11269 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
11270 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
11271 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11272 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11273 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11275 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11276 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11277 to use this operator as well.
11281 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11282 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11283 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11284 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11285 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11286 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11287 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11290 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11291 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11292 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11293 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11294 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11295 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11296 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11298 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11299 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11302 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11303 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11304 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11305 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11306 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11307 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11308 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11309 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11310 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11311 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11313 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11315 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11316 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11318 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11319 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11320 Finally, if an underbar
11321 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11322 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11323 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11326 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11327 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11328 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11329 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11330 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11331 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11333 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11335 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11336 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11337 with 256 being the default.
11339 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11340 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11341 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11342 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11345 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11346 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11347 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11348 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11349 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11350 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11351 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11352 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11353 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11354 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11355 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11356 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11357 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11359 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11360 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11361 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11363 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11364 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11365 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11369 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11370 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11371 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11372 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11373 The item is replaced by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11374 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11375 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11378 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11379 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11380 .cindex "substring extraction"
11381 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11382 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11383 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11384 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11386 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11388 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11389 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11390 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11392 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11393 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11394 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11395 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11398 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11399 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11400 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11401 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11402 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11403 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11406 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11407 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11408 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11409 .cindex "upper casing"
11410 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11411 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11412 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11413 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11415 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11416 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11417 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11418 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11419 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11420 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11421 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11422 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11423 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11424 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11425 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11426 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11427 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11428 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11430 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11432 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11433 literal question mark).
11435 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11436 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11437 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11438 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11439 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11440 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11442 .cindex internationalisation
11443 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11444 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11445 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11446 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11447 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11448 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11456 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11457 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11458 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11459 while expanding strings:
11462 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11463 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11464 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11465 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11468 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11469 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11470 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11471 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11473 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
11475 .irow "== " "equal"
11476 .irow "> " "greater"
11477 .irow ">= " "greater or equal"
11479 .irow "<= " "less or equal"
11483 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11485 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11486 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11487 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11488 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11489 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11492 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11493 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11494 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11497 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11498 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11499 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11500 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11501 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11502 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11503 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11504 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11505 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11506 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11507 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11508 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11509 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11510 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11512 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11513 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11514 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11515 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11516 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11517 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11519 An empty string is treated as false.
11520 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11521 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11522 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11524 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11525 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11528 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11532 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11533 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11534 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11535 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11536 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11537 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11538 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11539 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11541 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11543 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11544 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11545 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11546 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11547 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11548 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11549 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11550 included in the binary.
11552 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11553 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11554 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11555 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11556 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11557 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11558 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11559 string in LDAP form is:
11561 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11563 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11564 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11566 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11568 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11573 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11574 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11575 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11576 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11577 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11578 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11582 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11583 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11584 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11585 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11586 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11587 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11590 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11591 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11592 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11593 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11594 whatever its length.
11597 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11598 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11599 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11600 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11602 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11603 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11604 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11605 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11606 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11607 support &[crypt16()]&.
11609 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11610 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11611 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11612 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11613 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11615 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11616 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11617 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11619 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11620 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11621 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11622 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11623 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11625 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11626 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11627 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11628 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11629 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11630 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11632 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11634 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11635 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11637 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11638 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11639 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11640 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11641 exists in the message. For example,
11643 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11645 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11646 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11648 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11649 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11650 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11651 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11652 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11653 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11654 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11655 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11656 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11657 case is defined per the system C locale.
11659 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11660 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11661 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11662 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11663 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11664 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11665 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11666 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11668 &*Note:*& Testing a path using this condition is not a sufficient way of
11670 Consider using a dsearch lookup.
11672 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11673 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11674 .cindex "first delivery"
11675 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11676 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11677 .cindex retry condition
11678 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11679 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11682 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11683 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11684 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11685 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11686 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11688 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11689 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11690 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11691 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11692 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11693 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11695 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11696 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11697 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11699 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11700 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11701 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11703 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11704 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11705 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11706 list separator is changed to a comma:
11708 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11710 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11711 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11713 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11715 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11716 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11717 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11718 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11719 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11720 .cindex JSON expansions
11721 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11722 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11723 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11724 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11725 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11727 The array separator is not changeable.
11728 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11729 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11733 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11734 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11735 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11736 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11737 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11738 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11739 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11740 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11741 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11743 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11745 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11746 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11747 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11748 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11749 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11750 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11751 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11752 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11753 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11755 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11758 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
11759 SRS decode. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
11762 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11763 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11764 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11765 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11766 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11767 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11769 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11771 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11772 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11774 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11775 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11776 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11777 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11780 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
11781 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
11782 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
11783 .cindex "de-tainting" "using an inlist expansion condition"
11784 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
11786 ${if inlist {$h_mycode:} {0 : 1 : 42} {$value}}
11788 can be used for de-tainting.
11789 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
11792 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11793 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11794 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11795 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11796 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11797 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11798 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11799 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11800 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11801 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11802 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11804 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11805 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11806 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11807 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11808 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11810 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11811 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11813 This is no longer the case.
11815 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11816 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11818 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11820 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11822 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11823 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11824 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11825 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11826 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11827 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11828 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11829 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11830 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11831 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11832 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11833 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11834 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11838 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11839 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11840 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11841 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11842 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11843 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11844 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11845 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11846 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11848 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11850 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11851 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11852 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11853 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11854 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11855 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11856 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11857 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11858 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11860 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11863 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11864 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11865 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11866 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11867 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11868 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11869 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11870 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11871 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11872 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11873 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11876 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11878 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11879 backslashes is also required.
11881 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11882 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11883 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11884 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11885 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11886 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11887 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11888 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11890 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11891 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11892 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11893 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11894 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11895 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11896 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11897 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11899 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11900 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11901 See &*match_local_part*&.
11903 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11904 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11905 See &*match_local_part*&.
11907 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11908 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11909 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11910 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11911 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11912 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11914 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11916 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11919 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11921 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11923 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11924 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11925 in a single test such as
11926 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11927 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11928 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11929 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11931 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11933 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11935 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11937 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11938 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11939 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11940 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11941 masks. For example:
11943 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11945 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11946 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11947 address mask, for example:
11949 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11951 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11952 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11954 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11958 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11959 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11961 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11963 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11964 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11965 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11966 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11967 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11968 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11969 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11970 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11973 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11975 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11976 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11977 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11978 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11980 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11982 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11983 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11984 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11985 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11988 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
11989 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
11990 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
11991 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a match_local_part expansion condition"
11992 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
11994 ${if match_local_part {$local_part} {alice : bill : charlotte : dave} {$value}}
11996 can be used for de-tainting.
11997 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
11999 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12000 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12002 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
12003 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
12004 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
12005 matched using &%match_ip%&.
12007 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
12008 .cindex "PAM authentication"
12009 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
12010 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
12011 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
12012 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
12013 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
12014 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
12015 available in Solaris
12016 and in some GNU/Linux distributions.
12017 The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
12018 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
12022 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
12023 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
12025 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
12026 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
12027 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
12028 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
12029 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
12030 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
12031 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
12033 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
12034 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
12036 The &%listquote%& expansion item can be used for this.
12037 For example, the configuration
12038 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
12040 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${listquote{:}{$auth2}}}}
12042 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
12043 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
12044 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
12045 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
12048 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12049 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
12051 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
12052 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
12053 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
12054 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
12055 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
12056 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
12058 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12059 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12060 building Exim. For example:
12062 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
12064 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12065 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12066 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
12067 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
12069 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
12070 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
12071 configuration, you might have this:
12073 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
12075 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
12077 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
12079 .vitem &*queue_running*&
12080 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
12081 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
12082 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
12083 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
12084 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
12087 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
12089 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
12090 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
12091 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
12092 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
12093 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
12096 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
12097 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
12098 this library, you need to set
12100 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
12102 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
12103 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
12105 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
12107 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
12108 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
12109 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
12111 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
12112 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
12113 the authentication is successful. For example:
12115 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
12119 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
12120 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
12121 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
12123 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
12124 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
12125 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
12126 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
12127 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
12128 by a process that is not running as root.
12130 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12131 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12132 building Exim. For example:
12134 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
12136 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12137 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12138 from the Cyrus SASL library.
12140 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
12141 two are mandatory. For example:
12143 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
12145 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
12146 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
12147 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
12152 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
12153 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
12154 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
12155 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
12156 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
12157 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
12158 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
12162 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12163 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
12164 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
12165 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12166 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
12169 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
12171 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
12172 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
12173 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
12175 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12176 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
12177 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
12178 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12179 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
12180 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
12181 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
12182 parsed but not evaluated.
12184 .ecindex IIDexpcond
12189 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
12190 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
12191 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
12192 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
12193 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
12194 .cindex "tainted data"
12195 Variables marked as &'tainted'& are likely to carry data supplied by
12196 a potential attacker.
12197 Variables without such marking may also, depending on how their
12198 values are created.
12199 Such variables should not be further expanded,
12201 or used as command-line arguments for external commands.
12204 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
12205 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
12206 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
12207 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
12208 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
12209 In the expansion condition case
12210 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
12211 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
12212 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
12213 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
12214 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
12215 matching condition.
12216 If the subject string was tainted then any captured substring will also be.
12218 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
12219 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12220 any arguments are copied to these variables,
12221 any unused variables being made empty.
12223 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
12224 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
12225 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
12226 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
12227 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
12228 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
12229 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
12230 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
12231 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
12232 during subsequent delivery.
12234 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
12235 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
12236 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
12237 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
12238 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
12239 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
12240 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
12241 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
12244 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
12245 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12246 this variable has the number of arguments.
12248 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
12249 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
12250 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
12251 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers of the verb.
12252 The message can be preserved by coding like this:
12254 warn !verify = sender
12255 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
12257 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
12258 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
12260 &*Note*&: The variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
12262 .vitem &$address_data$&
12263 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12264 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
12265 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
12266 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
12267 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
12268 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
12271 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
12272 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
12273 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
12274 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
12275 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
12276 from the child's routing.
12278 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12279 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
12280 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
12283 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
12284 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
12285 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
12287 .vitem &$address_file$&
12288 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
12289 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
12290 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
12291 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
12292 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
12294 /home/r2d2/savemail
12296 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
12297 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
12298 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
12299 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
12300 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
12301 to the relevant file.
12303 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
12304 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
12305 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
12306 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
12308 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth4$&"
12309 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
12310 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
12311 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12313 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12314 .cindex "authentication" "id"
12315 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12316 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12317 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12318 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12319 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12320 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12321 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12323 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12324 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12325 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12326 command line option.
12327 This second case also sets up information used by the
12328 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12330 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12331 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12332 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12333 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12334 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12335 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12336 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12337 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12338 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12342 .tvar &$authenticated_sender$&
12343 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12344 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
12345 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12346 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12347 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12348 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12349 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12350 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12351 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12353 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12354 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12355 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12356 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12357 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12360 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12361 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12362 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12363 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12364 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12365 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12366 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12367 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12368 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&).
12369 Failure includes cancellation of a authentication attempt,
12370 and any negative response to an AUTH command,
12371 (including, for example, an attempt to use an undefined mechanism).
12373 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12374 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12375 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12376 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12377 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12378 the ACL malware condition.
12380 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12381 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12382 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12383 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12384 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12385 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12387 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12388 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12389 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12390 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12391 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12392 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12393 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12395 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12396 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12397 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12398 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12399 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12401 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12402 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12403 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12404 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12405 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12407 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12408 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12409 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12410 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12411 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12412 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12413 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12415 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12416 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12417 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12418 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12419 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12420 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12421 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12423 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12424 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12425 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12426 address that was connected to.
12428 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12429 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12430 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12431 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12432 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12434 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12435 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12436 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12437 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12438 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12439 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12441 .vitem &$config_file$&
12442 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12443 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12445 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12446 Results of DKIM verification.
12447 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12449 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12450 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12451 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12452 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12453 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12455 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12456 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12457 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12458 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12459 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12460 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12461 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12462 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12463 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12464 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12465 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12466 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12467 &$dkim_key_length$&
12468 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12469 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12471 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12472 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12473 When a message has been received this variable contains
12474 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12475 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12477 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12478 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12479 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12480 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12481 Results of DMARC verification.
12482 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12484 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12485 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12486 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12488 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12489 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12490 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12491 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12492 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12493 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12494 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12495 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12496 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12499 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12500 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12501 case for &$domain$&.
12503 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12504 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12505 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12506 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12508 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12509 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12510 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12511 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12512 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12513 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12515 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12516 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12517 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12519 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12522 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12523 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12524 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12525 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12526 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12527 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12528 the &(smtp)& transport.
12531 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12532 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12533 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12534 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12537 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12538 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12539 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12540 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12541 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12542 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12545 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12546 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12547 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12548 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12551 .cindex "tainted data"
12552 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12553 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and may not
12554 be further expanded or used as a filename.
12555 When an untainted version is needed, one should be obtained from
12556 looking up the value in a local (therefore trusted) database.
12557 Often &$domain_data$& is usable in this role.
12560 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12561 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12562 When the &%domains%& condition on a router
12565 against a list, the match value is copied to &$domain_data$&.
12566 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12567 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12568 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12570 If the router routes the
12571 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12572 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12575 &$domain_data$& set in an ACL is available during
12576 the rest of the ACL statement.
12578 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12579 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12580 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12582 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12583 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12584 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12586 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12587 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12588 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12590 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12591 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12592 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12593 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12594 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12595 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12596 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12598 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12600 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12601 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12602 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12603 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12604 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12606 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12607 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12608 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12609 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12610 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12614 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12615 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12616 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12617 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12618 by a setting on the transport itself.
12620 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12621 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12622 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12626 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12627 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12628 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12629 to local and remote transports.
12631 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12632 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12633 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12634 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12635 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12636 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12637 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12640 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12641 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12642 client is connected.
12645 .vitem &$host_address$&
12646 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12647 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12648 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12649 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12651 .vitem &$host_data$&
12652 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12653 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12654 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12655 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12657 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12658 message = $host_data
12661 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12662 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12663 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12664 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12665 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12666 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12667 variables is set to &"1"&.
12670 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12671 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12674 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12675 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12676 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12679 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12680 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12681 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12682 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12683 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12684 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12685 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12686 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12687 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12688 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12690 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12691 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12692 &%authresults%& expansion item.
12695 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12696 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12697 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12699 .vitem &$host_port$&
12700 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12701 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12702 for an outbound connection.
12704 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12705 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12706 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12707 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12708 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12709 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12712 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12713 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12714 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12715 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12716 a unique name for the file.
12718 .vitem &$interface_address$& &&&
12720 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12721 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12722 These are obsolete names for &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12726 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12727 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12728 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12732 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12733 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12734 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12737 .vitem &$load_average$&
12738 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12739 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12740 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12741 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12743 .tvar &$local_part$&
12744 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12745 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12746 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12747 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12749 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12750 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12751 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12752 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12755 .cindex "tainted data"
12756 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12757 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and
12758 may not be further expanded or used as a filename.
12760 &*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
12762 Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12764 This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12765 For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
12766 &$local_part_data$& variable rather than this one.
12767 For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12768 which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12769 rather than this variable.
12770 Often &$local_part_data$& is usable in this role.
12771 If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
12772 the retrieved data.
12774 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12775 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12776 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12779 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12780 local part of the recipient address.
12782 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12783 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12784 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12786 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12789 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12790 abc\:xyz@test.example
12792 the value of &$local_part$& is
12796 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12797 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12800 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12802 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12803 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12804 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12806 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12807 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12808 When the &%local_parts%& condition on a router or ACL
12809 matches a local part list
12810 the match value is copied to &$local_part_data$&.
12811 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12812 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12813 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12815 The &%check_local_user%& router option also sets this variable.
12817 .vindex &$local_part_prefix$& &&&
12818 &$local_part_prefix_v$& &&&
12819 &$local_part_suffix$& &&&
12820 &$local_part_suffix_v$&
12821 .cindex affix variables
12822 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12823 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12824 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12825 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12826 .cindex "tainted data"
12827 If the specification did not include a wildcard then
12828 the affix variable value is not tainted.
12830 If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
12831 the affix matched by the wildcard is in
12832 &$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate,
12833 and both the whole and varying values are tainted.
12835 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12836 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12837 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12838 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12840 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12841 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12842 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12844 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12845 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12846 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12847 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12848 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12849 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12850 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12851 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12853 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12854 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12855 This contains the expanded value of the
12856 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12859 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12860 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12861 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12862 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12863 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12864 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12866 .vitem &$log_space$&
12867 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12868 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12869 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12870 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12871 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12872 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12875 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12876 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12877 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12878 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12879 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12880 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12881 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12882 and &"yes"& if it was.
12883 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12884 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12885 as authenticated data.
12887 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12888 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12889 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12890 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12891 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12892 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12893 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12896 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12897 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12898 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12899 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12900 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12902 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12903 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12904 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12905 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12906 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12907 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12909 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
12911 .vitem &$message_age$&
12912 .cindex "message" "age of"
12913 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12914 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12915 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12918 .tvar &$message_body$&
12919 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12920 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12921 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12922 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12923 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12924 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12925 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12926 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12928 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12929 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12930 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12931 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12932 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12934 .tvar &$message_body_end$&
12935 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12936 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12937 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12938 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12941 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12942 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12943 .cindex "message body" "size"
12944 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12945 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12946 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12947 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12948 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12950 If the spool file is wireformat
12951 (see the &%spool_wireformat%& main option)
12952 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12954 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12955 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12956 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12957 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12958 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12959 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12960 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12961 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12963 .tvar &$message_headers$&
12964 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12965 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12966 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12967 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12969 .tvar &$message_headers_raw$&
12970 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12971 contents of header lines is done.
12973 .vitem &$message_id$&
12974 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12976 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12977 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12978 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12979 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12980 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12981 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12982 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12983 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12984 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12985 from the body is not counted.
12987 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12988 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12989 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12990 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12991 header and the body).
12993 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12996 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12997 message = Too many lines in message header
12999 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
13000 message has not yet been received.
13002 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13004 .vitem &$message_size$&
13005 .cindex "size" "of message"
13006 .cindex "message" "size"
13007 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
13008 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
13009 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
13010 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
13011 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
13012 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
13013 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
13014 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
13015 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13017 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
13018 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
13019 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
13020 value may not, of course, be truthful.
13022 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
13023 &$mime_anomaly_text$& &&&
13024 &$mime_boundary$& &&&
13025 &$mime_charset$& &&&
13026 &$mime_content_description$& &&&
13027 &$mime_content_disposition$& &&&
13028 &$mime_content_id$& &&&
13029 &$mime_content_size$& &&&
13030 &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$& &&&
13031 &$mime_content_type$& &&&
13032 &$mime_decoded_filename$& &&&
13033 &$mime_filename$& &&&
13034 &$mime_is_coverletter$& &&&
13035 &$mime_is_multipart$& &&&
13036 &$mime_is_rfc822$& &&&
13037 &$mime_part_count$&
13038 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
13039 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
13040 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
13042 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
13043 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
13044 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
13046 .tvar &$original_domain$&
13047 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13048 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13049 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
13050 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
13051 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
13052 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
13053 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
13054 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
13056 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13057 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13058 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13060 .tvar &$original_local_part$&
13061 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13062 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13063 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
13064 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
13065 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
13066 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
13067 the original address.
13069 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
13070 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
13071 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
13072 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
13073 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
13075 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13076 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13077 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13079 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
13080 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
13081 .cindex "sender" "gid"
13082 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
13083 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
13084 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
13085 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
13086 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
13087 normally the gid of the Exim user.
13089 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
13090 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
13091 .cindex "sender" "uid"
13092 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
13093 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
13094 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
13095 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
13096 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
13099 .tvar &$parent_domain$&
13100 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
13101 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13103 .tvar &$parent_local_part$&
13104 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
13105 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13108 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
13110 This variable contains the current process id.
13112 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
13113 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
13114 .cindex "transport" "filter"
13115 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
13116 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
13117 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
13118 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
13119 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
13120 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
13121 variable"& error if encountered.
13122 &*Note*&: This value permits data supplied by a potential attacker to
13123 be used in the command for a &(pipe)& transport.
13124 Such configurations should be carefully assessed for security vulnerbilities.
13126 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
13127 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
13128 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
13129 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
13130 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
13131 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
13132 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
13135 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
13136 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
13137 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
13138 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
13140 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
13142 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
13144 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
13145 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
13146 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
13147 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
13149 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$& &&&
13150 &$prvscheck_keynum$& &&&
13151 &$prvscheck_result$&
13152 These variables are used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13153 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13154 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13156 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
13157 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
13158 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
13160 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
13161 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
13162 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
13163 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
13165 .vitem &$queue_name$&
13166 .vindex &$queue_name$&
13167 .cindex "named queues" variable
13168 .cindex queues named
13169 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
13171 .vitem &$queue_size$&
13172 .vindex "&$queue_size$&"
13173 .cindex "queue" "size of"
13174 .cindex "spool" "number of messages"
13175 This variable contains the number of messages queued.
13176 It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
13177 If there is no daemon notifier socket open, the value will be
13182 .cindex router variables
13183 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
13184 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
13185 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
13186 and the eventual transport.
13188 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
13189 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
13190 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13191 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
13192 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
13194 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
13195 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
13196 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
13197 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13198 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13199 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
13201 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
13202 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
13203 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13204 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13205 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
13207 .vitem &$received_count$&
13208 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
13209 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
13210 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
13211 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
13214 .tvar &$received_for$&
13215 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
13216 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
13217 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
13218 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
13220 .vitem &$received_ip_address$& &&&
13222 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
13223 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
13224 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, these
13225 variables are set to the address and port on the local IP interface.
13226 (The remote IP address and port are in
13227 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
13228 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
13231 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
13232 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
13233 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
13234 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
13235 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
13237 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
13239 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
13240 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
13241 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
13242 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
13243 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
13244 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
13245 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
13246 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
13247 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
13249 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
13250 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
13251 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
13252 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
13253 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
13254 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
13256 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
13257 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
13258 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
13260 .vitem &$received_time$&
13261 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
13262 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
13263 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13265 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
13266 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
13267 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
13268 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
13269 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
13271 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13272 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
13274 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13275 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13276 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13277 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13279 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
13280 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
13281 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13282 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13285 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13286 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13289 &"route"&: Routing failed.
13292 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13293 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13297 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13300 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13303 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13304 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13306 .tvar &$recipients$&
13307 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
13308 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
13309 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13310 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
13314 In a system filter file.
13316 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13317 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13318 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13319 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13321 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13325 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
13326 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13327 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13328 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13329 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13330 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13333 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13334 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13335 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13336 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13338 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13339 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13340 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13341 these variables contain the
13342 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13343 If the subject string was tainted then so will any captured substring.
13346 .tvar &$reply_address$&
13347 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13348 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13349 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13350 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13351 decoding or character code translation takes place.
13353 .vitem &$return_path$&
13354 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
13355 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13356 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13357 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13358 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13359 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13360 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13361 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13362 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13363 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13366 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13367 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13368 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13370 .vitem &$router_name$&
13371 .cindex "router" "name"
13372 .cindex "name" "of router"
13373 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13374 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
13377 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13378 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13379 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13380 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13381 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13382 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13383 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13386 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13387 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13388 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13389 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13390 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13391 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13392 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13393 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13395 .tvar &$sender_address$&
13396 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13397 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13398 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13399 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13401 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13402 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13403 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13404 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13405 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13406 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13407 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13408 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13410 .tvar &$sender_address_domain$&
13411 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13413 .tvar &$sender_address_local_part$&
13414 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13416 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13417 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13418 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13419 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13420 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13423 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13424 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13426 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13427 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13428 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13429 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13431 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13432 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13433 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13434 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13435 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13436 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13437 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13438 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13439 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13440 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13441 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13442 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13443 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13445 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13446 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13447 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13448 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13449 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13451 .tvar &$sender_helo_name$&
13452 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13453 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13454 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13455 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13457 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13458 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13459 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13460 this variable contains that
13461 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13463 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13464 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13465 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13466 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13467 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13468 &$authenticated_id$&.
13470 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13471 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13472 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13473 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13474 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13475 resolver library states that both
13476 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13477 other times, this variable is false.
13479 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13480 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13481 library, by setting:
13486 In addition, on Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer the resolver library will
13487 default to stripping out a successful validation status.
13488 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
13489 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
13490 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
13491 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
13496 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13497 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13499 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13500 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13502 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13503 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13504 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13505 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13508 .tvar &$sender_host_name$&
13509 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13510 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13511 other means, this variable is empty.
13513 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13514 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13515 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13516 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13517 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13518 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13519 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13521 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13522 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13523 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13524 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13526 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13527 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13528 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13531 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13532 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13533 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13534 following are true:
13537 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13539 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13540 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13541 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13543 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13544 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13545 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13547 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13548 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13549 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13551 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13552 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13553 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13554 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13556 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13558 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13559 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13563 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13564 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13565 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13566 number that was used on the remote host.
13568 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13569 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13570 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13571 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13572 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13575 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13576 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13577 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13578 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13580 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13581 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13582 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13583 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13584 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13585 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13586 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13587 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13588 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13589 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13590 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13593 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13594 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13595 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13596 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13597 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13599 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13600 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13601 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13602 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13603 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13605 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13606 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13607 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13608 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13609 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13610 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13611 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13613 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13614 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13615 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13616 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13617 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13619 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13620 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13621 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13622 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13623 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13624 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13626 .tvar &$smtp_command$&
13627 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13628 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13629 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13634 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13635 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13636 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13637 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13639 .tvar &$smtp_command_argument$&
13640 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13641 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13642 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13643 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13644 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13646 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13647 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13648 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13649 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13650 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13653 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13654 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13655 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13656 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13657 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13658 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13659 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13660 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13661 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13662 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13663 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13665 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13666 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13667 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13668 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13669 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13670 message is junk mail.
13672 .vitem &$spam_score$& &&&
13673 &$spam_score_int$& &&&
13675 &$spam_report$& &&&
13677 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13678 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13679 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13681 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13682 &$spf_received$& &&&
13684 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13685 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13686 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13687 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13689 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13690 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13691 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13693 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13694 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13695 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13696 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13697 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13698 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13700 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13701 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13702 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13703 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13704 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13705 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13706 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13707 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13709 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13711 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13714 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13715 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13716 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13717 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13718 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13719 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13721 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13722 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13723 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13724 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13725 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13726 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13727 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13728 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13730 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13731 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13734 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13735 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13736 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13737 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13738 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13739 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13741 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13742 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13743 .cindex certificate variables
13744 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13745 inbound connection when the message was received.
13746 It is only useful as the argument of a
13747 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13748 or a &%def%& condition.
13750 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13751 when a list of more than one
13752 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13753 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13755 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13756 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13757 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13758 inbound connection when the message was received.
13759 It is only useful as the argument of a
13760 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13761 or a &%def%& condition.
13762 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13763 which is not the leaf.
13765 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13766 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13767 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13768 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13769 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13770 or a &%def%& condition.
13772 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13773 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13774 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13775 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13776 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13777 or a &%def%& condition.
13778 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13779 which is not the leaf.
13781 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13782 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13783 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13784 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13786 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13787 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13790 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13791 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13792 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13793 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13794 and &"0"& otherwise.
13796 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13797 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13798 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13799 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13800 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13801 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13802 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13803 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13804 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13806 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13807 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13808 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13810 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13811 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13812 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13814 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13815 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13817 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13818 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13819 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13820 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13822 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13823 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13824 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13826 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13827 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13828 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13830 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13831 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13832 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13833 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13835 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13836 1 No response to request
13837 2 Response not verified
13838 3 Verification failed
13839 4 Verification succeeded
13842 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13843 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13844 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13845 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13846 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13848 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13849 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13850 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13851 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13852 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13853 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13854 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13855 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13856 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13857 which is not the leaf.
13859 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13860 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13863 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13864 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13865 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13866 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13867 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13868 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13869 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13870 which is not the leaf.
13873 .vitem &$tls_in_resumption$& &&&
13874 &$tls_out_resumption$&
13875 .vindex &$tls_in_resumption$&
13876 .vindex &$tls_out_resumption$&
13877 .cindex TLS resumption
13878 Observability for TLS session resumption. See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
13881 .tvar &$tls_in_sni$&
13882 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13883 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13885 .cindex SNI "observability on server"
13886 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13887 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13888 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13889 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13890 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13891 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13892 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13894 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13895 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13898 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13899 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13900 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13902 .cindex SNI "observability in client"
13904 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13907 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13908 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13909 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13911 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
13912 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
13913 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13914 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
13916 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
13917 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
13918 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13919 this variable is set to the protocol version.
13922 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13923 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13924 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13925 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13927 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13928 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13929 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13931 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13932 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13933 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13935 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13936 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13937 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13938 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13939 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13940 values for those that are behind (west).
13943 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13944 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13945 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13947 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13948 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13949 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13950 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13953 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13954 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13955 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13958 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13959 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13960 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13961 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13963 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13964 .cindex "transport" "name"
13965 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13966 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13967 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13970 .vindex "&$value$&"
13971 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13972 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13973 &*reduce*& expansion.
13975 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13976 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13977 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13978 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13981 .vitem &$version_number$&
13982 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13983 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13984 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13986 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13987 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13988 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13989 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13991 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13992 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13993 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13994 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14000 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14001 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14003 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
14004 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
14005 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
14006 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
14007 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
14008 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
14013 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
14016 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
14017 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
14018 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
14019 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
14020 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
14021 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
14022 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
14023 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
14024 a newly created Perl interpreter.
14026 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
14027 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
14028 should usually be something like
14030 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
14032 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
14033 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
14034 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
14035 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
14036 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
14037 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
14038 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
14039 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
14043 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
14044 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
14045 a startup when Exim is entered.
14047 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
14048 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
14051 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
14052 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
14055 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
14056 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
14057 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
14058 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
14059 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
14060 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
14063 &*Note*&: This is entirely separate from Exim's tainted-data tracking.
14066 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
14067 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
14068 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
14069 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
14073 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
14074 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
14076 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
14077 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
14078 with an error message of the form
14080 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
14082 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
14083 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
14084 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
14085 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
14086 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
14087 that was passed to &%die%&.
14090 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
14091 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
14092 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
14095 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
14097 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
14098 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
14099 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
14101 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
14102 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
14103 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
14104 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
14106 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
14107 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
14108 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
14109 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
14110 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
14111 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
14112 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
14115 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
14116 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
14117 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
14118 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
14119 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
14120 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
14121 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
14122 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
14123 avoided, but the output is lost.
14125 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
14126 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
14127 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
14128 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
14129 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
14130 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
14131 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
14133 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
14135 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
14136 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
14137 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
14138 as the first subroutine argument.
14142 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14143 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14145 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
14146 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
14147 "Starting the daemon"
14148 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
14149 .cindex "interface" "listening"
14150 .cindex "network interface"
14151 .cindex "interface" "network"
14152 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
14153 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
14154 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
14155 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14156 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
14157 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
14158 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
14159 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
14160 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
14161 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
14162 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
14165 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
14166 and ports to listen on.
14168 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
14169 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
14170 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
14171 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
14172 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
14173 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
14174 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
14175 as an error situation.
14177 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
14178 for the outgoing connection.
14182 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
14183 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
14184 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
14185 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
14186 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
14188 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
14189 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
14190 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
14191 chapter describes how they operate.
14193 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
14194 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
14198 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
14199 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
14200 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
14204 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
14206 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
14208 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
14209 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
14212 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
14213 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
14214 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
14215 colons. For example:
14217 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
14220 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
14222 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
14223 in &%local_interfaces%&:
14226 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
14227 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
14229 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
14230 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
14233 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
14234 with a colon separator, for example:
14236 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
14237 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
14241 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
14242 default setting contains just one port:
14244 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14246 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
14247 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
14248 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
14249 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
14250 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
14254 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
14255 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
14256 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
14257 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
14258 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
14259 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14261 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14263 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
14265 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14267 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
14271 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
14272 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
14273 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
14274 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
14275 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
14276 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
14279 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
14280 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
14281 If there are any items that do not
14282 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
14283 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
14284 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14285 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
14289 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
14292 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
14294 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
14295 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
14296 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
14300 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
14301 .cindex "submissions protocol"
14302 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14303 .cindex "smtps protocol"
14304 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14305 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14306 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14307 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14308 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14309 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14310 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14311 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14312 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14315 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14316 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14317 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14319 The common use of this option is expected to be
14321 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14324 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14325 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14327 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14328 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14329 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14330 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14331 connections via the daemon.)
14336 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14337 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14338 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14339 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14340 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14341 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14342 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14343 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14345 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14347 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14348 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14349 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14350 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14351 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14352 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14354 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14356 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14357 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14358 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14359 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14360 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14362 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14363 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14364 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14365 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14366 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14367 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14368 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14369 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14370 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14371 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14372 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14373 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14375 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14376 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14377 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14378 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14379 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14383 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14384 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14386 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14387 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14389 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14390 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14391 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14392 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14394 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14396 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14398 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14400 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14401 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14403 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14404 IPv4 loopback address only:
14406 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14408 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14410 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14412 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14416 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14417 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14418 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14419 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14422 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14423 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14424 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14425 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14427 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14428 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14429 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14430 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14431 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14432 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14433 used for listening. Consider this example:
14435 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14437 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14439 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14441 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14442 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14445 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14446 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14447 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14448 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14449 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14450 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14451 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14452 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14456 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14457 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14458 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14459 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14460 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14461 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14467 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14468 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14470 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14471 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14472 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14473 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14476 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14477 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14479 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14480 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14481 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14483 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14484 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14485 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14486 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14490 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14491 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14492 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14493 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14494 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14495 listed in more than one group.
14497 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14499 .row &%add_environment%& "environment variables"
14500 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14501 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14502 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14503 .row &%keep_environment%& "environment variables"
14504 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14505 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14506 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14507 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14508 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14509 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14510 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14511 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14515 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14517 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14518 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14519 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14520 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14521 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14522 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14527 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14529 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14530 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14531 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14532 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14533 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14534 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14535 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14536 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14537 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14538 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14539 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14540 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14545 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14547 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14548 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14549 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14550 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14551 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14552 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14553 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14554 .row &%panic_coredump%& "request coredump on fatal errors"
14555 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14556 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14557 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14558 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14559 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14560 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14561 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14562 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14567 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14569 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14570 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14571 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14572 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14577 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14579 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14580 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14581 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14582 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14583 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14584 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14585 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14586 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14587 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14588 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14589 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14590 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14591 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14592 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14593 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14598 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14600 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14601 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14606 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14608 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14609 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14610 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14615 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14617 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14618 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14619 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14620 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14621 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14622 .row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
14623 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14624 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14625 .row &%smtp_backlog_monitor%& "level to log listen backlog"
14630 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14632 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14633 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14634 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14635 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14636 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14637 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14638 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14639 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14640 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14641 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14642 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14643 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14644 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14645 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14646 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14647 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14649 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14650 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14651 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14652 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14653 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14658 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14660 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14661 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14662 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14663 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14664 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14665 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14666 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14667 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14668 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14669 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14670 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14671 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14672 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14673 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14674 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14675 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14676 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14677 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14678 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14679 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14680 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14681 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14683 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14684 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14685 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14686 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14687 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14688 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14689 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14690 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14691 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14692 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14693 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14694 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14695 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14696 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14697 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14698 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14699 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14700 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14701 .row &%proxy_protocol_timeout%& "timeout for proxy protocol negotiation"
14702 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14703 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14704 .row &%spf_smtp_comment_template%& "template for &$spf_smtp_comment$&"
14709 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14711 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14713 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14715 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14716 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14717 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14722 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14724 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14725 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14726 .row &%hosts_require_alpn%& "mandatory ALPN"
14727 .row &%hosts_require_helo%& "mandatory HELO/EHLO"
14728 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14729 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14730 .row &%tls_alpn%& "acceptable protocol names"
14731 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14732 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14733 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14734 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14735 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14736 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14737 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14738 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14739 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14740 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14741 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14742 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14743 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14748 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14750 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14751 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14752 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14753 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14754 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14755 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14756 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14757 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14762 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14764 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14765 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14766 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14767 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14768 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14769 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14770 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14771 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14777 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14779 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14786 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14787 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14790 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14791 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14792 .row &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%& "DKIM key sizes accepted for signatures"
14793 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14794 .row &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& "DMARC sender for report messages"
14795 .row &%dmarc_history_file%& "DMARC results log"
14796 .row &%dmarc_tld_file%& "DMARC toplevel domains file"
14797 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14798 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14799 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14800 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14801 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14802 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14803 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14804 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14805 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14806 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14807 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14808 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14809 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14810 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14812 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14813 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14814 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14815 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14816 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14817 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14818 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14819 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14820 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14821 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14822 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14823 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14824 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14825 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14826 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14827 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14832 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14834 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14835 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14836 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14837 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14838 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14839 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14840 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14841 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14842 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14843 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14844 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14849 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14851 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14852 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14853 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14854 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14856 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14857 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14858 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14859 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14860 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14861 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14862 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14863 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14864 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14865 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14870 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14872 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14873 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14875 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14876 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14877 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14878 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14879 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14884 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14886 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14887 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14888 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14889 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14890 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14891 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14892 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14893 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14894 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14895 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14896 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14897 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14898 .row &%queue_fast_ramp%& "parallel delivery with 2-phase queue run"
14899 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14900 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14901 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14902 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14903 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14904 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14905 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14906 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14907 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14908 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14909 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14910 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14915 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14917 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14918 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14919 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14920 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14921 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14922 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14923 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14924 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14925 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14926 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14927 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14928 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14929 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14930 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14931 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14936 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14937 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14940 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14942 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14943 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14944 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14945 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" 8BITMIME
14946 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14947 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14948 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14949 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14951 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14952 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14953 It now defaults to true.
14954 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14956 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14959 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14961 log_selector = +8bitmime
14964 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14965 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14966 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14967 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14968 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14971 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14972 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14973 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14976 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14977 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14978 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14979 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14980 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14982 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14983 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14984 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14985 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14986 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14988 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14989 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14990 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14991 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14993 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14994 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14995 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14996 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14997 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14999 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
15000 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
15001 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
15002 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
15003 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
15004 This option defines the ACL that,
15005 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
15006 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
15007 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
15008 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15010 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
15011 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
15012 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
15013 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
15014 of a received message.
15015 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
15017 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
15018 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
15019 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
15020 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15022 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
15023 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
15024 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
15025 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15027 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
15028 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
15029 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
15030 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
15031 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15034 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
15035 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
15036 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
15037 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15039 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
15040 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
15041 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
15042 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
15043 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15045 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15046 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
15047 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
15048 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
15049 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
15051 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
15052 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
15053 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
15054 ends without a QUIT command being received.
15055 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15057 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
15058 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
15059 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
15062 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
15063 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
15064 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
15065 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15067 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
15068 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
15069 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
15070 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15072 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
15073 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
15074 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
15075 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15077 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
15078 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
15079 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
15080 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15082 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
15083 .cindex "environment" "set values"
15084 This option adds individual environment variables that the
15085 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
15086 Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
15088 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
15090 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15091 .cindex "admin user"
15092 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
15093 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
15094 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
15095 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
15096 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
15097 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
15098 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
15100 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
15101 .cindex "domain literal"
15102 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
15103 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
15104 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
15105 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
15107 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
15108 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
15109 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
15110 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
15111 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
15112 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
15113 the local host's IP addresses.
15115 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
15116 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
15117 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
15118 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
15119 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
15120 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
15121 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
15122 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
15123 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
15125 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
15126 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
15127 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
15128 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
15129 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
15130 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
15131 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
15133 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
15134 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
15135 letters, digits, and hyphens.
15137 If Exim is built with internationalization support
15138 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
15139 this option can be left as default.
15141 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
15142 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
15143 suitable setting is:
15145 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
15146 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
15148 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
15150 dns_check_names_pattern =
15152 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
15155 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15156 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
15157 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
15158 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
15159 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
15160 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
15161 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
15162 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
15163 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
15164 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
15165 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
15166 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
15168 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
15169 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
15170 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
15171 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
15172 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
15173 which Exim advertises AUTH.
15175 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
15176 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
15177 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
15178 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
15180 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
15182 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
15183 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
15184 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
15185 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
15188 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
15189 .cindex "thawing messages"
15190 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
15191 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
15192 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
15193 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
15194 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
15195 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
15197 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
15198 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
15199 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
15202 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
15203 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
15204 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
15206 sophie:/var/run/sophie
15208 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
15209 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
15212 .option bi_command main string unset
15214 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
15215 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
15216 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
15217 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
15220 .option bounce_message_file main string&!! unset
15221 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
15222 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
15223 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15224 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
15225 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
15226 .cindex bounce_message_file "tainted data"
15227 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
15228 absolute and untainted.
15229 See also &%warn_message_file%&.
15232 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
15233 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
15234 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
15235 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
15237 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
15238 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
15239 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
15240 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
15241 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
15242 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
15243 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
15244 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
15245 point at which the error was detected are returned.
15246 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
15248 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
15249 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
15250 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
15251 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
15252 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
15253 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
15254 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
15255 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
15256 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
15257 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
15259 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
15260 during reception of a message.
15261 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
15263 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
15266 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
15267 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
15268 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
15269 &%bounce_return_body%&.
15272 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
15273 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
15274 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
15275 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
15276 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
15277 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
15278 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
15279 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
15280 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
15282 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
15283 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
15284 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
15285 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
15286 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
15289 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
15290 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
15291 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
15292 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
15293 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
15294 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
15295 connection. A typical setting might be:
15297 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15299 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
15301 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15303 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
15306 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
15307 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
15308 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
15309 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
15310 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15311 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15314 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
15315 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
15316 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15317 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15320 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15321 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15322 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15323 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15326 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15327 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15328 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15329 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15332 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15333 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15334 callout verification. The default value is
15336 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15338 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15341 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
15342 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15345 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
15346 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15348 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15349 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15350 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15351 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15352 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15353 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15354 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15355 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15356 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15357 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15360 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
15361 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15364 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
15365 .cindex "checking disk space"
15366 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15367 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15368 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15369 message is accepted.
15371 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15372 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
15373 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15374 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15375 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15376 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15377 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15378 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15381 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15382 either value is greater than zero, for example:
15384 check_spool_space = 100M
15385 check_spool_inodes = 100
15387 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15388 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15391 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15392 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15393 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15395 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15396 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15397 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15398 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15399 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15400 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15402 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15403 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15404 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15406 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15407 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15408 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15410 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15411 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15412 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15413 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15415 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15416 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15417 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15418 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" CHUNKING
15419 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15421 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15423 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15424 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15425 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15426 administrative user.
15427 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15429 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15430 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15431 .cindex memory debugging
15432 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15433 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15434 it should normally be left as default.
15436 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15437 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15438 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15439 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15440 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15441 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15443 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15444 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15445 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15446 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15447 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15448 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15449 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15451 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15452 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15454 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15455 .cindex "warning of delay"
15456 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15457 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15458 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15459 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15460 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15461 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15462 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15463 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15466 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15468 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15469 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15470 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15471 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15475 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15476 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15478 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15480 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15481 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15482 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15484 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15485 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15486 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15487 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15488 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15489 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15490 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15491 not sent. The default is:
15493 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15494 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15495 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15496 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15499 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15500 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15501 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15502 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15504 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15505 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15506 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15507 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15508 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15509 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15510 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15511 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15513 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15514 .cindex "load average"
15515 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15516 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15517 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15518 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15519 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15522 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15523 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15524 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15525 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15526 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15527 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15528 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15529 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15531 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15532 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15533 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15534 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15535 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15536 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15537 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15538 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15540 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15541 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15542 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15543 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15546 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15547 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15548 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15549 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15550 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15551 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15552 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15555 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15556 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15557 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15558 and an order of processing.
15559 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15561 Acceptable values include:
15568 Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15570 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15571 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15572 and an order of processing.
15573 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15576 .option dkim_verify_min_keysizes main "string list" "rsa=1024 ed25519=250"
15577 This option gives a list of key sizes which are acceptable in signatures.
15578 The list is keyed by the algorithm type for the key; the values are in bits.
15579 Signatures with keys smaller than given by this option will fail verification.
15581 The default enforces the RFC 8301 minimum key size for RSA signatures.
15583 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15584 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15587 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15588 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15589 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15590 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15591 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15592 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15595 .option dmarc_forensic_sender main string&!! unset
15596 .option dmarc_history_file main string unset
15597 .option dmarc_tld_file main string unset
15598 .cindex DMARC "main section options"
15599 These options control DMARC processing.
15600 See section &<<SECDMARC>>& for details.
15603 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15604 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15605 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15606 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15607 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15608 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15609 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15610 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15611 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15612 by a setting such as this:
15614 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15616 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15617 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15618 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15619 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15620 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15621 options are applied after this global option.
15623 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15624 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15625 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15626 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15627 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15628 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15629 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15630 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15631 value of this option. The default pattern is
15633 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15634 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15636 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15637 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15638 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15639 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15640 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15643 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15644 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15645 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15647 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15648 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15649 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15650 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15652 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15653 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15654 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15655 not do it internally.
15656 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15657 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15659 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15660 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15661 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15664 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15665 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15666 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15667 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15668 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15669 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15671 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15673 On Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer this is insufficient, the resolver library
15674 will default to stripping out a successful validation status.
15675 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
15676 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
15677 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
15678 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
15684 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15685 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15686 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15687 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15688 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15689 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15690 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15691 domain matches this list.
15693 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15694 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15695 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15696 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15697 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15698 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15701 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15702 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15703 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15704 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15705 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15706 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15707 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15708 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15709 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15710 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15711 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15712 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15714 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15717 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15718 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15721 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15722 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15723 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15724 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15725 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15726 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15727 match with this expanded domain list.
15729 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15730 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15731 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15732 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15733 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15734 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15736 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15737 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15738 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15740 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15741 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15742 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15743 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15744 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15746 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15747 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15748 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15749 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15750 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15751 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15752 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15753 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15756 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15758 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15759 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15760 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15763 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15764 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15765 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15766 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15768 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15769 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15770 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15771 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15772 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" DSN
15773 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15774 and accepted from, these hosts.
15775 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ORCPT options on RCPT TO commands,
15776 and RET and ENVID options on MAIL FROM commands.
15777 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15778 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15780 &*Note*&: Supplying success-DSN messages has been criticised
15781 on privacy grounds; it can leak details of internal forwarding.
15783 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15784 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15785 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15786 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15787 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15788 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15790 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15792 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15793 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15795 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15796 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15797 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15798 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15799 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15800 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15801 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15802 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15803 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15806 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15807 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15808 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15809 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15810 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15811 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15812 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15813 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15814 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15816 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15817 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15818 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15819 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15820 are examined. For example:
15822 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15823 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15824 postmaster@mydomain.example
15826 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15827 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15828 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15829 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15830 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15831 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15832 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15835 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15836 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15837 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15839 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15841 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15842 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15843 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15844 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15845 overrides the default.
15847 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15848 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15849 and warning messages. For example:
15851 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15853 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15854 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15855 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15856 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15860 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15862 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15863 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15866 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15867 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15868 .cindex "Exim group"
15869 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15870 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15871 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15872 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15873 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15877 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15878 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15879 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15880 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15881 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15882 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15884 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15885 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15886 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15887 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15890 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15891 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15892 .cindex "Exim user"
15893 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15894 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15895 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15896 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15898 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15899 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15900 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15901 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15904 .option exim_version main string "current version"
15905 .cindex "Exim version"
15906 .cindex customizing "version number"
15907 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
15908 This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
15909 various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
15912 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15913 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15914 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15915 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15918 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15919 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15921 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15922 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15924 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15925 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15926 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15927 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15928 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15929 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15930 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15931 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15932 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15933 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15937 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15938 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15939 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15940 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15941 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15942 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15943 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15944 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15947 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15948 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15949 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15950 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15954 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15955 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15956 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15957 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15958 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15959 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15960 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15961 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15962 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15963 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15964 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15965 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15966 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15967 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15968 logging that you require.
15971 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15973 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15974 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15975 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15976 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15977 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15978 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15979 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15980 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15982 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15983 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15984 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15987 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15988 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15989 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15990 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15992 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15996 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15997 See &%gecos_name%& above.
16000 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
16001 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
16002 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
16003 implementations of TLS.
16006 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
16007 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
16008 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
16011 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
16016 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
16017 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
16018 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
16019 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
16020 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
16021 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
16025 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
16026 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
16027 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
16028 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
16029 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
16030 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
16031 sections are rejected.
16034 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
16035 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
16036 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
16037 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
16038 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
16039 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
16040 zero means &"no limit"&.
16045 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16046 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
16047 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
16048 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
16049 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
16050 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
16051 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
16052 if you want to do semantic checking.
16053 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
16057 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
16058 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
16059 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
16060 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
16061 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
16062 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
16063 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
16065 helo_allow_chars = _
16067 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
16070 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
16071 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16072 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16073 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
16074 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
16075 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
16076 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
16080 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16081 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
16082 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
16083 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
16084 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
16085 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
16086 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
16087 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
16088 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
16089 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
16090 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
16091 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
16093 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
16094 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
16095 EHLO command either:
16098 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
16100 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
16101 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
16102 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
16103 calling host address, or
16105 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
16108 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
16109 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
16110 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
16112 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
16113 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16114 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
16116 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16117 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
16118 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
16119 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
16120 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
16121 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
16122 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
16123 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
16124 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
16127 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16128 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
16129 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
16130 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
16131 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
16132 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
16133 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
16134 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
16135 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
16137 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
16138 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
16139 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
16140 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
16141 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
16143 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
16144 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
16145 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
16146 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
16149 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
16150 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
16151 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
16152 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
16153 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
16154 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
16155 default configuration file contains
16159 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
16160 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
16162 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
16163 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
16164 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
16166 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
16167 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
16168 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
16169 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
16170 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
16171 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
16174 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
16175 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
16176 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
16177 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
16178 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
16181 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
16182 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
16183 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
16184 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
16188 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
16189 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
16190 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
16191 as soon as the connection is made.
16192 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
16193 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
16194 connections immediately.
16196 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
16197 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
16198 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
16199 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
16200 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
16203 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
16204 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
16205 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
16206 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
16207 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
16208 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
16209 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
16210 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
16211 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
16213 hosts_connection_nolog = :
16216 The hosts affected by this option also do not log "no MAIL in SMTP connection"
16217 lines, as may commonly be produced by a monitoring system.
16221 .option hosts_require_alpn main "host list&!!" unset
16222 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in server"
16224 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
16225 If the TLS library supports ALPN
16226 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any client
16227 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
16228 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
16230 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
16231 managed by this option, and should be done separately.
16234 .option hosts_require_helo main "host list&!!" *
16235 .cindex "HELO/EHLO" requiring
16236 Exim will require an accepted HELO or EHLO command from a host matching
16237 this list, before accepting a MAIL command.
16240 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
16241 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
16242 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
16243 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
16246 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
16247 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
16248 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
16249 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
16250 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
16252 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
16253 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
16255 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
16256 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
16257 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
16258 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
16259 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
16260 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
16261 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
16264 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
16265 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
16266 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
16267 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16268 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
16272 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
16273 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
16274 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
16275 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
16276 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
16277 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
16279 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
16280 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
16281 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
16282 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
16283 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
16284 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
16285 for frozen messages. For example,
16287 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
16289 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
16290 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
16291 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
16292 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
16293 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
16294 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
16297 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16298 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16299 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16300 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
16301 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
16302 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
16303 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
16304 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
16305 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
16306 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
16309 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
16310 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
16312 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
16313 .cindex "environment" "values from"
16314 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
16315 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
16316 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
16317 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
16318 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
16319 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
16320 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
16322 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
16323 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
16325 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
16326 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
16327 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
16328 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
16330 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
16331 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
16332 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
16335 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
16336 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
16337 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
16341 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
16342 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
16343 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
16344 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
16348 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
16349 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
16350 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
16351 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
16352 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16353 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16354 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16355 and constrained to be a directory.
16358 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
16359 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
16360 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16361 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
16362 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16363 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16364 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16365 and constrained to be a file.
16368 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
16369 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16370 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16371 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16372 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16373 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16376 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16377 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16378 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16379 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16380 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16381 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16382 identity to be proven.
16385 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16386 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16387 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16388 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16389 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16392 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16393 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16394 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16395 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16396 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16400 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16401 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16402 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16403 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16404 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16405 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16409 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16410 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16411 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16412 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16413 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16415 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16416 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16417 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16420 .option ldap_version main integer unset
16421 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16422 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16423 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16424 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16425 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16426 has been built with LDAP support.
16430 .option local_from_check main boolean true
16431 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16432 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16433 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16434 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16435 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16436 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16438 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16439 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16440 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16442 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16443 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16444 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16445 and the default qualify domain.
16447 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16448 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16449 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16450 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16452 .cindex "envelope from"
16453 .cindex "envelope sender"
16454 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16455 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16456 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16458 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16459 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16460 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16465 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
16466 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16467 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16468 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16469 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16470 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16471 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16474 local_from_prefix = *-
16476 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16478 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16480 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16481 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16485 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
16486 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
16489 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16490 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16491 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16492 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16493 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16494 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16495 &%local_interfaces%& is
16497 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16499 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16501 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16504 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16505 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16506 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16507 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16508 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16509 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16510 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16511 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16515 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16516 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16517 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16518 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16519 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16520 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16521 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16522 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16527 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16528 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16529 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16530 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16531 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16532 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16533 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16534 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16535 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16536 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16537 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16538 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16539 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16540 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16541 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16545 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16546 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16547 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16548 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16549 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16550 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16551 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16552 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16553 A path must start with a slash.
16554 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16555 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16556 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16557 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16558 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16559 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16560 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16561 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16564 .option log_selector main string unset
16565 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16566 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16567 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16568 minus characters. For example:
16570 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16572 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16573 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16576 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16577 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16578 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16579 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16580 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16581 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16582 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16583 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16584 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16585 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16586 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16587 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16588 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16591 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16592 .cindex "too many open files"
16593 .cindex "open files, too many"
16594 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16595 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16596 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16597 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16598 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16599 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16600 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16601 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16602 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16603 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16604 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16605 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16608 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16609 .cindex "length of login name"
16610 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16611 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16612 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16613 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16614 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16615 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16618 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16619 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16620 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16621 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16622 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16623 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16624 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16625 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16628 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16629 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16630 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16631 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16632 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16633 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16634 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16637 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16638 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16639 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16640 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16641 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16642 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16643 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16644 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16645 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16646 empty string, the option is ignored.
16649 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16650 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16651 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16652 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16653 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16654 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16655 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16656 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16657 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16658 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16659 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16660 colons will become hyphens.
16663 .option message_logs main boolean true
16664 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16665 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16666 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16667 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16668 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16669 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16670 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16671 which is not affected by this option.
16674 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16675 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16676 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16677 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16678 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16679 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16680 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16681 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16682 optionally followed by K or M.
16684 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
16685 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
16686 If nonzero the value will be advertised as a parameter to the ESMTP SIZE
16687 service extension keyword.
16689 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16690 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16691 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16692 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16693 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16695 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16696 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16697 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16698 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16699 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16700 message that an individual transport can process.
16702 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16703 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16704 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16705 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16706 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16707 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16708 some problems may result.
16710 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16711 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16712 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16715 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16716 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16717 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16719 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16721 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16722 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16723 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16724 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16725 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16728 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16729 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16730 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16731 contains a full description of this facility.
16735 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16736 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16737 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16738 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16739 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16742 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16743 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16744 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16745 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16746 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16749 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16750 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16751 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16752 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16753 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16755 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16756 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16759 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16761 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16762 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16766 .option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
16767 This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
16768 listens for work and information-requests.
16769 Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
16770 should need to modify the default.
16772 The option is expanded before use.
16773 If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
16774 is used with a nul byte prefixed.
16776 it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
16779 If this option is set as empty,
16780 or the command line &%-oY%& option is used, or
16781 the command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&,
16782 then a notifier socket is not created.
16785 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
16786 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16787 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16788 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16789 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16791 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16792 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16793 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16794 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16795 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16796 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16797 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16799 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16800 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16801 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16802 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16803 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16805 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16807 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16808 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16809 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16810 some now infamous attacks.
16814 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16815 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16816 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16818 # Disable older protocol versions:
16819 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16822 Possible options may include:
16826 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16828 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16830 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16834 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16836 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16838 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16840 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16842 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16844 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16848 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16862 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16866 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16868 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16870 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16872 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16876 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16879 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16880 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16881 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16882 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16883 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16884 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16887 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16888 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16889 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16890 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16891 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16895 .option panic_coredump main boolean false
16896 This option is rarely needed but can help for some debugging investigations.
16897 If set, when an internal error is detected by Exim which is sufficient
16898 to terminate the process
16899 (all such are logged in the paniclog)
16900 then a coredump is requested.
16902 Note that most systems require additional administrative configuration
16903 to permit write a core file for a setuid program, which is Exim's
16904 common installed configuration.
16907 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16908 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16909 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16910 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16911 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16912 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16913 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16914 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16915 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16916 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16919 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16920 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16921 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16922 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16923 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16924 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16925 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16928 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16930 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16931 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16934 .option perl_startup main string unset
16936 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16937 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16939 .option perl_taintmode main boolean false
16941 This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16944 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16945 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16946 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16947 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16948 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16949 PostgreSQL support.
16952 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16953 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16954 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16955 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16956 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16959 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16961 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16963 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16964 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16965 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16968 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16969 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16970 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
16971 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16972 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16973 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16974 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16975 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16976 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16977 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16979 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16980 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16981 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
16982 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPECONNECT
16983 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16984 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16985 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16986 commands are acceptable.
16987 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16989 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
16991 The SMTP service extension keyword advertised is &"PIPECONNECT"&;
16992 it permits the client to pipeline
16993 TCP connection and hello command (inclear phase),
16994 or TLS-establishment and hello command (encrypted phase),
16995 on later connections to the same host.
16998 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16999 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
17000 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
17001 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
17002 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
17003 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
17004 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
17005 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
17006 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
17008 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
17009 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
17010 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
17011 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
17012 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
17013 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
17014 volume of mail. Use with care!
17017 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
17018 .cindex "name" "of local host"
17019 .cindex "host" "name of local"
17020 .cindex "local host" "name of"
17021 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17022 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
17023 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
17024 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
17025 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
17026 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
17028 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
17029 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
17030 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
17031 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
17032 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
17033 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
17036 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
17037 .cindex "printing characters"
17038 .cindex "8-bit characters"
17039 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
17040 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
17041 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
17042 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
17043 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
17046 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
17047 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
17048 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
17049 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
17050 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
17054 .option process_log_path main string unset
17055 .cindex "process log path"
17056 .cindex "log" "process log"
17057 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
17058 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
17059 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
17060 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
17061 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
17062 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
17063 different spool directories.
17066 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
17067 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17071 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
17072 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
17073 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17076 .option proxy_protocol_timeout main time 3s
17077 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
17078 This option sets the timeout for proxy protocol negotiation.
17079 For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
17082 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
17083 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
17084 .cindex "address" "qualification"
17085 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
17086 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
17087 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
17088 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
17089 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
17090 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
17092 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
17093 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
17094 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
17095 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
17096 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
17097 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
17098 &%primary_hostname%& value.
17101 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
17102 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
17103 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
17107 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17108 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
17109 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17110 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
17111 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
17112 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
17113 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
17114 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
17117 .option queue_fast_ramp main boolean true
17118 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
17119 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
17120 If set to true, two-phase queue runs, initiated using &%-qq%& on the
17121 command line, may start parallel delivery processes during their first
17122 phase. This will be done when a threshold number of messages have been
17123 routed for a single host.
17126 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
17127 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17129 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
17130 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
17131 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
17132 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17135 .option queue_only main boolean false
17136 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17137 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
17138 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
17139 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
17140 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
17141 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
17143 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
17144 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
17145 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
17146 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
17149 .option queue_only_file main string unset
17150 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17151 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
17152 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
17153 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
17154 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
17155 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
17156 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
17157 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
17159 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
17161 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
17162 &_/some/file_& exists.
17165 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
17166 .cindex "load average"
17167 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17168 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
17169 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
17170 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
17171 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
17172 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
17173 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17176 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
17177 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
17178 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
17179 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17182 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
17183 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
17184 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
17185 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
17186 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
17187 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
17188 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
17189 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
17190 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
17191 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17192 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
17193 re-evaluated for each message.
17196 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
17197 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17198 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
17199 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
17200 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
17201 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
17204 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
17205 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
17206 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
17207 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
17208 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
17209 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
17210 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
17211 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
17212 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
17213 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
17214 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
17215 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
17216 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
17220 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
17221 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
17222 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
17223 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
17224 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
17225 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
17226 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
17227 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
17228 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
17230 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
17231 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
17232 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
17233 the daemon's command line.
17235 .cindex queues named
17236 .cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
17237 To set limits for different named queues use
17238 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
17240 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17241 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17242 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
17243 .cindex "first pass routing"
17244 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
17245 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
17246 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
17247 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
17248 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
17249 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
17250 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
17251 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
17252 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
17253 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
17257 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
17258 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
17259 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
17260 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
17261 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
17262 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
17263 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
17265 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
17266 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
17267 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
17268 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
17269 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
17270 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
17271 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
17272 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
17273 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
17275 The default setting is:
17278 received_header_text = Received: \
17279 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
17280 {${if def:sender_ident \
17281 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
17282 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
17283 by $primary_hostname \
17284 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
17285 ${if def:tls_in_ver { ($tls_in_ver)}}\
17286 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
17287 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
17288 ${if def:sender_address \
17289 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
17290 id $message_exim_id\
17291 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
17294 The references to the TLS version and cipher are
17295 omitted when Exim is built without TLS
17296 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
17297 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
17298 header lines such as the following:
17300 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
17301 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
17302 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
17303 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
17304 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
17305 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
17306 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
17308 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
17309 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
17310 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
17311 message was accepted.
17314 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
17315 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
17316 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
17317 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
17318 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
17319 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
17320 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
17321 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
17324 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17325 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17326 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17327 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17328 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
17329 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
17330 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
17331 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
17332 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
17333 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
17334 option was not set.
17337 .option recipients_max main integer 50000
17338 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
17339 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
17340 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
17341 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
17342 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
17343 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
17344 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
17347 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
17348 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
17349 RCPT commands in a single message.
17352 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
17353 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
17354 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
17355 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
17356 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
17357 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
17358 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
17361 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 4
17362 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
17363 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
17364 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
17365 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
17366 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
17367 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
17368 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
17369 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
17370 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
17371 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
17372 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
17373 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
17374 tagged with its process id.
17376 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
17377 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
17378 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
17379 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
17382 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option,
17383 and the &%serialize_hosts%& smtp transport option.
17385 .cindex "number of deliveries"
17386 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
17387 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
17388 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
17389 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
17390 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
17391 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
17392 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
17393 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
17394 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
17395 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
17397 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
17398 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
17399 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
17400 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
17403 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17404 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
17405 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
17406 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
17407 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
17409 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
17411 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
17412 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
17415 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17416 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17417 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17418 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17419 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17423 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17424 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17425 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17426 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17427 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17428 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17429 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17433 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
17434 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17435 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
17436 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17437 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17438 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17439 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17440 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17441 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17442 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17445 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17446 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17449 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17451 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17452 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17453 an item in the list.
17454 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17457 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17458 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17459 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17460 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17461 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17464 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17465 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17466 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17467 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17468 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17469 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17470 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17471 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17472 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17473 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17476 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17477 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17478 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17479 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17480 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17481 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17482 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17486 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17487 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17488 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17489 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17490 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17491 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17492 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17493 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17494 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17495 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17496 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17500 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17501 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17502 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17504 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17505 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17506 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17507 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17508 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17509 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17511 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17512 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17513 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17514 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17517 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17518 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17519 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17520 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17521 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17522 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17523 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17524 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17526 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17527 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17528 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17529 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17530 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17531 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17532 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17533 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17536 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17537 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17538 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17539 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17543 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17544 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17545 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17546 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17547 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17548 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17549 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17550 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17551 . the option name to split.
17553 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer&!! 1000 &&&
17554 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17555 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17556 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17557 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17558 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17559 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17560 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17561 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17563 The option is expanded after the HELO or EHLO is received
17564 and may depend on values available at that time.
17565 An empty or zero value after expansion removes the limit.
17568 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17569 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17570 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17571 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17572 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17573 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17574 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17575 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17576 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17577 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17578 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17580 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17581 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17582 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17583 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17584 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17585 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17589 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17590 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17591 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17592 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17593 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17594 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17595 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17596 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17597 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17598 to all messages received in the same connection.
17600 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17601 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17602 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17603 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17606 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17608 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17609 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17610 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17611 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17612 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17613 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17614 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17615 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17616 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17617 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17618 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17619 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17620 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17623 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17624 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17625 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17626 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17627 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17628 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17629 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17630 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17631 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17632 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17633 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17636 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17637 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17638 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17639 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17642 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17643 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17644 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17645 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17646 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17647 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17648 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17649 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17650 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17652 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17653 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17654 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17655 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17657 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17658 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17659 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17660 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17661 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17664 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17665 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17668 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17669 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17670 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17671 &%helo_data%& value.
17673 .option smtp_backlog_monitor main integer 0
17674 .cindex "connection backlog" monitoring
17675 If this option is set to greater than zero, and the backlog of available
17676 TCP connections on a socket listening for SMTP is larger than it, a line
17677 is logged giving the value and the socket address and port.
17678 The value is retrived jsut before an accept call.
17679 This facility is only available on Linux.
17681 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17682 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17683 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17684 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17685 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17686 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17687 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17689 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17690 $version_number $tod_full
17692 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17693 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17694 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17695 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17696 multiline response).
17699 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17700 .cindex "checking disk space"
17701 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17702 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17703 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17704 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17705 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17706 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17707 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17710 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17711 .cindex "connection backlog" "set maximum"
17712 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17713 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17714 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17715 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17716 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17717 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17718 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17719 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17720 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17721 attacks by SYN flooding.
17724 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17725 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17726 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17727 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17728 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17729 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17730 fewer, but they still exist.
17732 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17733 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17734 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17735 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17736 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17737 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17738 does detect many instances.
17740 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17741 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17742 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17743 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17747 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17748 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17749 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
17750 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17751 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17752 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17753 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17754 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17755 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17758 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17759 $sender_host_address
17761 If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
17762 be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
17763 In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
17764 if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
17766 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17767 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17768 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17769 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17770 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17774 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17775 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17776 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17777 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17778 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17781 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17782 .cindex "load average"
17783 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17784 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17785 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17786 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17787 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17788 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17792 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17793 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17794 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17795 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17796 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17798 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17800 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17801 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17802 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17803 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17804 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17806 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17807 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17808 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17809 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17810 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17811 not count towards the limit.
17815 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17816 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17817 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17818 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17819 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17822 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17823 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17827 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17828 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17829 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17830 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17831 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17832 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17835 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17836 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17837 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17838 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17840 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17841 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17842 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17843 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17847 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17849 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17850 fractional parts are allowed here.
17852 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17854 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17855 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17858 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17859 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17861 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17862 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17864 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17865 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17866 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17867 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17870 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17871 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17874 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17875 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17878 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17879 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17880 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17881 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17882 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17883 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17884 the message is abandoned.
17885 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17887 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17888 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17890 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17891 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17893 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17894 expanded before use and may depend on
17895 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17899 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17900 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17901 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17902 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17903 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17906 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17907 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17908 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17911 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17912 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17913 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17914 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17915 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17916 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17917 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17918 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17919 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17920 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17922 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17923 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17927 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17928 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
17929 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
17930 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17931 the availability thereof is advertised in
17932 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17933 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17936 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17937 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17938 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17939 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17943 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17944 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17945 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17947 .option spf_smtp_comment_template main string&!! "Please%_see%_http://www.open-spf.org/Why"
17948 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support. It
17949 allows the customisation of the SMTP comment that the SPF library
17950 generates. You are strongly encouraged to link to your own explanative
17951 site. The template must not contain spaces. If you need spaces in the
17952 output, use the proper placeholder. If libspf2 can not parse the
17953 template, it uses a built-in default broken link. The following placeholders
17954 (along with Exim variables (but see below)) are allowed in the template:
17958 &*%{L}*&: Envelope sender's local part.
17960 &*%{S}*&: Envelope sender.
17962 &*%{O}*&: Envelope sender's domain.
17964 &*%{D}*&: Current(?) domain.
17966 &*%{I}*&: SMTP client Ip.
17968 &*%{C}*&: SMTP client pretty IP.
17970 &*%{T}*&: Epoch time (UTC).
17972 &*%{P}*&: SMTP client domain name.
17974 &*%{V}*&: IP version.
17976 &*%{H}*&: EHLO/HELO domain.
17978 &*%{R}*&: Receiving domain.
17980 The capitalized placeholders do proper URL encoding, if you use them
17981 lowercased, no encoding takes place. This list was compiled from the
17984 A note on using Exim variables: As
17985 currently the SPF library is initialized before the SMTP EHLO phase,
17986 the variables useful for expansion are quite limited.
17989 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17990 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
17991 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
17992 .cindex "directories, multiple"
17993 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17994 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17995 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17996 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17997 arrival of the message.
17999 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
18000 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
18001 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
18002 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
18003 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
18005 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
18006 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
18007 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
18008 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
18009 automatically deleted.
18011 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
18012 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
18013 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
18014 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
18015 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
18016 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
18017 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
18018 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
18019 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
18022 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
18023 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
18024 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
18025 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
18026 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
18027 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
18028 &$primary_hostname$&.
18030 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
18031 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
18032 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
18033 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
18034 as failures in the configuration file.
18036 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
18037 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
18039 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
18040 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
18041 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
18042 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
18043 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
18044 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
18047 The following variables will not have useful values:
18049 $max_received_linelength
18054 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
18055 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
18056 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
18057 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
18059 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
18060 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
18061 The transmission benefit is maintained.
18063 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
18064 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
18065 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
18066 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
18068 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
18069 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
18070 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
18071 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
18072 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
18073 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
18075 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
18076 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
18077 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
18078 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
18079 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
18080 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
18081 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
18084 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
18085 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
18086 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
18087 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
18088 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
18089 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
18090 domain causes a syntax error.
18091 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
18095 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
18096 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
18097 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
18098 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
18099 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
18100 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
18101 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
18102 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
18103 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
18104 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
18105 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
18106 the LOG_ALERT priority.
18109 .option syslog_facility main string unset
18110 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
18111 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18112 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
18113 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
18114 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18115 details of Exim's logging.
18118 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
18119 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
18120 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
18121 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
18122 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
18123 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
18124 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18128 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
18129 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
18130 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18131 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
18132 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18136 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
18137 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
18138 .cindex timestamps syslog
18139 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
18140 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18141 details of Exim's logging.
18144 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
18145 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
18146 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
18147 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
18148 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
18149 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
18150 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
18151 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
18152 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
18153 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
18154 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
18155 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
18158 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
18159 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18160 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
18161 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
18162 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
18163 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18166 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
18167 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
18168 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
18169 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
18170 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18172 .option system_filter_group main string unset
18173 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
18174 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
18175 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
18176 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
18178 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
18179 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
18180 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18181 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
18182 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
18183 contains the pipe command.
18186 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
18187 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
18188 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
18189 is used in a system filter.
18192 .option system_filter_user main string unset
18193 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
18194 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
18195 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
18196 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
18197 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
18198 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
18199 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
18200 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
18201 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
18203 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
18204 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
18205 transport option overrides.
18208 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
18209 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
18210 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
18211 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
18212 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
18213 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
18214 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
18215 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
18216 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
18217 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
18218 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
18219 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
18223 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
18224 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
18225 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
18226 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
18227 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
18228 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
18229 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
18230 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
18231 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
18232 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
18234 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
18235 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
18236 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
18239 .option timezone main string unset
18240 .cindex "timezone, setting"
18241 .cindex "environment" "values from"
18242 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
18243 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
18244 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
18245 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
18249 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
18250 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
18251 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
18252 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
18253 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
18254 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
18257 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18258 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
18259 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
18260 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
18261 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
18262 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
18263 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
18264 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18265 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
18266 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
18267 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
18268 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
18271 .option tls_alpn main "string list&!!" "smtp : esmtp"
18272 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
18274 .cindex ALPN "set acceptable names for server"
18275 If this option is set,
18276 the TLS library supports ALPN,
18277 and the client offers either more than
18278 ALPN name or a name which does not match the list,
18279 the TLS connection is declined.
18282 .option tls_certificate main "string list&!!" unset
18283 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
18284 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
18285 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18286 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
18287 Commonly only one file is needed.
18288 The server's private key is also
18289 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
18290 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18292 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
18293 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
18294 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
18295 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
18297 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
18298 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
18300 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
18301 when a list of more than one
18302 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
18303 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
18305 .cindex SNI "selecting server certificate based on"
18306 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
18307 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
18308 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
18309 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
18311 If this option is unset or empty a self-signed certificate will be
18313 Under Linux this is generated at daemon startup; on other platforms it will be
18314 generated fresh for every connection.
18316 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
18317 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
18318 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
18319 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
18320 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
18322 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
18324 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
18325 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
18326 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
18328 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18331 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
18332 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
18333 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
18334 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
18335 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
18336 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
18338 The value must be at least 1024.
18340 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
18341 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
18342 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
18344 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
18347 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
18348 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
18349 larger prime than requested.
18352 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
18353 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
18354 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
18355 to be used by Exim.
18357 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
18358 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
18359 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
18360 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
18362 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
18363 then it names a file from which DH
18364 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
18365 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
18366 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
18367 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
18368 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
18369 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
18371 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
18374 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
18375 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
18376 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
18377 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
18379 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
18380 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
18382 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
18383 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
18384 in IKE is assigned number 23.
18386 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
18387 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
18388 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
18389 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
18390 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18392 The available standard primes are:
18393 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
18394 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
18395 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
18396 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
18398 The available additional primes are:
18399 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18401 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
18402 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
18403 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
18404 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
18405 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
18407 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
18408 they are still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
18409 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
18410 Two of them in particular (&`ike1`& and &`ike22`&) are called out by RFC 8247
18411 as MUST NOT use for IPSEC, and two more (&`ike23`& and &`ike24`&) as
18413 Because of this, Exim regards them as deprecated; if either of the first pair
18414 are used, warnings will be logged in the paniclog, and if any are used then
18415 warnings will be logged in the mainlog.
18416 All four will be removed in a future Exim release.
18418 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
18419 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
18420 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
18421 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
18422 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
18425 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
18426 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
18427 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
18428 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
18429 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
18430 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
18431 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
18434 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
18435 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
18436 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
18437 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
18439 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
18440 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
18441 for valid selections.
18443 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
18444 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
18445 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
18447 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
18450 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
18451 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
18452 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
18454 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
18455 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
18456 Certificate Authority.
18458 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
18459 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
18461 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
18462 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
18463 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
18464 The ordering of the two lists must match.
18465 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
18467 The file(s) should be in DER format,
18468 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
18470 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
18471 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
18472 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
18473 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
18474 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
18475 (this only works under TLS1.3)
18476 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
18478 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
18479 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
18480 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
18481 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
18483 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18486 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18487 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18488 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18489 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18493 .option tls_privatekey main "string list&!!" unset
18494 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18495 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18496 files which contains the server's private keys.
18497 If this option is unset, or if
18498 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18499 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18500 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18502 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18505 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18506 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18507 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18508 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18509 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18510 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18514 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18515 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18516 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18517 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18518 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18519 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18520 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18521 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18522 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18523 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18524 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18527 .option tls_resumption_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18528 .cindex TLS resumption
18529 This option controls which connections to offer the TLS resumption feature.
18530 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
18533 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18534 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18535 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18536 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18539 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18540 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18541 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18542 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18544 or the absolute path to
18545 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18546 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18548 The "system" value for the option will use a
18549 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18550 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18551 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18554 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18555 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18557 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18559 either by file or directory
18560 are added to those given by the system default location.
18562 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
18563 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
18564 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
18565 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
18566 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
18567 use the explicit directory version. (If your peer is Exim up to 4.85,
18568 using GnuTLS, you may need to send the CAs (thus using the file
18569 variant). Otherwise the peer doesn't send its certificate.)
18571 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18573 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
18577 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18578 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18579 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18580 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
18581 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
18582 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
18583 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
18584 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
18586 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
18587 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
18588 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
18590 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
18591 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
18592 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
18593 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
18595 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
18596 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
18597 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
18598 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18599 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18600 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18601 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18604 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18608 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18609 .cindex "trusted groups"
18610 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
18611 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18612 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18613 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18614 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18615 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18616 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18619 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18620 .cindex "trusted users"
18621 .cindex "user" "trusted"
18622 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18623 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18624 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18625 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18626 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18627 Exim user are trusted.
18629 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18630 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18631 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18632 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18633 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18634 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18635 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18636 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18637 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18640 .option unknown_username main string unset
18641 See &%unknown_login%&.
18643 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18644 .cindex "trusted users"
18645 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18646 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18647 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18648 .cindex "envelope from"
18649 .cindex "envelope sender"
18650 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18651 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18652 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18653 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18654 is used) is ignored.
18656 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18657 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18659 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18661 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18662 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18663 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18664 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18665 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18666 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18667 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18668 followed by a hyphen
18669 by a setting like this:
18671 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18673 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18674 restriction, you can use
18676 untrusted_set_sender = *
18678 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18679 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18680 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18681 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18682 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18683 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18684 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18685 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18687 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18688 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18689 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18690 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18694 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18695 .cindex "&""From""& line"
18696 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18697 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18698 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18699 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18700 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18701 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18702 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18703 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18705 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18706 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18708 The pattern can be seen by running
18710 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18712 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18713 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18714 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18715 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18716 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18717 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18720 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18721 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18724 .option warn_message_file main string&!! unset
18725 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18726 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18727 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18728 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18729 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18730 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18731 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
18732 .cindex warn_message_file "tainted data"
18733 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
18734 absolute and untainted.
18735 See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18738 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18739 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18740 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18741 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18742 .ecindex IIDconfima
18743 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18748 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18749 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18751 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18752 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18753 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18754 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18755 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
18757 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18758 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18759 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18760 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18761 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18763 The name of a router is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
18764 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
18768 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18769 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18770 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18771 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18772 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18773 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18774 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18776 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18777 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18778 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18779 routers, and the eventual transport.
18781 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18782 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18783 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18784 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18785 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18787 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18788 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18789 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18790 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18791 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18793 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18794 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18795 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18797 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18799 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18801 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18803 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18804 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18806 See also the &%set%& option below.
18808 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18809 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18810 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18811 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18812 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18813 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18814 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18818 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18820 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18821 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18822 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18823 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18824 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18829 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18830 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18831 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18832 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18833 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18834 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18835 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18836 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18837 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18838 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18841 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18843 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18846 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18848 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18849 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18850 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18851 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18854 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18855 .cindex "case of local parts"
18856 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18857 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18858 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18859 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18860 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18861 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18862 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18865 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18866 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18867 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18868 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18869 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18870 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18871 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18872 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18873 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18875 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18876 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18877 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18878 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18882 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18883 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
18884 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18885 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18887 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18888 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18889 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18890 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18891 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18893 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
18894 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router check_local_user option"
18895 &$local_part_data$& is set to an untainted version of the local part and
18896 &$home$& is set from the password data. The latter can be tested in other
18897 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18898 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18899 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18900 the router is skipped.
18902 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18903 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18904 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18905 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18906 setting to achieve this. For example:
18908 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18910 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18911 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18912 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18916 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18917 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18918 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18919 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18920 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18921 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18922 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18923 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18925 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18926 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18928 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18929 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18931 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18932 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18933 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18935 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18937 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18939 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18942 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18944 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18945 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18949 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18950 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18951 be specified using &%condition%&.
18953 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18954 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18955 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18956 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18957 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18958 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18959 Router rules processing behavior.
18961 This is best illustrated in an example:
18963 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18964 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18966 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18969 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18972 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18973 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18974 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18975 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18976 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18977 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18978 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18979 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18981 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18982 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18983 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18984 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18987 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18988 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18989 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18990 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18991 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18994 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18995 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18996 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18997 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18998 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18999 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19000 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19001 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19002 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
19003 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
19004 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
19005 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
19006 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
19007 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
19011 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
19012 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
19013 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
19014 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
19015 transport option of the same name.
19017 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
19018 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19019 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19020 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19021 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19022 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
19023 the DNSSEC request bit set.
19024 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19026 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
19027 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19028 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19029 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19030 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19031 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
19032 the DNSSEC request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
19033 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
19034 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19037 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
19038 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
19039 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
19040 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
19041 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
19042 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
19043 expansions of the driver's private options and in the transport.
19044 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
19045 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
19049 .option driver routers string unset
19050 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
19054 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
19055 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19056 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19057 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
19058 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
19059 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
19060 Not effective on redirect routers.
19064 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
19065 .cindex "envelope from"
19066 .cindex "envelope sender"
19067 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
19068 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
19069 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
19070 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
19071 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
19072 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
19073 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
19075 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
19076 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
19077 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
19080 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
19081 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
19082 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
19083 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
19085 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
19086 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
19087 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
19088 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
19094 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
19095 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
19096 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
19097 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
19098 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
19100 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19101 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
19102 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
19103 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
19104 setting &%return_path%&.
19106 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
19107 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
19108 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
19112 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
19113 .cindex "address" "testing"
19114 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
19115 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
19116 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
19117 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
19118 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
19119 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
19120 on for the system alias file.
19121 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19124 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
19125 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
19126 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
19130 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
19131 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
19132 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
19133 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19137 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
19138 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19139 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
19143 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
19144 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19145 verifying a sender, verification fails.
19149 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
19150 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
19151 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
19152 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
19153 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
19154 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
19155 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
19156 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
19157 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
19159 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
19160 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
19161 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
19162 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
19163 transport for further details.
19166 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
19167 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
19168 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19169 .cindex "transport" "local"
19170 .cindex "router" "setting group"
19171 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19172 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
19174 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19175 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19176 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
19177 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
19178 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19182 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
19183 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
19184 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
19185 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19186 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19187 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19188 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
19189 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
19190 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
19191 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
19192 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
19193 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
19194 &"see"& the added header lines.
19196 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
19197 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
19198 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
19199 failures are treated as configuration errors.
19201 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19202 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19204 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19205 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19207 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19208 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
19209 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19210 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
19211 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
19212 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
19213 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
19214 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
19215 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
19216 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19220 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
19221 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19222 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
19223 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19224 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19225 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19226 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
19227 Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
19228 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
19230 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
19231 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
19232 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
19233 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
19234 &"see"& the original header lines.
19236 The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
19237 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
19238 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
19241 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19242 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
19244 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19245 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19247 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19248 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
19249 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
19250 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
19252 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
19253 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
19254 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19258 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
19259 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
19260 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
19261 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
19262 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
19263 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
19264 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
19267 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
19271 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
19273 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
19274 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
19275 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
19276 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
19277 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
19278 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
19280 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
19281 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
19283 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
19284 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
19286 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
19287 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
19289 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
19290 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19291 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
19292 domain that is being routed.
19294 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19295 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
19298 .option initgroups routers boolean false
19299 .cindex "additional groups"
19300 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19301 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19302 .cindex "transport" "local"
19303 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
19304 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
19305 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
19306 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
19307 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19311 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
19312 .cindex affix "router precondition"
19313 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
19314 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
19315 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
19316 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
19317 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
19320 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
19321 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
19322 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
19323 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
19324 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
19325 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
19326 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
19327 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
19328 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
19330 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19331 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
19332 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
19333 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
19334 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
19335 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
19336 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
19337 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
19338 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
19339 the relevant transport.
19341 .vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
19342 If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
19343 wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
19345 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
19346 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
19347 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
19350 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
19351 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
19352 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
19353 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
19354 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
19358 local_part_prefix = real-
19360 transport = local_delivery
19362 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19363 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19365 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19366 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19369 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
19370 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
19371 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
19372 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
19375 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
19376 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
19380 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
19381 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
19382 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
19383 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
19384 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
19385 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
19386 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
19387 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
19388 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
19392 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
19393 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
19397 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
19398 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
19399 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
19400 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
19401 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19403 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
19404 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
19407 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain_data
19409 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
19410 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
19411 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
19412 expansions of the router's private options or in the transport.
19413 You might use this option, for
19414 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
19415 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
19416 each virtual domain:
19420 local_parts = postmaster
19421 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
19425 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
19426 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
19427 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
19428 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
19429 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
19430 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
19431 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
19432 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
19433 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
19434 redirect addresses.
19438 .option more routers boolean&!! true
19439 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19440 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19441 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19442 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
19443 delivery to be deferred.
19445 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
19446 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
19448 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
19449 means of the setting
19453 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
19454 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
19455 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
19457 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
19458 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
19459 controls what happens next.
19462 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
19463 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
19464 .cindex "router" "timeout"
19465 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
19466 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
19467 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
19468 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
19469 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
19471 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
19472 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
19473 applies to all of them.
19477 .option pass_router routers string unset
19478 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
19479 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
19480 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
19481 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
19482 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
19483 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
19484 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
19485 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
19486 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
19487 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
19491 .option redirect_router routers string unset
19492 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
19493 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
19494 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
19495 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
19496 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
19498 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
19499 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
19500 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
19501 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19505 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19506 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19507 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19508 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19509 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19510 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19511 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19513 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19514 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19515 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19516 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19517 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19519 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19520 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19521 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19522 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19523 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19526 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19527 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
19530 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
19531 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
19532 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
19533 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
19534 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
19535 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
19536 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
19537 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
19539 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
19540 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
19541 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
19542 operates as follows:
19544 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
19545 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
19546 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
19547 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
19550 require_files = mail:/some/file
19551 require_files = $local_part_data:$home/.procmailrc
19553 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
19554 &%require_files%& condition fails.
19556 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
19557 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
19558 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
19559 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
19561 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
19562 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
19563 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
19564 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
19565 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
19567 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
19568 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
19569 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
19570 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
19571 check again in that process.
19573 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
19574 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
19575 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
19576 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
19577 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
19578 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
19579 as if the file did not exist. For example:
19581 require_files = +/some/file
19583 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
19584 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
19585 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
19589 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
19590 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19591 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
19592 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
19593 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
19594 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
19595 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
19596 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
19599 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
19600 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
19601 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
19602 &%check_local_user%&,
19605 &%local_part_prefix%&,
19606 &%local_part_suffix%&,
19609 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
19610 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
19613 Failing to set this option when it is needed
19614 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
19615 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
19617 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19618 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19619 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19623 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19624 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
19625 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
19627 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19628 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19629 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19630 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19631 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19632 cause the router to defer.
19634 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19635 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19637 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19639 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19640 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19642 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19643 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19644 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19645 of these values that is set:
19648 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19650 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19652 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19654 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19657 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19658 router, but not for the transport.
19662 .option self routers string freeze
19663 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19664 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19665 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19666 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19667 and &(manualroute)& routers.
19668 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19670 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19671 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19672 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19673 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19674 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19676 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19677 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19678 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19679 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19680 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19685 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19687 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19688 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19689 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19690 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19692 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19693 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19694 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19699 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19700 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19701 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19702 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19703 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19704 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19710 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19711 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19712 be passed to the next router.
19715 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19718 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
19719 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19720 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19721 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19722 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19723 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19728 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19729 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
19730 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19731 address matches something on the list.
19732 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19735 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19736 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19737 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19738 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19739 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19740 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19741 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19745 .option set routers "string list" unset
19746 .cindex router variables
19747 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19748 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19749 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19752 Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19753 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19754 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19755 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19756 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19758 This is done immediately after all the preconditions, before the
19759 evaluation of the &%address_data%& option.
19760 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19761 The variables can be used by the router options
19762 (not including any preconditions)
19763 and by the transport.
19764 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19765 Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19767 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19768 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19771 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19772 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
19773 .cindex "packet radio"
19774 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19775 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19776 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19777 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19778 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19779 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19780 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19781 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19783 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19784 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19785 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19786 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19787 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19788 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19789 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19790 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19791 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19792 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19794 translate_ip_address = \
19795 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19798 The file would contain lines like
19800 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
19801 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19803 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19808 .option transport routers string&!! unset
19809 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19810 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19811 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19812 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19813 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19814 delivery is deferred.
19816 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19817 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19818 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19822 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19823 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19824 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19825 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19826 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19827 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19828 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19829 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19830 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19831 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19832 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19838 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19839 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19840 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19841 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19842 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19843 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19844 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19845 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19846 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19847 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19849 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19850 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19851 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19852 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19853 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19855 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19861 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19862 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19863 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19864 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19865 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19866 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19867 delivery to be deferred.
19869 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19870 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19871 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19872 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19873 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19874 sometimes true and sometimes false).
19876 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19877 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19878 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19879 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19880 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19881 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19882 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19883 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19885 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19886 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19887 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19888 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19889 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19890 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19891 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19892 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19893 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19894 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19896 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19897 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19898 subsequent routers.
19901 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
19902 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19903 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19904 .cindex "transport" "local"
19905 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19906 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19907 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19908 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19909 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19910 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19911 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19912 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19913 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19914 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19915 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19916 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19920 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
19921 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19922 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19925 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19926 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19928 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19929 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19930 delivering in cutthrough mode or
19931 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19932 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19933 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19934 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19936 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19937 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19938 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19942 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19943 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19945 delivering in cutthrough mode
19946 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19947 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19949 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19952 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19953 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19954 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19955 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19957 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19958 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19959 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19966 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19967 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19969 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19970 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
19971 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19972 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19973 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19974 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19975 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19976 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19977 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19981 domains = mydomain.example
19983 transport = local_delivery
19985 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19986 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19987 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19988 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19995 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19996 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19998 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19999 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
20000 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
20001 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
20002 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
20003 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
20005 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
20006 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
20007 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
20008 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
20011 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
20012 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
20013 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
20014 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
20015 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
20016 generic option, the router declines.
20018 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
20019 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
20020 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
20022 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
20023 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
20024 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
20025 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
20026 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
20027 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
20030 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
20031 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
20032 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
20033 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
20034 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
20035 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
20037 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
20038 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
20039 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
20040 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
20041 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
20042 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
20043 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
20044 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
20045 case routing fails.
20048 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
20049 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
20050 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
20051 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
20052 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
20054 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
20055 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
20057 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
20059 The domain does not exist in DNS
20061 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
20062 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
20063 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
20065 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
20067 MX record points to a non-existent host.
20069 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
20070 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
20072 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
20073 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
20075 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
20076 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
20078 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
20079 not be found in the MX records (see below)
20085 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
20086 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
20087 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
20089 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
20090 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
20091 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
20092 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
20093 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
20094 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
20095 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
20098 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
20099 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
20100 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
20101 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
20102 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
20103 required. For example,
20107 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
20108 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
20109 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
20110 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
20111 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
20114 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
20115 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
20116 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
20117 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
20118 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
20119 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
20121 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
20122 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
20123 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
20124 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
20125 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
20126 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
20127 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
20128 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
20130 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
20131 when there is a DNS lookup error.
20136 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20137 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
20138 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
20139 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
20140 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
20141 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
20142 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
20143 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
20147 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
20148 .cindex IPv6 disabling
20149 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
20150 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20151 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20152 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20153 only A records are used.
20155 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
20156 .cindex IPv4 preference
20157 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
20158 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20159 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20160 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20161 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
20163 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20164 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
20165 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
20166 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
20167 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
20168 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
20169 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
20172 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
20174 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
20175 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
20176 the address record.
20179 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20180 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20181 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
20182 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20187 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
20188 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20189 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
20190 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
20191 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
20192 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
20193 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
20194 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
20195 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
20200 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
20201 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
20202 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
20203 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
20204 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
20205 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
20206 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
20207 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
20208 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
20209 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
20210 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
20212 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
20213 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
20216 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
20217 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
20218 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
20219 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
20220 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
20224 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
20225 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20226 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
20227 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
20228 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20229 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20230 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20231 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20233 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20234 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
20235 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20236 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
20237 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
20238 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
20239 without processing them independently,
20240 provided the following conditions are met:
20243 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
20244 &%headers_remove%&.
20246 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
20253 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
20254 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20255 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
20256 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
20257 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
20258 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
20259 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
20260 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
20261 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
20262 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
20264 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
20265 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
20270 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20271 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20272 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
20273 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20278 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
20279 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
20280 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
20281 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
20284 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
20286 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
20287 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
20288 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
20289 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
20290 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
20291 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
20294 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
20295 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
20296 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
20297 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
20298 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
20300 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
20301 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
20302 such as that implied by
20306 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
20307 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
20308 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
20309 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
20319 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20320 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20322 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
20323 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
20324 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
20325 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
20326 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
20327 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
20328 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
20329 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
20330 router handles the address
20334 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
20335 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
20336 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
20338 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
20340 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
20341 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
20343 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
20344 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
20345 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
20346 &%self%& option determines what happens.
20348 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
20349 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
20350 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
20351 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
20355 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20356 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20358 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
20359 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
20360 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
20361 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
20362 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
20363 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
20366 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
20368 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
20370 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
20371 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
20372 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
20373 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
20374 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
20375 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
20376 must not be specified for it.
20378 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
20379 .option hosts iplookup string unset
20380 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
20381 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
20382 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
20383 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
20384 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
20387 .option optional iplookup boolean false
20388 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
20389 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
20390 delivery to the address is deferred.
20393 .option port iplookup integer 0
20394 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
20395 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
20399 .option protocol iplookup string udp
20400 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
20401 protocols is to be used.
20404 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
20405 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
20408 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
20410 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
20411 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
20414 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
20415 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
20416 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
20417 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
20418 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
20419 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
20420 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
20421 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
20424 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
20425 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
20426 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
20427 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
20428 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
20429 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
20430 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
20431 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
20432 following could be used:
20434 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
20435 reroute = $local_part@$1
20438 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
20439 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
20440 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
20441 call. It does not apply to UDP.
20446 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20447 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20449 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
20450 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
20451 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
20452 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
20453 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
20454 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
20455 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
20456 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
20457 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
20458 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
20460 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
20461 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
20462 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
20463 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
20464 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
20465 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
20466 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
20469 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
20470 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
20471 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
20472 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
20473 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
20474 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
20475 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
20478 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
20479 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
20480 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
20481 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
20482 below, following the list of private options.
20485 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
20487 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
20488 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
20490 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
20491 See &%host_find_failed%&.
20493 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
20494 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
20495 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
20496 of the following values:
20505 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20506 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20507 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20510 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20511 router only if &%more%& is true.
20513 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20514 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20515 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20516 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20518 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20519 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20520 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20523 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20524 .cindex "randomized host list"
20525 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
20526 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
20527 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
20528 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
20529 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
20530 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
20531 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
20532 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
20534 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
20535 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
20536 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
20537 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
20539 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
20541 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
20542 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
20543 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
20544 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
20545 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
20548 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
20549 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
20550 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
20553 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
20555 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
20556 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
20560 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
20561 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
20562 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
20563 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
20566 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
20567 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20568 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
20569 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
20570 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20571 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20572 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20573 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20575 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20576 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
20577 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20578 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
20579 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
20580 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
20581 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
20582 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
20587 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
20588 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
20589 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
20590 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
20591 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
20592 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
20594 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
20596 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
20600 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
20601 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20603 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
20604 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
20605 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
20606 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
20607 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
20608 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
20609 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
20610 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
20611 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
20612 in a &%route_list%&).
20614 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
20615 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
20616 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
20617 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20621 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20622 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20623 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20624 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20625 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20626 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20627 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20630 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20631 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20633 This data can be accessed by setting
20635 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20637 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20638 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20639 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20640 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20641 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20646 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20647 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20648 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20649 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20650 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20651 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20652 The format of each item
20653 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20654 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20656 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20657 variables are set during its expansion:
20660 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20661 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20662 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20664 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20667 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20669 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20672 .vindex "&$value$&"
20673 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20674 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20676 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20680 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20681 semicolon is the default route list separator.
20685 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20686 Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
20687 optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
20688 (see &%hosts_randomize%&).
20689 When no port is given, an IP address
20690 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20691 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20692 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20695 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20696 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20697 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20699 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20700 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20703 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20704 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20705 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20706 number follows. For example:
20708 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20712 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20713 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20714 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20715 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20716 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20719 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20720 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20721 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20722 records in the DNS. For example:
20724 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20726 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20729 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20731 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20732 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20733 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20734 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20735 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20736 happens is controlled by the
20737 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20738 &%self%& option of the router.
20740 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20741 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20742 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20743 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20744 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20745 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20746 defined by MX preferences.
20748 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20749 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20750 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20752 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20753 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20754 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20755 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20757 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20758 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20761 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20762 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20763 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20765 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20766 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20770 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20771 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20772 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20773 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20774 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20775 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20776 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20779 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20780 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20782 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20783 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20785 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20786 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20787 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20789 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20790 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20791 timeout), delivery is deferred.
20793 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20795 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20800 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20801 domain2 host4:host5
20803 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20804 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20805 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20806 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20809 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20810 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20811 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20812 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20815 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20816 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20821 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20822 &%host_find_failed%& option.
20825 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20826 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20830 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20831 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20832 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20835 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
20836 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20837 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20838 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20840 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20842 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20843 your first router something like this:
20846 driver = manualroute
20847 domains = !+local_domains
20848 transport = remote_smtp
20849 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20851 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20852 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20853 they are tried in order
20854 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20855 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20858 driver = manualroute
20859 transport = remote_smtp
20860 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20862 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20863 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20864 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20865 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20866 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20867 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20868 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20869 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20872 .cindex "mail hub example"
20873 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20874 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20875 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20876 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20877 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20878 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20879 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20880 lookup is easier to manage.
20882 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20883 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20887 driver = manualroute
20888 transport = remote_smtp
20889 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20891 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20892 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20893 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20894 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20895 domain can be used to find the host:
20898 driver = manualroute
20899 transport = remote_smtp
20900 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20902 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20903 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20904 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20908 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20909 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20910 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20911 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20912 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20913 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20916 driver = manualroute
20917 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20918 route_list = saved.domain.example
20920 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20921 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20922 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20925 driver = manualroute
20927 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20928 *.saved.domain2.example \
20929 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20932 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20934 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20935 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20936 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20937 the address if the lookup fails.
20940 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20941 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20942 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20943 one way it can be done:
20949 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20950 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20951 return_fail_output = true
20956 driver = manualroute
20958 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20960 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20962 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20964 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20965 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20966 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20968 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
20969 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
20978 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20979 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20981 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20982 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20983 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20984 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
20985 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20986 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20987 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20988 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20989 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20990 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20992 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20994 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20995 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20996 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20997 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20998 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
21001 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
21002 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
21003 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
21004 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
21005 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
21006 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
21009 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
21010 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
21011 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
21012 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
21013 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
21014 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
21015 not set, a value for the gid also.
21017 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
21018 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
21019 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
21020 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
21021 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
21022 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
21026 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
21027 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
21028 before running the command.
21031 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
21032 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
21033 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
21037 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
21038 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
21039 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
21040 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
21041 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
21044 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
21047 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
21048 &%no_more%& is set.
21050 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
21051 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
21052 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
21053 included in the SMTP response.
21055 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
21056 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
21057 included in any SMTP response.
21059 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
21061 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
21062 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
21064 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
21065 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
21066 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
21069 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
21070 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
21073 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
21074 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
21076 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
21077 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
21078 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
21079 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
21081 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
21082 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
21083 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
21084 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
21085 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
21087 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
21088 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
21089 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
21090 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
21091 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
21093 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
21094 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
21095 variable. For example, this return line
21097 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
21099 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
21100 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
21101 .ecindex IIDquerou1
21102 .ecindex IIDquerou2
21107 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21108 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21110 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
21111 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
21112 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
21113 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
21114 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
21115 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
21116 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
21117 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
21118 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
21119 redirected in several different ways:
21122 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
21125 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
21127 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
21129 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
21131 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
21133 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
21135 It can be discarded.
21138 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
21139 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
21140 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
21141 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
21143 If success DSNs have been requested
21144 .cindex "DSN" "success"
21145 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
21146 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
21150 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
21151 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
21152 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
21153 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
21154 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
21155 aliases, in a configuration like this:
21159 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
21161 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
21162 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
21163 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
21164 cause delivery to be deferred.
21166 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
21167 &_.forward_& files, like this:
21172 file = $home/.forward
21175 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
21176 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
21177 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
21178 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
21181 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21182 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21183 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21185 &*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
21186 directly for redirection,
21187 as they are provided by a potential attacker.
21188 In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
21189 on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
21190 the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
21194 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
21195 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
21196 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
21197 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
21200 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
21201 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
21202 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
21203 practice the router may not be able to operate.
21205 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
21206 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
21207 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
21208 saves some resources.
21216 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
21217 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21218 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21219 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
21220 can be interpreted in two different ways:
21223 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
21224 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
21225 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
21226 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
21227 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
21228 document is intended for use by end users.
21230 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
21231 described in the next section.
21234 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
21235 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
21236 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
21237 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
21238 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
21242 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
21243 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
21244 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
21245 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
21246 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
21247 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
21248 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
21249 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
21250 commas or newlines.
21251 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
21254 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
21255 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
21256 next newline character is ignored.
21258 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
21259 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
21260 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
21261 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
21264 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21265 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
21266 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
21267 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
21268 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
21269 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
21272 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
21276 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
21277 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
21278 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
21279 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
21280 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
21281 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
21282 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
21283 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
21284 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
21285 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
21286 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
21288 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
21289 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
21290 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
21291 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
21292 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
21294 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
21296 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
21297 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
21298 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
21299 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
21300 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
21303 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
21304 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
21305 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
21306 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
21307 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
21309 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
21310 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
21315 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
21316 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
21319 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21321 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
21322 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
21323 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
21324 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
21325 should really contain
21327 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21329 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
21330 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
21331 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
21335 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
21336 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
21337 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
21340 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
21341 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
21342 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
21343 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
21344 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
21345 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21346 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21348 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
21349 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
21350 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
21351 in double quotes, for example:
21353 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
21355 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
21356 quote just the command. An item such as
21358 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
21360 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
21362 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
21363 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
21364 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
21365 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
21366 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
21367 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
21368 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
21369 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
21370 an &%accept%& router.
21373 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
21374 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
21375 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
21376 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
21378 /home/world/minbari
21380 is treated as a filename, but
21382 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
21384 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
21385 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
21386 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
21387 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
21389 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21390 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21392 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
21393 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
21394 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
21395 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
21398 .cindex "included address list"
21399 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
21400 If an item is of the form
21402 :include:<path name>
21404 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
21405 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
21406 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
21407 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
21408 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
21409 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
21411 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
21413 It must be given as
21415 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
21417 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21418 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21419 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21421 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
21422 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
21423 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
21424 .cindex "black hole"
21425 .cindex "abandoning mail"
21426 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
21427 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
21428 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
21432 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
21433 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
21434 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
21436 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
21437 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
21438 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
21439 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
21443 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
21444 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
21445 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
21446 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
21447 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
21448 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
21449 redirection items of the form
21454 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
21455 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
21456 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
21457 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
21459 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
21461 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
21463 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
21464 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
21466 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
21467 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
21468 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
21470 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21471 By default for verify, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
21472 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
21473 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
21474 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
21475 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
21476 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
21477 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
21478 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
21481 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
21482 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
21483 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
21484 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
21486 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
21487 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
21488 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
21489 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
21490 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
21492 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
21493 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
21494 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
21495 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
21496 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
21500 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21501 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21502 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21503 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21504 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21505 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21506 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21510 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21511 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
21512 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21513 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21514 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21515 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21516 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21517 aliasing scheme of the type
21519 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
21523 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
21524 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
21525 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
21528 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
21529 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
21531 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
21532 the pipes are distinct.
21536 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
21537 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
21538 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
21539 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
21540 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
21541 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
21542 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
21543 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
21544 can be used to avoid this.
21547 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
21548 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
21549 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
21550 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
21551 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
21552 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
21553 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
21557 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
21559 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
21560 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
21563 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
21564 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
21565 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
21568 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
21569 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
21570 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
21571 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
21574 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
21575 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
21576 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
21577 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
21578 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
21579 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
21580 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
21582 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
21583 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
21586 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
21587 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
21588 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
21589 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
21590 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
21594 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
21595 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
21596 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
21597 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
21598 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
21599 let ordinary users do.
21603 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
21604 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
21605 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
21606 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
21607 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
21608 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
21610 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
21611 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
21612 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
21613 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
21614 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
21615 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
21617 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
21619 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
21620 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
21621 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
21622 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
21623 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
21624 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
21625 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
21626 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21629 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21630 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21631 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21632 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21633 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21634 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21635 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21636 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21640 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21641 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21642 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21643 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21644 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21645 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21648 .option data redirect string&!! unset
21649 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21650 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21651 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21652 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21653 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21655 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21656 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21657 terminated with newline characters. For example:
21659 data = #Exim filter\n\
21660 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21662 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21663 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21664 choice into a newline.
21667 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21668 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21669 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21670 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21671 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21674 .option file redirect string&!! unset
21675 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21676 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21677 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21678 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21679 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21680 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21681 entirely of comments), the router declines.
21683 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21684 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21685 runs a check on the containing directory,
21686 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21687 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21688 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21689 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21690 not, the router declines.
21693 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21694 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21695 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21696 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21697 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21698 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21699 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21702 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21703 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21704 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21705 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21706 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21709 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21710 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21711 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21712 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21716 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21717 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21718 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21719 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21720 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21725 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21726 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21727 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21728 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21729 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21730 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21731 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21732 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21733 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21734 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21735 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21738 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21739 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21740 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21741 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21742 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21745 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21746 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21747 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21748 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21749 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21750 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21752 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21753 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21754 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21755 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21756 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21757 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21758 &_.forward_& files).
21761 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21762 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21763 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21764 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21765 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21768 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21769 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21770 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21771 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21772 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21773 of the embedded Perl support.
21776 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21777 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21778 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21779 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21780 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21783 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21784 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21785 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21786 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21787 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21790 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21791 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21792 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21793 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21794 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21795 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21796 &%one_time%& is set.
21799 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21800 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21801 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21802 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21803 to make use of &%run%& items.
21806 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21807 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21808 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21809 If this option is true, items of the form
21811 :include:<path name>
21813 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21816 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21817 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21818 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21819 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21820 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21821 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21822 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21825 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21826 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21827 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21828 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21829 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21832 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21833 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21834 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21835 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21836 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21841 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21842 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21843 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21844 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21845 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21846 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21847 bounce may well quote the generated address.
21850 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21852 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21853 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21854 file did not exist.
21857 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21859 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21860 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21861 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21863 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21864 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21865 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21866 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21867 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21868 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21869 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21870 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21874 .option include_directory redirect string unset
21875 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21876 redirection list must start with this directory.
21879 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21880 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21881 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21884 .option one_time redirect boolean false
21885 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21886 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21887 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21888 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21889 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21890 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21891 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21892 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21893 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21894 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21895 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21896 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21897 before they subscribed.
21899 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21900 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21901 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21902 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21905 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21906 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21907 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21908 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21910 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21911 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21912 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21914 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21917 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21918 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21919 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21920 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21921 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21925 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
21926 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21927 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21928 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21929 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21930 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21931 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21932 See &%check_owner%& above.
21935 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21936 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21937 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21938 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21941 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21942 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21943 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21944 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21945 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21946 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21947 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21950 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21951 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21952 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21953 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21954 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21955 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21956 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21957 &$qualify_recipient$&.
21959 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21960 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21961 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21964 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21965 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21966 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21967 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21968 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21969 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21970 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21971 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21972 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21973 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21976 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21977 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21978 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21979 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21980 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21981 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21984 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21985 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21986 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21987 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21988 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21989 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21992 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
21993 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21994 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21995 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21996 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21999 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
22000 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22001 :subaddress part of an address.
22003 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
22004 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
22005 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
22006 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
22009 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
22010 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
22011 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
22012 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
22013 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
22014 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
22015 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
22019 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
22020 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
22021 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
22022 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
22023 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
22024 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
22025 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
22026 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
22027 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
22028 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
22029 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
22030 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
22031 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
22032 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
22033 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
22034 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
22036 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
22037 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
22038 the following routers.
22040 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
22041 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
22042 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
22043 so it is passed to the following routers.
22045 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
22046 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
22047 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
22048 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
22050 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
22051 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
22052 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
22053 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
22059 file = $home/.forward
22060 file_transport = address_file
22061 pipe_transport = address_pipe
22062 reply_transport = address_reply
22065 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
22066 syntax_errors_text = \
22067 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
22068 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
22069 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
22070 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
22071 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
22072 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
22073 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
22074 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
22075 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
22076 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
22078 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
22079 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
22080 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
22085 local_part_prefix = real-
22086 transport = local_delivery
22088 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
22089 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
22091 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
22092 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
22096 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
22097 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22100 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
22101 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22102 .ecindex IIDredrou1
22103 .ecindex IIDredrou2
22110 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22111 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22113 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
22114 "Environment for local transports"
22115 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
22116 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
22117 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
22118 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
22119 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
22120 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
22121 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
22123 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
22124 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
22125 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
22126 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
22128 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
22129 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
22130 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
22131 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
22132 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
22136 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
22137 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
22138 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
22139 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
22140 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
22141 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
22142 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
22145 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
22146 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
22150 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
22152 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
22153 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
22154 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
22155 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
22160 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
22161 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
22162 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
22163 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
22164 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
22165 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
22166 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
22167 group (set by the transport). For example:
22170 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
22174 transport = group_delivery
22177 # This transport overrides the group
22179 driver = appendfile
22180 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
22183 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
22184 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
22185 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
22188 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
22189 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
22190 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
22191 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
22192 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
22193 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
22195 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
22196 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
22197 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
22198 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
22199 original gid is also used.
22201 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
22202 following that is set is used:
22205 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
22207 A &%group%& setting of the router;
22209 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
22210 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
22212 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
22214 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
22215 the uid is the creator's uid;
22217 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
22220 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
22221 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
22222 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
22223 The first of the following that is set is used:
22226 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
22228 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
22230 A &%user%& setting of the router;
22232 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
22237 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
22238 &%never_users%& list.
22244 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
22245 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
22246 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
22247 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
22248 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
22249 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
22250 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
22251 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
22252 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
22253 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22256 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
22258 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
22260 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
22262 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
22265 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22268 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
22270 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
22274 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
22275 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
22276 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
22280 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
22281 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22282 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22283 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
22284 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
22285 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
22286 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
22287 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
22288 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
22289 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
22290 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
22291 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
22292 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
22293 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
22301 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22302 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22304 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
22305 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
22306 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
22307 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
22308 The name of a transport is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
22309 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
22312 The following generic options apply to all transports:
22315 .option body_only transports boolean false
22316 .cindex "transport" "body only"
22317 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
22318 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
22319 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
22320 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
22321 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
22322 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
22323 automatically suppress them.
22326 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
22327 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
22328 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
22329 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
22330 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
22331 logged, and delivery is deferred.
22334 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
22335 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
22336 deliveries by the transport or for any
22337 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
22338 what you are doing.
22341 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
22342 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
22343 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
22344 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
22346 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
22347 output, and Exim carries on processing.
22348 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
22349 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
22350 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
22351 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
22353 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
22354 transport and the router that called it.
22356 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
22357 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
22358 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
22359 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
22360 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
22361 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
22362 safely be resent to other recipients.
22365 .option driver transports string unset
22366 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
22367 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
22370 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
22371 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22372 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
22373 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
22374 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
22375 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
22376 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
22377 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
22378 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
22379 resent to other recipients.
22381 &*Note:*& If used on a transport handling multiple recipients
22382 (the smtp transport unless &%rcpt_max%& is 1, the appendfile, pipe or lmtp
22383 transport if &%batch_max%& is greater than 1)
22384 then information about Bcc recipients will be leaked.
22385 Doing so is generally not advised.
22388 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
22390 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
22391 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
22394 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
22395 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
22396 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
22397 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
22398 &%user%& (see below).
22401 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
22402 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
22403 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
22404 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22405 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22406 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
22407 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
22408 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
22409 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22410 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22411 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22413 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
22414 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
22417 .option headers_only transports boolean false
22418 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
22419 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
22420 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
22421 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
22422 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
22423 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
22424 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
22427 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
22428 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
22429 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
22430 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22431 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22432 to be removed from the message.
22433 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
22434 Each list item is separately expanded.
22435 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22436 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22437 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22438 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
22440 Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
22441 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
22444 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
22445 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
22447 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
22448 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
22449 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
22453 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
22454 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
22455 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22456 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
22457 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
22458 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
22459 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
22460 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
22463 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
22466 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
22467 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
22468 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
22469 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
22470 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
22471 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
22472 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
22473 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
22474 change envelope recipients at this time.
22477 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
22478 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
22480 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
22481 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
22482 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
22483 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
22484 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
22485 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
22486 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
22490 .option initgroups transports boolean false
22491 .cindex "additional groups"
22492 .cindex "groups" "additional"
22493 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
22494 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
22495 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
22496 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
22499 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
22500 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
22501 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
22502 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
22503 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
22504 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
22505 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
22506 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
22508 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22509 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22510 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
22511 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
22512 Obviously there is scope for
22513 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22514 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22516 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
22517 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22518 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22519 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22520 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
22523 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
22524 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
22525 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
22526 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
22527 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
22528 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
22529 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
22530 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
22531 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
22532 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
22533 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
22534 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
22535 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
22540 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
22541 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
22542 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
22543 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
22544 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
22545 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
22546 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
22547 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
22550 local_part_prefix = *-
22552 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
22555 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
22557 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
22558 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
22559 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
22560 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
22561 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
22564 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
22565 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
22566 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
22567 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
22568 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
22569 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
22570 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
22571 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
22572 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
22574 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
22575 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
22576 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
22577 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
22579 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
22580 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
22581 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
22584 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
22585 .cindex "envelope sender"
22586 .cindex "envelope from"
22587 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
22588 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
22589 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
22590 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
22591 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
22592 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
22593 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
22594 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
22595 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
22597 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
22598 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
22600 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
22601 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
22602 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
22603 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
22604 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
22605 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
22606 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
22608 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
22609 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
22610 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
22611 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
22612 &%errors_to%& in a router.
22616 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
22617 .chindex Return-path:
22618 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
22619 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
22620 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
22621 have easy access to it.
22623 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
22624 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
22625 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
22626 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
22627 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
22631 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
22632 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
22635 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
22636 .cindex "shadow transport"
22637 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
22638 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
22639 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
22641 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22642 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22643 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22644 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22645 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22646 cause a log line to be written.
22648 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22649 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22650 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22651 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22652 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22655 ST=<shadow transport name>
22657 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22658 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22659 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22660 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22661 headers that some sites insist on.
22664 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22665 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22666 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22667 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22668 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22669 individual users or via a system filter.
22670 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22672 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22673 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22674 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22675 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
22676 command must be specified as an absolute path.
22678 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22679 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22680 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22681 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22682 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22683 &(pipe)& transports.
22685 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22686 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22687 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22688 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22689 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22691 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22692 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22693 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22694 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22696 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22697 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22698 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22699 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22700 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22701 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22703 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
22704 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22705 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22706 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22707 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22708 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22709 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22710 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22712 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22713 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22714 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22715 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22716 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22717 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22718 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22719 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22720 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22721 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22724 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22725 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22726 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22727 which the message is being sent. For example:
22728 . used to have $sender_address in this cmdline, but it's tainted
22730 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22731 $host $host_address $pipe_addresses
22734 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22735 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22736 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22738 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22739 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22740 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22743 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22745 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22746 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22747 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22748 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22749 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22750 Exim tried to expand the first one.
22752 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22753 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22754 arguments. Consider this example:
22756 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22757 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22759 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22760 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22762 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22763 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22767 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22768 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22769 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22770 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22771 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22772 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22773 bounced from a transport filter.
22775 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22776 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22777 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22780 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22781 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22782 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22783 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22784 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22785 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22786 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22787 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22788 becomes a temporary error.
22791 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22792 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22793 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22794 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22795 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22796 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22797 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22800 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22801 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22802 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22804 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22805 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22806 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22807 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22809 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22810 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22811 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22818 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22819 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22821 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22823 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22824 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22825 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22826 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22827 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22828 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22829 copy of the message is delivered each time.
22831 .cindex "batched local delivery"
22832 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22833 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22834 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22835 local transport, for example:
22838 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22839 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22840 recipients saves space.
22842 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22843 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22845 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22846 to a scanner program or
22847 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22851 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22852 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22853 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22855 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22856 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22857 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22858 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22859 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22860 to certain conditions:
22863 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22864 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22865 batching is possible.
22867 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22868 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22869 addresses with the same domain are batched.
22871 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22872 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22873 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22874 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22875 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22878 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22879 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22880 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22884 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22885 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22886 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22887 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22888 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22889 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22890 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22893 escape_string = ".."
22895 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22896 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22897 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22899 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22900 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22901 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22902 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22903 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22904 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22906 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22907 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22908 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22909 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22910 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22911 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22912 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22913 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22914 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22919 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22920 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22922 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22923 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22924 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22925 .cindex "directory creation"
22926 .cindex "creating directories"
22927 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22928 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22929 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22930 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22931 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22932 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22933 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22934 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22935 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22936 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22938 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22939 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22940 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22943 .cindex "quota" "system"
22944 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22945 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22946 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22948 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22949 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22950 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22951 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22953 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22954 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22957 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22958 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22959 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22960 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22965 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22966 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22967 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22968 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22969 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22971 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22972 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22973 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22974 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22975 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22976 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22977 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22978 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22979 operation. There are two cases:
22982 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22983 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22984 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22985 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22986 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22987 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22988 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22990 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22991 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22992 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22994 If the &%create_file%& option is set to a path which
22995 matches (see the option definition below for details)
22996 a file or directory name
22997 for the delivery, that name becomes de-tainted.
22999 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
23000 .cindex appendfile "tainted data"
23001 Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
23002 This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
23003 as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
23004 which returns a path (or component).
23007 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
23008 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
23009 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
23010 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
23015 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
23017 require "fileinto";
23018 fileinto "folder23";
23020 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
23021 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
23022 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
23023 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
23024 way of handling this requirement:
23026 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
23027 {/var/mail/$local_part_data} \
23028 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
23030 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
23034 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
23035 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
23036 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
23038 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
23039 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
23040 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
23041 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
23042 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
23043 path to the transport.
23045 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
23046 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
23051 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
23052 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
23056 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
23057 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
23058 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
23059 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
23060 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
23061 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
23062 delivery is deferred.
23065 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
23066 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23067 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23068 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
23069 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
23070 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
23071 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
23072 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
23075 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
23076 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23077 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
23078 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
23082 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
23083 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23086 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
23087 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
23088 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
23089 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
23090 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
23093 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
23094 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
23095 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
23096 process is running.
23099 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
23100 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23101 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
23102 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
23103 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
23104 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
23105 contains is significant.
23107 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
23108 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
23109 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
23110 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
23111 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
23113 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
23114 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
23115 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
23116 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
23117 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
23118 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
23120 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23121 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
23122 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23123 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23125 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
23126 .cindex "directory creation"
23127 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
23128 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
23129 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
23131 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
23132 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
23133 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
23134 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
23135 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
23139 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
23140 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
23141 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
23142 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
23143 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
23146 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
23147 &"belowhome"&, or to an absolute path.
23149 In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
23150 set for the transport, and the file or directory being created must
23152 The "belowhome" checking additionally checks for attempts to use "../"
23153 to evade the testing.
23154 This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
23155 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
23156 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
23157 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
23158 &%file_must_exist%&.
23160 In the fourth case,
23161 the value given for this option must be an absolute path for an
23162 existing directory.
23163 The value is used for checking instead of a home directory;
23164 checking is done in "belowhome" mode.
23166 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
23167 .cindex "de-tainting" "using appendfile create_file option"
23168 If "belowhome" checking is used, the file or directory path
23169 becomes de-tainted.
23172 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
23173 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
23174 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
23175 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
23177 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
23178 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
23179 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
23180 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
23181 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
23183 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23187 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
23189 .vindex "&$inode$&"
23190 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
23191 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
23192 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
23194 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
23196 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
23197 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
23201 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
23202 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
23203 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
23206 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
23207 See &%check_string%& above.
23210 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
23211 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
23212 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
23213 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
23214 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
23215 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
23218 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23221 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23222 .cindex "locking files"
23223 .cindex "lock files"
23224 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
23225 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
23227 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
23228 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
23231 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
23232 file = /home/$local_part_data/inbox
23235 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
23236 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
23237 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
23238 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
23239 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
23240 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
23244 .option file_format appendfile string unset
23245 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
23246 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
23247 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
23248 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
23249 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
23250 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
23251 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
23252 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
23255 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
23256 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
23258 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
23259 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
23260 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
23261 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
23262 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
23263 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
23264 delivery is deferred.
23267 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
23268 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
23269 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
23270 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
23273 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
23274 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23275 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
23276 .cindex "locking files"
23277 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
23278 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
23279 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
23280 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
23281 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
23282 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
23283 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
23284 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
23286 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
23287 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
23288 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
23289 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
23291 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
23292 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
23295 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
23297 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
23298 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
23299 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
23301 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
23302 local deliveries because of errors of the form
23304 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
23307 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
23308 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
23309 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
23310 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
23313 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
23314 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
23315 for details of locking.
23318 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
23319 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
23320 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
23323 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23324 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
23325 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
23328 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
23329 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23330 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
23331 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
23332 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
23335 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
23336 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23337 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23338 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23339 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
23340 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
23341 external source that maintains the data.
23344 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
23345 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23346 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23347 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23348 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
23349 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
23350 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
23351 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
23355 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
23356 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
23357 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
23358 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
23359 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
23360 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
23361 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
23362 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
23363 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
23364 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23367 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
23368 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
23369 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
23370 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
23371 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
23372 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
23373 calculation. The default value is:
23375 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
23377 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
23378 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
23380 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
23382 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
23384 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
23385 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
23386 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
23387 directly into that directory.
23390 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
23391 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
23392 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23395 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
23396 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
23397 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23400 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
23401 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23402 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
23403 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
23404 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
23405 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
23406 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
23407 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23409 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
23410 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
23411 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
23412 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
23413 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
23414 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
23415 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
23416 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
23417 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
23418 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
23421 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
23422 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
23423 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
23424 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
23425 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
23426 below for further details.
23429 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
23430 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23431 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23434 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
23435 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23436 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23439 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
23440 .cindex "locking files"
23441 .cindex "file" "locking"
23442 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
23443 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
23444 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23445 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
23446 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
23447 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
23448 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
23450 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
23451 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
23452 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
23459 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
23460 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
23461 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
23462 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
23463 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
23464 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
23465 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
23466 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
23468 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
23469 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
23470 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
23471 append messages to it.
23474 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23475 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23476 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23477 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23478 in which case it is:
23480 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
23481 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
23483 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23484 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23486 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23487 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23488 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23489 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
23494 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23495 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23497 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23498 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
23499 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
23500 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
23501 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
23502 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
23503 value, and this option is ignored.
23506 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
23507 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
23508 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
23509 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
23510 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
23513 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
23514 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
23515 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
23516 on users about incoming mail.
23519 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
23520 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
23521 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
23522 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
23523 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
23524 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
23525 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
23526 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
23527 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
23529 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
23530 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
23531 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
23533 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
23534 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
23535 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
23536 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
23537 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
23538 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
23540 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
23541 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
23542 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
23543 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
23544 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
23547 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23548 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23550 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
23552 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
23553 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
23554 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
23555 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
23556 system quota failures.
23558 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
23559 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
23560 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
23561 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
23562 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
23563 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
23564 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
23565 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
23566 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
23567 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
23570 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
23571 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
23572 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
23573 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
23574 delivery directory.
23577 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
23578 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
23579 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
23580 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
23581 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
23584 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23585 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23587 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
23588 See &%quota%& above.
23591 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
23592 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
23593 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
23594 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
23595 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
23596 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
23597 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
23599 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
23600 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
23601 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
23602 the file length to the filename. For example:
23604 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
23605 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
23607 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
23608 number of lines in the message.
23610 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
23611 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
23612 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
23614 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
23616 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
23617 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
23618 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
23619 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
23620 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
23621 as is used to adjust the effective size.
23624 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
23625 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
23626 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
23628 quota_warn_message = "\
23629 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
23630 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
23631 This message is automatically created \
23632 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
23633 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
23634 a warning threshold that is\n\
23635 set by the system administrator.\n"
23639 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
23640 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
23641 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
23642 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23643 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
23644 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
23645 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
23646 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
23647 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
23651 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
23653 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
23654 percent sign is ignored.
23656 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
23657 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
23658 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
23659 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
23660 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
23661 &'From:'& line, the default is:
23663 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
23665 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
23666 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
23669 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
23670 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
23674 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
23675 .cindex "envelope from"
23676 .cindex "envelope sender"
23677 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23678 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23679 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23680 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23681 for details of batch SMTP.
23684 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23685 .cindex "carriage return"
23687 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23688 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23689 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23690 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23692 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23693 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23694 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23695 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23696 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23697 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23700 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23701 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23702 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23703 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23704 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23705 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23708 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23709 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23710 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23711 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23712 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23714 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23715 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23716 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23717 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23719 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23720 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23721 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23722 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23723 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23726 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23727 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23730 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23731 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23732 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23733 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23734 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23735 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23736 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23738 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23739 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23740 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23741 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23744 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23745 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23746 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23749 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23750 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23751 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23752 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23753 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23754 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23755 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23756 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23757 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23759 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23760 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23761 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23762 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23767 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23768 .cindex "appending to a file"
23769 .cindex "file" "appending"
23770 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23773 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23777 .cindex "directory creation"
23778 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23779 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23780 &%directory_mode%& option.
23783 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23784 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23788 .cindex "file" "locking"
23789 .cindex "locking files"
23790 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23791 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23792 reliably over NFS, as follows:
23795 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23796 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23797 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23799 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23801 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23802 Unlink the hitching post name.
23804 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23805 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23806 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23807 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23809 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23810 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23811 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23812 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23813 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23814 it before trying again.
23818 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23819 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23820 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23823 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23824 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23825 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23826 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23827 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23828 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23829 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23830 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23831 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23835 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23836 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23837 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23838 delivery is deferred.
23841 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23842 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23843 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23847 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23848 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23849 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23852 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23853 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23854 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23857 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23858 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23859 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23860 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23861 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23862 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23863 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23864 that prevents link following.
23867 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23868 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23869 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23870 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23871 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23874 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23877 .cindex "file" "locking"
23878 .cindex "locking files"
23879 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23880 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23881 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23882 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23883 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23885 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23887 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23888 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23889 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23891 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23892 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23893 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23895 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23896 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23897 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23898 delivery is deferred.
23900 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23901 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23902 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23903 immediately. It retries up to
23905 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23907 times (rounded up).
23910 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23911 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23914 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23915 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23916 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23917 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23918 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23919 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23920 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23921 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23922 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23923 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23925 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23926 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23927 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23928 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23929 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23930 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23931 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23933 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23934 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23935 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23936 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23939 .cindex "maildir format"
23940 .cindex "mailstore format"
23941 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23942 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23943 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23944 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23945 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23947 .cindex "directory creation"
23948 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23949 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23950 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23951 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23952 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23953 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23958 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23959 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23960 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23961 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23962 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23963 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23964 &_new_& subdirectory.
23966 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23967 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23968 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23969 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23970 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23971 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23972 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23974 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23975 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23976 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23977 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23978 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23979 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23980 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23981 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23983 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23984 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23985 folders. Consider this example:
23987 maildir_format = true
23988 directory = /var/mail/$local_part_data\
23989 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23990 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23991 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23993 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23994 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23995 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23996 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23997 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23998 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
24000 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
24001 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
24002 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
24003 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
24004 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
24006 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
24007 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
24008 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
24010 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24011 .cindex "maildir++"
24012 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
24013 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
24014 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
24015 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
24016 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
24017 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
24018 amount of space used.
24020 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
24021 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
24022 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
24023 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
24024 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
24025 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
24030 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
24031 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
24032 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
24033 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
24034 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
24035 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
24038 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
24039 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
24040 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
24041 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
24042 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
24043 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
24044 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
24045 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
24046 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
24047 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
24048 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
24049 backwards compatibility).
24051 For one common implementation, you might set:
24053 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
24055 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
24057 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
24058 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
24059 &[stat()]& each message file.
24062 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
24063 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24064 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
24065 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
24066 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
24067 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
24068 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
24069 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
24070 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
24072 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
24073 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
24074 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
24075 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
24076 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
24077 need to know the quota.
24079 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
24080 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
24082 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
24083 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
24084 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
24088 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
24089 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
24090 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
24091 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
24092 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
24093 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
24094 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
24095 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
24097 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
24098 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
24099 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
24100 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
24101 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
24102 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
24104 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
24105 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
24106 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
24107 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
24108 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
24109 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
24111 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
24112 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
24113 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
24114 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
24117 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
24118 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
24119 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
24120 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
24121 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
24123 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
24125 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
24126 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
24127 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
24128 .ecindex IIDapptra1
24129 .ecindex IIDapptra2
24136 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24137 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24139 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
24140 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
24141 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
24142 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
24143 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
24144 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
24145 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
24146 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
24148 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
24149 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
24150 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
24151 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
24152 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
24155 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
24156 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
24157 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
24158 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
24159 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
24161 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
24162 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
24163 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
24164 transport is run as a consequence of a
24166 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
24167 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
24168 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
24169 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
24170 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
24171 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
24173 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
24174 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
24175 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
24176 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
24178 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
24179 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
24180 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
24181 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
24182 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
24183 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
24184 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
24186 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
24187 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
24188 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
24189 the transport defers.
24190 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
24191 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
24193 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
24194 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
24195 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
24196 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
24198 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24199 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
24200 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
24201 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
24202 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
24203 problems. They are just discarded.
24207 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
24208 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
24210 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
24211 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
24212 message when the message is specified by the transport.
24215 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
24216 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
24217 when the message is specified by the transport.
24220 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
24221 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
24222 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
24223 string comes first.
24226 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
24227 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
24228 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
24231 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
24232 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
24233 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
24236 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
24237 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
24238 specified by the transport.
24241 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
24242 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
24243 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
24244 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
24247 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
24248 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
24249 the message is specified by the transport.
24252 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
24253 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
24257 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
24258 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
24259 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
24260 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
24261 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
24265 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
24266 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
24267 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
24268 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
24270 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
24271 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
24272 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
24273 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
24274 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
24275 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
24276 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
24279 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
24280 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
24281 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
24282 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
24283 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
24285 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
24286 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
24287 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
24288 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
24289 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
24290 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
24293 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
24294 See &%once%& above.
24297 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
24298 See &%once%& above.
24299 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
24302 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
24303 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
24304 specified by the transport.
24307 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
24308 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
24309 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
24310 configuration option.
24313 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
24314 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
24315 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
24316 automatic responses. For example:
24318 subject = Re: $h_subject:
24320 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
24321 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
24322 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
24323 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
24328 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
24329 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
24330 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
24331 the text comes first.
24334 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
24335 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
24336 when the message is specified by the transport.
24337 .ecindex IIDauttra1
24338 .ecindex IIDauttra2
24343 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24344 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24346 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
24347 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
24348 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
24349 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
24350 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
24351 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
24353 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
24354 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
24355 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
24356 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
24357 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
24358 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
24362 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
24363 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
24364 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
24367 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
24368 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24371 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
24372 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24373 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
24374 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
24375 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24378 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
24379 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
24380 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
24381 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
24382 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
24383 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
24386 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
24387 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24388 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
24389 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
24390 in its response to the LHLO command.
24392 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
24393 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
24394 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
24395 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
24398 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
24399 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
24400 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
24401 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
24406 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
24410 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
24411 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
24415 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24416 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24418 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
24419 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
24420 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
24421 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
24422 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
24423 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
24424 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
24425 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
24429 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24430 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
24431 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
24432 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
24433 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
24435 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24436 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
24437 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
24438 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
24439 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
24440 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
24441 that are routed to the transport.
24443 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
24444 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
24445 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
24446 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
24447 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
24448 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
24449 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
24453 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
24454 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
24455 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
24457 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
24458 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
24459 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
24460 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
24461 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
24462 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
24463 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
24465 .cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
24466 .cindex pipe "tainted data"
24467 Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
24470 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
24471 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
24472 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
24473 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
24474 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
24475 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
24476 of "1" to enforce serialization.
24481 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
24482 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
24483 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
24484 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
24485 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
24486 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
24487 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
24488 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
24489 &"local delivery failed"&.
24491 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
24492 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
24493 will be sent as normal.
24495 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
24496 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
24497 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
24498 apply in this case.
24500 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
24501 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
24502 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
24503 a non-existent command may be the problem.
24505 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
24506 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
24507 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
24508 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
24509 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
24510 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
24511 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
24516 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
24517 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
24518 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
24519 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
24520 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
24523 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
24524 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
24525 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
24526 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
24528 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
24529 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
24530 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
24531 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
24532 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
24534 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
24536 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
24537 arguments. You have to write
24539 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
24541 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
24542 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
24543 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
24544 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
24545 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
24546 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
24549 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
24552 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24553 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24554 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24555 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
24556 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
24557 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
24558 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
24559 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
24560 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
24561 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
24562 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
24564 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
24565 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
24566 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
24567 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
24568 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
24569 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
24570 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
24571 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
24573 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
24574 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
24575 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
24576 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
24577 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
24578 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
24579 control what is done with it.
24581 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
24582 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
24583 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
24584 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
24585 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
24586 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
24587 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
24588 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
24589 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
24590 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
24591 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
24595 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
24596 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24597 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24598 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
24599 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
24600 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
24601 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
24602 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
24603 &*Note*&: Using enviroment variables loses track of tainted data.
24604 Writers of &(pipe)& transport commands should be wary of data supplied
24605 by potential attackers.
24607 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
24608 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
24609 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
24610 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
24611 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
24612 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
24613 &`LOGNAME `& see below
24614 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
24615 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
24616 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
24617 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
24618 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
24619 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
24620 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
24621 &`USER `& see below
24623 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
24624 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
24625 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
24626 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
24627 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
24628 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
24629 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
24632 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
24633 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
24634 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
24638 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
24639 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
24640 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
24641 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
24644 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
24645 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
24649 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
24650 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
24651 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24652 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
24653 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
24654 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
24655 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
24656 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
24657 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
24658 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
24659 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
24662 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
24664 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
24665 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
24666 &%use_shell%& is set.
24669 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
24670 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24673 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
24674 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24675 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24678 .option check_string pipe string unset
24679 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
24680 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
24681 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
24682 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24683 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24684 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24685 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24689 .option command pipe string&!! unset
24690 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24691 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24692 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24693 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24694 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24695 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24697 .cindex "tainted data"
24698 No part of the resulting command may be tainted.
24701 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
24702 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24703 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24704 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24705 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24706 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24707 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24710 .option escape_string pipe string unset
24711 See &%check_string%& above.
24714 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24715 .cindex "exec failure"
24716 .cindex "failure of exec"
24717 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24718 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24719 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24720 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24721 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24724 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24725 .cindex "signal exit"
24726 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24727 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24728 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24729 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24732 .option force_command pipe boolean false
24733 .cindex "force command"
24734 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24735 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24736 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24737 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24738 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24739 command. For example:
24741 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24745 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24746 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24747 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24750 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24751 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24752 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24753 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24754 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24755 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24757 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24758 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24761 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24762 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24763 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24764 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24765 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24766 written to the main log.
24769 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24770 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24771 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24772 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24773 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24774 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24778 .option log_output pipe boolean false
24779 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24780 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24781 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24782 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24785 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
24786 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24787 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24788 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24789 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24790 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24791 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24792 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24795 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24796 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24797 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24800 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24804 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
24805 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24806 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24807 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24808 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24813 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24814 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24817 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24818 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24819 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24820 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24824 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24825 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24828 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24829 This option is expanded and
24830 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24831 variable of the subprocess.
24832 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24833 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24834 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24837 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24838 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24839 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24840 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24841 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24842 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24843 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24844 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24845 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24848 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24849 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24850 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24851 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24852 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24853 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24854 accept the message is used.
24857 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24858 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24859 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24860 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24861 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24862 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24865 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24866 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24867 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24868 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24869 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24870 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24871 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24875 .option return_output pipe boolean false
24876 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24877 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24878 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24879 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24880 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24881 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24882 of them may be set.
24886 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24887 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24888 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24889 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24890 and &%return_output%& is not set,
24891 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24892 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24893 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24894 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24895 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24896 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24897 and 73, respectively.
24900 .option timeout pipe time 1h
24901 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24902 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24903 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24904 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24905 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24906 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24908 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24909 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24910 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24911 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24912 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24913 delivery to be deferred.
24915 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24916 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24919 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24920 .cindex "envelope sender"
24921 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24922 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24923 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24924 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24925 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24927 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24928 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24929 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24930 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24931 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24932 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24936 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24937 .cindex "carriage return"
24939 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24940 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24941 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24942 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24944 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24945 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24946 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24947 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24948 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24951 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
24952 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24953 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24954 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24955 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24956 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24957 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24958 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24959 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24964 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24965 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24966 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
24967 .cindex "external local delivery"
24968 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24969 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24970 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24971 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24972 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24973 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24974 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24975 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24976 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24977 configuration for &%procmail%&:
24982 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part_data
24986 check_string = "From "
24987 escape_string = ">From "
24989 user = $local_part_data
24996 transport = procmail_pipe
24998 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24999 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
25000 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
25001 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
25002 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
25003 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
25005 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
25009 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
25010 use a shell to run pipe commands.
25013 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
25014 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
25015 . Used to have R: local_part_suffix = .* + T: -m $local_part_suffix_v
25016 . but that suffix is tainted so cannot be used in a command arg
25017 . Really, you'd want to use a lookup for acceptable suffixes to do real detainting
25020 local_delivery_cyrus:
25022 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
25023 -- $local_part_data
25035 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
25037 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
25038 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
25040 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
25041 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
25044 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25045 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25047 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
25048 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
25049 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
25050 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
25051 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
25052 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
25053 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
25054 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
25057 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
25058 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
25062 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
25063 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
25064 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
25065 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
25066 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
25067 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
25068 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
25070 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
25071 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
25072 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
25073 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
25074 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
25075 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
25080 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
25081 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
25082 no further messages are sent over that connection.
25086 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
25088 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25089 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
25090 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
25091 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
25092 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
25093 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
25094 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
25095 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
25098 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
25099 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
25100 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25101 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25102 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
25103 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
25104 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
25105 are the values that were set when the message was received.
25106 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
25107 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
25108 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
25109 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
25110 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
25111 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
25113 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
25114 and will be removed in a future release.
25117 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
25118 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
25119 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
25122 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
25123 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
25124 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
25125 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
25126 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
25127 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
25128 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
25129 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
25131 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
25132 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
25133 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25134 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
25135 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
25136 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
25137 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
25138 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
25139 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
25142 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
25144 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
25145 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
25146 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
25147 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
25148 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
25151 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
25152 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
25153 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
25154 particular connection.
25156 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
25157 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
25158 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
25159 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
25161 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
25162 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
25163 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
25165 authenticated_sender = $local_part
25167 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
25168 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
25170 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
25171 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
25175 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
25176 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
25177 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
25178 authenticated as a client.
25181 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
25182 .cindex timeout "smtp transport command"
25183 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
25184 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
25185 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
25188 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
25189 .cindex timeout "smtp transport connect"
25190 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
25191 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
25192 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
25193 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
25194 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
25195 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
25198 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
25199 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
25200 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
25201 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25202 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
25203 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
25204 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
25208 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25209 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
25210 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25211 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
25212 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
25213 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
25214 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
25215 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
25216 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
25217 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
25218 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
25219 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
25220 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
25221 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
25224 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
25225 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data blocks"
25226 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
25227 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
25228 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
25231 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
25232 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25233 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
25234 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25235 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
25236 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25237 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
25238 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25239 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
25240 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25241 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
25242 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25243 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
25244 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25245 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
25246 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25247 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
25248 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25251 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
25252 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
25253 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
25254 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
25255 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
25258 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
25259 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
25260 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
25261 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
25262 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
25263 unhappy at this prospect, so...
25265 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25266 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
25267 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25268 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
25269 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
25270 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
25271 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
25272 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
25276 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
25277 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
25278 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
25279 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
25280 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
25283 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
25284 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
25285 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
25286 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
25290 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
25291 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25292 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25293 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25294 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25295 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
25296 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
25297 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
25302 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
25303 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25304 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25305 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25306 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25307 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
25308 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
25309 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
25310 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
25314 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
25315 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
25316 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
25317 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
25318 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
25319 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
25320 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
25322 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
25323 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
25324 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
25325 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
25326 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
25329 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
25330 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25331 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
25332 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
25333 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
25334 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25335 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25336 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
25338 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
25339 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
25340 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
25341 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
25342 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
25343 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
25345 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
25346 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
25347 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
25348 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
25349 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
25351 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
25352 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
25353 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
25354 copy of the message is sent.
25356 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
25357 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
25358 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
25359 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
25363 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
25364 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data accept"
25365 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
25366 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
25369 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
25370 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
25371 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
25372 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
25373 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
25374 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
25376 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
25377 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
25378 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
25379 implementations of TLS.
25381 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
25382 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
25383 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
25384 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
25385 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
25386 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
25387 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
25392 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
25393 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
25394 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
25395 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
25396 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
25397 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
25398 interface address, you could use this:
25400 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address} \
25401 {${listextract{1}{<\n $value}}} \
25402 {$primary_hostname}}
25404 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
25407 .option host_name_extract smtp "string list&!!" "see below"
25408 .cindex "load balancer" "hosts behind"
25409 .cindex TLS resumption
25410 Some mail-accepting sites
25411 (notably Microsoft)
25412 operate many servers behind a network load-balancer. When this is done,
25413 with separated TLS session caches, TLS session resuption becomes problematic.
25414 It will only succeed when the same server happens to be selected by the
25415 load-balancer, matching the session stored in the client's cache.
25417 Exim can pull out a server name, if there is one, from the response to the
25418 client's SMTP EHLO command.
25419 The default value of this option:
25421 ${if and { {match {$host} {.outlook.com\$}} \
25422 {match {$item} {\N^250-([\w.]+)\s\N}} \
25425 suffices for one known case.
25426 During the expansion of this option the &$item$& variable will have the
25427 server's EHLO response.
25428 The result of the option expansion is included in the key used to store and
25429 retrieve the TLS session, for session resumption.
25431 Operators of high-load sites may wish to evaluate their logs for indications
25432 of other destination sites operating load-balancers, and develop a suitable
25433 expression for this option.
25434 The smtp:ehlo event and the &$tls_out_resumption$& variable
25435 will be useful for such work.
25437 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
25438 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
25439 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
25440 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
25441 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
25442 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
25444 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
25445 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
25446 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
25447 &%hosts_override%& is set.
25449 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
25450 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
25451 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
25452 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25453 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25454 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
25455 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
25457 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
25458 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
25459 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
25460 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
25461 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
25462 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
25463 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
25466 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
25467 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
25470 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25471 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
25472 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
25473 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
25474 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25475 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
25476 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
25477 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
25478 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
25479 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
25482 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
25483 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25484 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
25485 Exim will not use the ESMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
25486 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
25488 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
25489 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
25490 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
25491 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
25492 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
25493 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
25495 The retry hints database is used for the record,
25496 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
25497 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
25498 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
25499 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
25501 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
25504 When the facility is used, if the transport &%interface%& option is unset
25505 the &%helo_data%& option
25506 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
25508 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
25509 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
25510 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
25511 You have been warned.
25514 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25515 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25516 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25517 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25519 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25520 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25521 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
25522 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
25523 to any host that matches this list.
25526 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
25527 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25528 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
25529 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
25530 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
25531 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
25532 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
25533 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
25536 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
25537 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
25538 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
25543 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25544 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25545 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25546 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25547 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
25548 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25549 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
25550 explanation of when this might be needed.
25552 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25553 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25554 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25555 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25556 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
25557 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25558 message on the same session.
25560 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
25561 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
25562 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
25563 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
25564 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
25565 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
25570 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
25571 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
25572 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
25573 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
25574 &%fallback_hosts%&.
25577 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
25578 .cindex "randomized host list"
25579 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
25580 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
25581 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
25582 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
25583 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
25584 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
25585 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
25586 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
25588 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
25589 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
25590 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
25591 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
25593 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
25595 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
25596 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
25597 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
25599 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25600 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
25601 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
25602 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
25603 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
25604 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
25605 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
25606 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
25607 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25610 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" "see below"
25611 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25612 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
25613 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25614 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25617 The default is &"**"& if DANE is not in use for the connection,
25618 or if DANE-TA us used.
25619 It is empty if DANE-EE is used.
25622 .option hosts_require_alpn smtp "host list&!!" unset
25623 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in client"
25625 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
25626 If the TLS library supports ALPN
25627 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any host
25628 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
25629 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
25631 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
25632 managed by this option; see &%hosts_require_tls%&.
25634 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
25635 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25636 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
25637 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25638 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25639 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
25640 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25641 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25642 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25644 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25645 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25646 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
25647 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25648 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25650 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25651 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25652 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25653 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25654 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
25655 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
25657 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25658 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
25659 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25660 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
25661 connects. If authentication fails
25662 and &%hosts_require_auth%& permits,
25663 Exim will try to transfer the message unauthenticated.
25664 See also chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25666 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
25667 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
25668 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
25669 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
25670 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25671 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
25672 Unless DKIM signing is being done,
25673 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
25675 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
25676 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25677 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
25678 If built with DANE support, Exim will look up a
25679 TLSA record for any host matching the list,
25680 If one is found and that lookup was DNSSEC-validated,
25681 then Exim requires that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made for that host;
25682 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25683 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25684 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25686 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
25687 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
25688 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
25689 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
25690 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
25691 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
25692 perform a TCP Fast Open.
25693 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
25694 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
25695 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
25697 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
25698 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
25700 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
25701 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
25702 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
25703 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
25704 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
25706 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
25707 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
25708 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
25709 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25710 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
25711 for multi-recipient messages.
25712 The option can usually be left as default.
25714 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
25715 .cindex "bind IP address"
25716 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
25718 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25719 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
25720 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
25721 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
25722 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
25723 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
25724 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
25725 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
25728 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
25729 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
25730 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
25731 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
25732 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
25733 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
25736 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
25738 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
25739 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
25740 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
25741 interface to use if the host has more than one.
25744 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
25745 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
25746 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
25747 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
25748 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
25749 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
25750 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
25751 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
25752 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
25753 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
25757 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
25758 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
25759 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25760 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25761 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25763 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
25764 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25765 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25766 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
25767 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
25768 permits this. A value setting of zero disables the limit.
25771 .option message_linelength_limit smtp integer 998
25772 .cindex "line length" limit
25773 This option sets the maximum line length, in bytes, that the transport
25774 will send. Any messages with lines exceeding the given value
25775 will fail and a failure-DSN ("bounce") message will if possible be returned
25777 The default value is that defined by the SMTP standards.
25779 It is generally wise to also check in the data ACL so that messages
25780 received via SMTP can be refused without producing a bounce.
25783 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
25784 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25785 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
25786 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
25787 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
25788 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
25789 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
25790 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
25792 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
25793 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
25794 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
25796 If the connection is DANE-enabled then this option is ignored;
25797 only messages having the domain used for the DANE TLSA lookup are
25798 sent on the connection.
25800 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
25801 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
25802 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
25803 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
25804 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
25805 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
25806 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
25807 variable that contains an outgoing port.
25809 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
25810 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
25812 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
25813 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25814 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25817 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25818 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25822 .option protocol smtp string smtp
25823 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25824 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25825 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25827 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25828 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25829 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25830 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25831 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25833 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25834 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25835 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25836 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25837 but as of RFC 8314 it is preferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25838 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25841 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25842 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25843 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25844 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25845 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25846 addresses is not affected.
25848 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25849 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25850 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25851 Exim to use only the host name.
25852 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25855 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25856 .cindex "serializing connections"
25857 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25858 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25859 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25860 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25861 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25862 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25863 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25865 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25866 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25867 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25868 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25869 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25870 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25872 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25873 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25874 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25875 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25876 are used for ETRN serialization.
25878 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25881 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25882 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
25883 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25884 .cindex "size" "of message"
25885 .cindex "transport" "filter"
25886 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25887 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25888 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25889 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25890 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25891 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25892 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25894 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25895 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25898 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25899 .cindex proxy SOCKS
25900 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25901 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25904 .option tls_alpn smtp string&!! unset
25905 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
25907 .cindex ALPN "set name in client"
25908 If this option is set
25909 and the TLS library supports ALPN,
25910 the value given is used.
25912 As of writing no value has been standardised for email use.
25913 The authors suggest using &"smtp"&.
25917 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25918 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25919 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25921 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25922 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25923 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25924 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25925 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25928 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25929 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25930 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25931 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25935 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25936 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25937 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25938 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25939 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25942 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25943 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25944 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25945 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25946 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25947 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25950 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25953 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25954 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25956 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25957 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25958 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25959 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25960 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25961 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25962 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25963 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25966 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25967 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25968 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25970 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25971 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25972 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25973 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25974 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25975 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25976 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25977 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25978 ciphers is a preference order.
25981 .option tls_resumption_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25982 .cindex TLS resumption
25983 This option controls which connections to use the TLS resumption feature.
25984 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
25988 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25989 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25991 .cindex SNI "setting in client"
25992 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25993 If this option is set
25994 and the connection is not DANE-validated
25995 then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25996 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25997 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25998 certificate and private key for the session.
26000 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
26002 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
26008 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
26009 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
26010 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
26011 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
26012 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
26013 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
26014 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
26015 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
26016 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26017 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26021 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
26022 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26023 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26024 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26025 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
26026 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26027 Note that unless the host is in this list
26028 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
26029 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
26030 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
26031 certificate verification succeeds.
26034 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
26035 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
26036 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26037 This option give a list of hosts for which,
26038 while verifying the server certificate,
26039 checks will be included on the host name
26040 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
26041 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
26042 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
26044 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
26047 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
26048 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26049 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26051 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26052 The value of this option must be either the
26054 or the absolute path to
26055 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
26056 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
26058 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
26059 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
26060 is taken as empty and an explicit location
26063 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
26064 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
26066 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
26068 either by file or directory
26069 are added to those given by the system default location.
26071 The values of &$host$& and
26072 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26073 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26075 For back-compatibility,
26076 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
26077 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
26078 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
26081 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26082 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26083 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26084 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26085 certificate verification must succeed.
26086 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26087 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
26088 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
26089 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
26090 that connections use TLS.
26091 Fallback to in-clear communication will be done unless restricted by
26092 the &%hosts_require_tls%& option.
26094 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer&!! -1
26095 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
26096 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
26097 If built with internationalization support,
26098 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
26100 If, after expansion, the value is 1, 0, or -1 then this value overrides
26101 any value previously set for the message. Otherwise, any previously
26102 set value is used. To permit use of a previous value,
26103 set this option to an empty string.
26104 For details on the values see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
26109 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
26111 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
26112 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
26113 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
26114 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
26115 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
26118 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
26119 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
26120 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
26121 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
26124 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
26125 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
26126 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
26128 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
26129 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
26130 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
26131 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
26132 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
26134 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
26135 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
26136 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
26137 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
26138 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
26139 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
26140 see below for an exception).
26142 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
26143 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
26144 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
26145 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
26146 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
26148 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
26149 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
26150 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
26151 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
26152 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
26153 reached their retry times.
26155 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
26156 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
26157 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
26158 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
26159 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
26160 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
26161 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
26162 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
26163 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
26164 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
26167 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
26168 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
26169 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
26170 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
26171 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
26172 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
26174 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
26175 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
26176 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
26177 possible IP addresses have been tried.
26178 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
26179 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
26185 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26186 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26188 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
26189 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
26190 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
26191 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
26192 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
26193 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
26195 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
26196 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
26197 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26198 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
26199 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
26200 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
26201 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
26203 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
26204 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
26205 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
26206 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
26209 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
26210 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
26211 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
26212 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
26214 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
26215 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
26216 facility; you do not have to use it.
26218 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
26219 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
26220 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
26221 address to which it applies.
26223 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
26224 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
26225 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
26226 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
26227 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
26228 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
26231 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
26232 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
26233 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
26234 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
26237 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
26238 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
26239 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
26240 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
26241 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
26244 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
26245 illustrated by these examples:
26248 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
26249 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
26250 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
26251 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
26253 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
26254 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
26259 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
26260 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
26261 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
26262 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
26263 message's processing.
26265 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26266 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
26267 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&), but no
26268 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
26269 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
26270 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
26271 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
26272 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
26273 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
26275 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26276 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26277 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
26278 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
26279 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
26280 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
26281 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
26282 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
26283 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
26284 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
26286 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
26287 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
26288 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
26289 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
26290 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
26291 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
26293 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
26294 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
26295 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
26297 .cindex "envelope from"
26298 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
26299 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
26300 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
26301 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
26302 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
26303 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
26304 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
26305 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
26306 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
26308 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
26309 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
26315 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
26316 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
26317 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
26318 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
26319 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
26320 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
26321 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
26322 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
26323 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
26324 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
26326 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
26328 might produce the output
26330 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26331 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26332 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26333 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26334 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26335 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26336 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26337 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26339 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
26340 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
26341 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
26342 set for a particular transport.
26345 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
26346 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
26347 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
26350 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
26352 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
26353 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
26354 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
26355 any colons must be doubled, of course).
26357 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
26358 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
26359 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
26360 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
26363 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
26364 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
26365 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
26367 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
26368 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
26369 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
26370 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
26371 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
26372 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
26373 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
26375 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26376 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26377 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
26378 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
26379 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
26383 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
26384 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26387 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
26388 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
26389 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
26390 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
26391 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
26392 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
26393 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
26394 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
26395 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
26397 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
26398 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
26399 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
26401 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
26402 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
26403 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
26404 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
26405 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
26406 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
26407 of pattern they are set as follows:
26410 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
26411 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
26412 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
26415 *queen@*.fict.example
26417 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
26419 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
26423 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
26424 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
26427 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
26428 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
26429 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
26430 rewriting rule of the form
26432 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
26434 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
26440 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
26441 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
26442 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
26443 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
26444 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
26448 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
26449 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
26450 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
26451 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
26452 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
26454 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
26456 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
26459 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26460 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26461 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
26462 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
26463 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26464 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
26465 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
26466 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
26467 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
26468 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
26469 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
26470 entry written to the panic log.
26474 .subsection "Rewriting flags" "SSECID153"
26475 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
26478 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
26481 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
26483 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
26486 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
26487 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
26491 .subsection "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
26493 .cindex rewriting flags
26494 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
26495 &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
26496 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
26497 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
26498 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
26500 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
26501 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
26502 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
26503 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
26504 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
26505 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
26506 &`h`& rewrite all headers
26507 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
26508 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
26509 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
26511 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
26512 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
26513 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
26515 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
26516 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
26519 .subsection "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" SSECTrewriteS
26520 .cindex SMTP "rewriting malformed addresses"
26521 .cindex RCPT "rewriting argument of"
26522 .cindex MAIL "rewriting argument of"
26523 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
26524 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
26525 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
26526 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
26527 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
26529 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26530 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26531 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
26532 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
26533 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
26534 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
26535 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
26536 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
26539 .subsection "Flags controlling the rewriting process" SSECID155
26540 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
26541 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
26542 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
26545 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
26546 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
26547 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
26549 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
26550 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
26551 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
26552 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
26554 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
26555 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
26556 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
26558 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
26559 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
26560 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
26561 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
26563 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
26567 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
26570 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
26571 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
26572 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
26573 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
26574 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
26575 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
26576 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
26577 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
26579 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
26580 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
26584 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
26585 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
26587 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
26588 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
26589 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
26591 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
26592 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
26593 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
26594 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
26595 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
26596 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
26597 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
26598 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
26600 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
26601 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
26603 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
26605 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
26606 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
26608 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
26609 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
26610 messages that originate outside the local host:
26612 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
26613 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
26615 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
26618 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
26619 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
26620 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
26621 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
26622 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
26623 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
26624 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
26625 components. For example, the rule
26627 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
26629 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
26630 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
26631 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
26632 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
26633 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
26634 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
26635 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
26642 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26643 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26645 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
26646 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
26647 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
26648 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
26649 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
26650 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
26651 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
26652 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
26653 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
26654 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
26655 address, domain and error.
26657 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
26658 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
26659 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
26660 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
26661 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
26662 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
26663 log selector is set, the message
26664 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
26665 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
26666 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
26667 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
26669 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
26670 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
26671 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
26672 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
26673 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
26674 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
26675 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
26676 domain are maintained independently.
26678 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
26679 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
26680 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
26681 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
26682 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
26683 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
26684 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
26685 the local address is reached.
26687 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
26688 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
26689 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
26690 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
26691 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
26693 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
26694 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
26695 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
26696 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
26697 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
26698 messages that it should now be retaining.
26702 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
26703 .cindex "retry" "rules"
26704 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
26705 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
26706 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
26707 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
26708 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
26709 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
26710 message's sender, respectively.
26713 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
26714 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
26715 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
26716 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
26717 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
26718 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
26721 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26723 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
26726 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26728 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
26729 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
26732 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
26733 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
26734 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
26735 expressions work in address lists.
26737 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
26738 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
26742 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
26743 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
26744 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
26745 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
26746 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
26747 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
26748 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
26749 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
26750 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
26752 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
26753 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
26754 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
26755 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
26758 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
26759 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
26760 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
26761 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
26762 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
26763 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
26764 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
26765 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
26766 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
26767 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
26772 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
26774 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
26775 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
26776 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
26777 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
26778 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
26779 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
26781 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
26785 and the retry rules are
26787 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
26788 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
26790 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
26791 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
26792 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
26793 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
26794 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
26795 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
26797 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
26798 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
26799 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
26800 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
26802 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
26803 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
26804 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
26806 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
26808 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
26809 textual form of the IP address.
26811 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
26812 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
26813 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
26814 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
26817 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
26818 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
26819 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
26821 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
26822 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
26823 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
26825 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
26826 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
26828 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
26829 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
26832 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
26833 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
26834 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
26835 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
26836 retry rule of this form:
26838 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
26840 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
26841 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
26844 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
26845 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26846 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26847 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26850 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26851 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26852 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26853 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26854 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26856 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
26857 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26859 .vitem &%refused_A%&
26860 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26863 A connection was refused.
26865 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26866 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26868 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26869 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26871 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26872 A connection attempt timed out.
26874 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26875 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26876 obtained from an MX record.
26878 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
26879 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26880 obtained from an MX record.
26883 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26885 .vitem &%tls_required%&
26886 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26887 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26888 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26891 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26894 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26895 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26896 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26897 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26898 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26899 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26903 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26904 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26905 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26906 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26907 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26911 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26912 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26913 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26915 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26916 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26917 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26918 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26919 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26920 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26921 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26923 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26924 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26927 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26928 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26929 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26934 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26935 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26936 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26937 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26938 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26941 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26943 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26945 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26947 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26948 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26951 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26953 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26954 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26955 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26956 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26957 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26959 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26960 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
26962 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26964 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26965 list is never matched.
26971 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26972 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26973 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26974 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26976 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26978 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26979 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26980 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26981 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26982 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26984 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26985 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26986 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26987 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26988 The available algorithms are:
26991 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26994 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26995 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26996 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26998 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26999 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
27000 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
27001 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
27002 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
27003 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
27004 queue processing times.
27007 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
27008 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
27009 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
27010 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
27011 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
27012 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
27013 interval is found. The main configuration variable
27014 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
27015 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
27016 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
27017 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
27018 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
27020 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
27021 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
27022 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
27023 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
27024 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
27025 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
27028 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
27029 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
27030 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
27031 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
27032 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
27033 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
27034 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
27035 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
27036 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
27037 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
27038 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
27039 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
27041 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
27042 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
27043 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
27044 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
27045 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
27046 deliveries that have been deferred.
27049 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
27050 Here are some example retry rules:
27052 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
27053 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
27054 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
27055 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27056 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
27057 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
27059 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
27060 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
27061 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
27062 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
27063 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
27064 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
27065 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
27068 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
27069 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
27070 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
27071 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
27072 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
27074 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
27075 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
27076 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
27077 were not obtained from an MX record.
27079 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
27080 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
27081 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
27082 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
27083 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
27087 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
27088 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
27089 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
27090 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
27091 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
27092 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
27093 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
27094 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
27095 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
27096 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
27097 failing for the first time.
27099 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
27100 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
27101 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
27102 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
27104 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
27105 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
27106 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
27111 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
27112 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
27113 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
27114 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
27115 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
27116 default retry rule:
27118 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
27120 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
27121 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
27122 failure for the recipient address that counts.
27124 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
27125 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
27126 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
27127 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
27128 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
27130 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
27131 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
27132 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
27134 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
27135 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
27136 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
27137 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
27138 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
27139 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
27140 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
27141 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
27142 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
27143 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
27144 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
27146 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
27147 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
27148 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
27149 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
27150 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
27153 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
27154 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
27155 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
27156 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
27157 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
27158 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
27159 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
27160 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
27161 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
27164 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
27165 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
27166 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
27167 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
27168 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
27169 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
27170 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
27171 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
27174 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
27175 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
27176 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
27177 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
27178 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
27179 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
27180 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
27181 time out the address.
27183 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
27184 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
27185 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
27186 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
27187 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
27188 considered immediately.
27189 .ecindex IIDretconf1
27190 .ecindex IIDregconf2
27197 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27198 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27200 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
27201 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
27202 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
27203 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
27204 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
27205 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
27206 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
27207 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
27208 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
27211 The name of an authenticator is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
27212 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
27215 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
27216 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
27217 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
27220 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
27221 the client's EHLO command.
27223 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
27224 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
27226 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
27227 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
27228 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
27229 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
27230 with the AUTH command.
27232 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
27234 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
27235 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
27236 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27239 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
27240 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
27241 unauthenticated connection.
27244 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
27245 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
27246 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
27247 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
27249 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
27250 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
27251 &`Connected to server.example.`&
27252 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
27253 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
27254 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
27255 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
27256 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
27261 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
27262 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
27263 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
27264 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
27265 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
27266 included by setting
27269 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
27273 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
27278 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
27279 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
27280 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
27281 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
27282 work via a socket interface.
27283 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
27284 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
27285 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
27286 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
27287 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
27288 supporting setting a server keytab.
27289 The seventh can be configured to support
27290 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
27291 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
27292 The eighth authenticator
27293 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
27294 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
27295 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
27297 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
27298 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
27299 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
27300 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
27301 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
27302 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
27303 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
27305 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
27306 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
27307 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
27308 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
27309 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
27310 both sets of options, is required. For example:
27314 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27315 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
27317 client_secret = secret2
27319 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
27320 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
27322 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
27323 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
27324 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
27327 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
27328 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
27329 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
27330 authenticating data.
27332 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
27333 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
27334 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
27335 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
27336 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
27337 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
27338 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
27339 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
27340 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
27341 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
27344 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
27345 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
27346 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
27347 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
27351 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
27352 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
27353 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
27355 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27356 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
27357 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
27358 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
27359 encrypted by a setting such as:
27361 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27365 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27366 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
27367 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
27368 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
27371 .option driver authenticators string unset
27372 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
27373 authenticators is to be used.
27376 .option public_name authenticators string unset
27377 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
27378 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
27379 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
27380 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
27381 defaults to the driver's instance name.
27384 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27385 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
27386 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
27387 mechanism is not advertised.
27388 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
27389 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
27390 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
27393 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27394 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
27395 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
27398 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
27399 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
27401 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
27402 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
27403 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
27404 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
27405 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
27406 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
27407 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27408 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
27409 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
27413 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
27414 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
27415 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
27416 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
27417 out the values of variables.
27418 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
27419 output, and Exim carries on processing.
27422 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27423 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27424 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
27425 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
27426 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
27427 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
27428 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
27429 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
27430 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
27431 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
27432 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
27433 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
27436 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27437 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
27438 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
27439 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
27440 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
27441 remembered for later use.
27442 How it is used is described in the following section.
27448 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
27449 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
27450 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27451 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
27452 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
27456 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
27457 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
27459 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
27461 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
27462 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
27463 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
27464 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
27465 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
27466 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
27467 given for the MAIL command.
27469 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
27470 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
27473 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
27474 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
27475 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
27476 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
27477 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
27478 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
27479 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
27484 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
27485 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
27486 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
27487 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
27489 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
27490 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
27491 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
27492 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
27493 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
27498 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
27499 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
27500 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
27501 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
27505 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
27507 If the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
27508 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
27511 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
27512 the mechanisms are advertised.
27514 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
27515 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
27516 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
27517 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
27518 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
27519 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
27520 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
27522 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
27524 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
27526 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
27527 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
27528 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
27531 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
27533 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27534 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
27535 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
27537 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
27538 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
27539 command. This is the case if
27542 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
27544 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
27546 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
27547 server authenticators.
27551 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
27552 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
27553 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
27555 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
27556 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
27557 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
27558 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
27559 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
27560 rejected with a 504 error.
27562 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
27563 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
27564 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
27565 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
27566 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
27567 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
27568 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
27569 no successful authentication.
27571 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
27572 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
27573 &%authresults%& expansion item.
27576 .cindex authentication "failure event, server"
27577 If an authenticator is run and does not succeed,
27578 an event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "auth:fail" is raised.
27579 While the event is being processed the variables
27580 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
27581 and &$authenticated_fail_id$& (as set by the authenticator &%server_set_id%& option)
27583 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged
27584 instead of the default log line.
27585 See <<CHAPevents>> for details on events.
27589 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
27590 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
27591 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
27592 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
27593 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
27594 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
27595 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
27599 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
27601 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
27602 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
27603 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
27604 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
27605 command line to run this script on such data might be
27607 encode '\0user\0password'
27609 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
27610 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
27611 whose code value is zero.
27613 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
27614 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
27615 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
27616 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
27618 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
27619 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
27620 example, a command such as
27622 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
27624 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
27626 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to produce
27627 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
27629 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
27631 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
27632 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
27633 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
27634 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
27638 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
27639 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
27640 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
27641 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
27642 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
27643 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
27646 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
27647 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
27648 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
27649 of the authenticator.
27652 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27653 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
27654 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
27655 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
27656 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
27657 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
27658 delivery to be deferred.
27660 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
27661 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
27662 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
27667 .cindex authentication "failure event, client"
27668 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code),
27669 an event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "auth:fail" is raised.
27670 While the event is being processed the variable
27671 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
27673 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged.
27674 See <<CHAPevents>> for details on events.
27678 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
27679 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
27680 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
27681 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
27682 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
27683 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
27684 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
27685 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
27686 deliver the message unauthenticated.
27689 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
27690 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
27691 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
27692 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
27693 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
27694 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
27695 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
27696 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
27698 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
27700 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27701 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
27702 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
27703 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
27704 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
27705 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
27706 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
27707 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
27708 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
27709 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
27710 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
27711 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
27712 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
27719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27720 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27722 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
27723 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
27724 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
27725 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
27726 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
27727 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
27728 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
27729 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
27730 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
27731 connections as you do for login accounts.
27733 .section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
27734 The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
27735 TLS is not being used:
27737 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
27738 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
27741 &*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
27742 but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
27743 (including their names) have been properly verified.
27745 .section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
27746 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
27747 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
27749 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27750 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
27751 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
27753 .option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
27754 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
27755 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
27758 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
27759 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27760 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27761 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27762 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27763 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27764 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27766 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
27767 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27768 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27769 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
27770 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
27771 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
27772 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
27774 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
27775 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
27776 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27777 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27779 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
27780 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
27781 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
27783 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27784 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
27785 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27786 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27787 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27788 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27789 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27790 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27791 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27792 string as the error text.
27794 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
27795 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
27796 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
27800 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
27801 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
27802 .cindex authentication PLAIN
27803 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27804 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
27805 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
27806 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
27807 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
27809 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
27810 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
27811 configured as follows:
27815 public_name = PLAIN
27817 server_condition = \
27818 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
27819 server_set_id = $auth2
27821 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
27822 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
27823 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
27824 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
27826 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
27827 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
27828 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
27829 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
27833 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
27835 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
27837 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
27838 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
27842 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
27843 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
27845 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
27846 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
27847 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
27848 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
27849 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
27851 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
27852 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
27853 authenticating clients it could make sense.
27855 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
27856 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
27857 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
27858 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
27859 This is an incorrect example:
27861 server_condition = \
27862 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
27864 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
27865 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
27866 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
27867 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
27868 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
27869 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
27870 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
27872 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
27873 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
27875 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
27876 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
27877 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
27878 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
27879 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
27882 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
27883 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27884 .cindex authentication LOGIN
27885 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27886 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27887 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27888 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27892 public_name = LOGIN
27893 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27894 server_condition = \
27895 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27896 server_set_id = $auth1
27898 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27899 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27900 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27901 strings are used to obtain two data items.
27903 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27904 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27905 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27906 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27907 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27911 public_name = LOGIN
27912 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27913 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27916 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27917 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27918 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27919 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27921 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27922 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27923 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27924 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27925 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27926 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27927 uninterpreted string.
27930 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27931 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27932 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27933 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27934 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27940 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27941 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27942 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27944 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27945 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27946 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27947 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27950 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27951 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27952 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27953 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27954 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27955 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27956 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27957 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27958 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27959 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27960 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27961 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27963 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27964 splitting takes priority and happens first.
27966 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27967 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27968 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27969 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27972 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27973 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27977 public_name = PLAIN
27978 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27980 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27981 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs.
27982 Note that due to the ambiguity of parsing three consectutive circumflex characters
27983 there is no way to provide a password having a leading circumflex.
27987 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27991 public_name = LOGIN
27992 client_send = : username : mysecret
27994 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27995 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27997 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27998 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
28003 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28004 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28006 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
28007 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28008 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
28009 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
28010 .cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
28011 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
28012 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
28013 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
28014 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
28015 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
28016 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
28017 available in plain text at either end.
28020 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
28021 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
28022 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
28023 authenticator as a server:
28025 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28026 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28027 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
28028 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
28029 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
28030 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
28031 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
28032 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
28033 returned to the client.
28035 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
28036 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
28037 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
28038 numeric variables for other things.
28040 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
28041 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
28042 user name, authentication fails.
28046 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28047 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
28048 server_set_id = $auth1
28050 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28051 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
28052 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
28053 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
28057 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28058 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
28060 server_set_id = $auth1
28062 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
28063 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
28065 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
28066 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
28067 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
28072 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28073 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
28074 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28075 server_set_id = $auth1
28078 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
28079 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
28080 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
28084 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
28085 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
28086 computing the response to the server's challenge.
28089 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28090 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
28091 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
28095 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28096 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
28097 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
28098 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
28099 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
28100 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
28101 send the message to the current server.
28103 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
28108 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28110 client_secret = secret
28112 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
28113 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
28117 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28118 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28120 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
28121 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
28122 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
28123 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
28125 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
28126 at A L Digital Ltd.
28128 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
28129 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
28130 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
28131 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
28132 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
28134 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
28135 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
28136 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
28137 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
28139 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
28140 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
28141 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
28142 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
28143 depending on the driver you are using.
28145 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
28146 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
28147 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
28148 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
28149 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
28152 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
28153 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
28154 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
28155 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
28156 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
28157 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
28158 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
28159 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
28162 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
28163 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
28164 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
28165 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
28166 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
28167 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
28171 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
28172 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28173 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
28174 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
28177 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
28178 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28179 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28180 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28184 driver = cyrus_sasl
28185 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28186 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28187 server_set_id = $auth1
28190 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
28191 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28194 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
28195 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28198 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
28199 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
28200 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
28201 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
28204 driver = cyrus_sasl
28205 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28206 server_set_id = $auth1
28209 driver = cyrus_sasl
28210 public_name = PLAIN
28211 server_set_id = $auth2
28213 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
28214 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
28215 but it is present in many binary distributions.
28216 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
28217 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
28222 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28223 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28224 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
28225 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
28226 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
28227 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
28228 Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
28229 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
28230 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
28231 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
28232 authenticator only. There is only one option:
28234 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
28236 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
28237 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
28238 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
28239 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
28243 public_name = PLAIN
28244 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28245 server_set_id = $auth1
28250 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28251 server_set_id = $auth1
28253 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
28254 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
28255 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
28256 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
28257 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
28258 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
28260 The Dovecot configuration to match the above will look
28263 conf.d/10-master.conf :-
28268 unix_listener auth-client {
28275 conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
28277 auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
28280 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
28281 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
28284 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28285 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28286 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
28287 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
28288 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
28289 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
28290 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
28291 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28292 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28293 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
28294 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
28295 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
28296 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
28297 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
28298 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
28299 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
28300 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
28301 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
28302 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
28303 without code changes in Exim.
28305 The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
28306 realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
28307 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
28310 To see the list of mechanisms supported by the library run Exim with "auth" debug
28311 enabled and look for a line containing "GNU SASL supports".
28312 Note however that some may not have been tested from Exim.
28315 .option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
28316 This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
28317 which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
28318 by &%client_username%& option.
28319 If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
28320 which is the common case.
28322 .option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28323 See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
28325 .option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
28326 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28327 the password to be used, in clear.
28329 .option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
28330 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28331 the account name to be used.
28334 .option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
28335 This option is only supported for library versions 1.9.1 and greater.
28336 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY will be defined when this is so.
28338 If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
28339 and correctly sized
28340 it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
28341 The value after expansion should be
28342 a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
28343 with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
28345 Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
28346 supplied by the server.
28347 The option is expanded before use.
28348 During the expansion &$auth1$& is set with the client username,
28349 &$auth2$& with the iteration count, and
28350 &$auth3$& with the salt.
28352 The intent of this option
28353 is to support clients that can cache thes salted password
28354 to save on recalculation costs.
28355 The cache lookup should return an unusable value
28356 (eg. an empty string)
28357 if the salt or iteration count has changed
28359 If the authentication succeeds then the above variables are set,
28360 .vindex "&$auth4$&"
28361 plus the calculated salted password value value in &$auth4$&,
28362 during the expansion of the &%client_set_id%& option.
28363 A side-effect of this expansion can be used to prime the cache.
28366 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28367 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
28368 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
28369 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
28370 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
28373 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
28374 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
28375 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
28378 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
28379 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
28380 When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
28382 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
28383 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
28384 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
28386 . However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
28387 . Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
28388 . with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
28390 This option was deprecated in previous releases due to doubts over
28391 the "Triple Handshake" vulnerability.
28392 Exim takes suitable precausions (requiring Extended Master Secret if TLS
28393 Session Resumption was used) for safety.
28396 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
28397 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28398 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28399 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28402 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
28403 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28404 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28405 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28410 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28411 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28412 server_set_id = $auth1
28416 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
28417 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
28418 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
28419 the password itself.
28421 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
28422 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
28423 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
28424 if available, else the empty string.
28425 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
28426 else the empty string.
28428 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
28430 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
28431 option to be simply "true".
28434 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
28435 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28436 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28439 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
28440 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28441 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28442 when this option is expanded.
28444 The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
28445 and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
28446 a compute cost factor imposed on the client
28447 (if it does not cache results, or the server changes
28448 either the iteration count or the salt).
28449 A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
28450 for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
28452 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
28453 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28454 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28455 when this option is expanded.
28456 The value should be a base64-encoded string,
28457 of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
28458 If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
28459 protocol conversation.
28462 .option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
28463 .option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
28464 These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
28465 to provide stored information related to a password,
28466 the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
28468 &%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
28469 &%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
28471 They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
28472 When this is so, the macros
28473 _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
28474 and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
28477 The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
28479 If set, the results of expansion should for each
28480 should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
28481 of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
28482 &%server_password%& option.
28483 If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
28485 The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
28486 to generate these values.
28489 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
28490 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28491 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28494 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
28495 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28496 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
28497 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
28499 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
28500 meanings for these variables:
28503 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28504 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
28506 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28507 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
28509 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
28510 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
28513 On a per-mechanism basis:
28516 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28517 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
28518 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28520 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28521 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
28522 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28524 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28525 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
28526 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
28527 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28530 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
28531 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
28532 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
28535 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
28536 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
28538 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
28540 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28541 server_realm = imap.example.org
28542 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
28543 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28544 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
28545 server_condition = yes
28549 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28550 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28552 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
28553 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
28554 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
28555 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28556 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
28557 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
28558 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
28561 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
28562 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
28563 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
28564 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28566 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
28567 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
28568 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
28569 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
28571 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
28572 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
28573 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
28577 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
28578 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
28579 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
28580 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
28582 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
28583 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
28584 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
28585 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
28587 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28589 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28590 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
28592 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28593 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
28594 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
28599 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28600 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28602 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
28603 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
28604 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
28605 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
28606 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
28607 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
28608 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
28609 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
28610 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
28611 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
28612 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
28613 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
28614 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
28618 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
28619 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
28621 The server sends back a challenge.
28623 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
28624 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
28627 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
28631 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
28632 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
28633 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
28635 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
28636 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
28637 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
28638 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
28639 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
28640 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
28641 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
28642 for other things. For example:
28647 server_password = \
28648 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
28650 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28651 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28657 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
28658 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
28659 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
28663 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
28664 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
28667 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
28668 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
28671 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
28672 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
28673 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
28679 client_username = msn/msn_username
28680 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
28681 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
28683 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
28684 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
28690 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28691 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28693 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
28694 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
28695 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
28696 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28697 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
28698 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28699 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
28700 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
28701 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
28702 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
28703 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
28704 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
28705 by the server configuration.
28707 The client presents an identity in-clear.
28708 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
28709 and for clients to only attempt,
28710 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
28712 One possible use, compatible with the
28713 K-9 Mail Android client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
28714 is for using X509 client certificates.
28716 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
28717 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
28718 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
28719 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
28720 client certificates only.
28722 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
28723 client-certificate authentication is being done.
28725 The client must present a certificate,
28726 for which it must have been requested via the
28727 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28728 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28729 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
28730 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
28732 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
28733 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
28734 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
28736 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
28737 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
28738 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28739 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
28740 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
28741 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28742 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28744 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
28746 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
28747 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28748 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28749 "in &(external)& authenticator"
28750 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28751 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28753 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
28754 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28755 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28756 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
28757 an identity for authentication and
28758 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
28760 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
28761 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
28762 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28763 string expansions that also use them for other things.
28765 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28766 Once an identity has been received,
28767 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28768 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28769 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28770 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28771 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28772 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28773 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28774 string as the error text.
28778 ext_ccert_san_mail:
28780 public_name = EXTERNAL
28782 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
28783 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28784 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28785 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
28786 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
28787 server_set_id = $auth1
28789 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28790 of your configured trust-anchors
28791 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28792 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
28794 &*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
28795 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28796 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28800 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
28801 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
28802 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
28804 .option client_send external string&!! unset
28805 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
28806 identity being asserted.
28812 public_name = EXTERNAL
28814 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
28815 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
28819 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
28820 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
28826 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28827 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28829 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
28830 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
28831 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
28832 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28833 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
28834 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28835 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
28836 authentication based on client certificates.
28838 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
28839 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
28840 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
28841 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
28842 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
28843 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
28845 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
28846 for which it must have been requested via the
28847 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28848 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28850 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
28851 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
28852 and can authenticate the connection.
28853 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
28855 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
28858 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
28859 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
28861 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
28862 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
28863 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
28864 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
28865 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28866 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28868 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
28869 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
28870 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
28872 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
28879 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28880 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28881 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
28884 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
28885 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
28886 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
28888 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
28890 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28891 of your configured trust-anchors
28892 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28893 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
28895 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
28896 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28897 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28899 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
28901 . An alternative might use
28903 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
28905 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
28906 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
28907 . This would help for per-device use.
28909 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
28910 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
28912 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
28913 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
28916 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
28917 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
28918 a connect- or helo-ACL.
28922 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28923 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28925 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
28926 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
28927 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
28928 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
28929 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
28932 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
28933 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
28934 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
28935 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
28936 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
28937 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
28938 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
28939 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
28940 certificates are used.
28942 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
28943 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
28944 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
28945 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
28946 between them is encrypted.
28948 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
28949 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
28950 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
28951 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
28954 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
28955 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
28956 in order to get TLS to work.
28960 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
28962 .cindex "submissions protocol"
28963 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
28964 .cindex "smtps protocol"
28965 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
28966 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
28967 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
28968 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
28969 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
28970 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
28971 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
28972 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
28974 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
28975 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
28976 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
28978 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
28979 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
28980 reassigned for other use.
28981 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
28983 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
28984 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
28985 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
28987 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
28988 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
28989 the most common use is expected to be:
28991 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
28993 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
28994 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
28995 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
28996 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
28997 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
29000 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
29001 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
29008 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
29009 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
29010 TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
29011 To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
29017 To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
29023 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
29024 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
29026 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
29029 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
29030 cannot be the path of a directory
29031 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
29032 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
29034 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
29036 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29037 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
29038 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
29039 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
29040 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
29042 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
29043 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
29044 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
29045 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
29046 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
29047 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
29048 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
29051 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
29052 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
29054 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
29055 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
29056 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
29057 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
29059 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
29060 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
29062 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
29063 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
29064 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
29065 implementation, then patches are welcome.
29067 The output from "exim -bV" will show which (if any) support was included
29069 Also, the macro "_HAVE_OPENSSL" or "_HAVE_GNUTLS" will be defined.
29073 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
29074 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
29075 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
29076 but not the chosen filename.
29077 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
29078 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
29080 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
29081 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
29082 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
29083 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
29085 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
29086 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
29087 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
29088 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
29089 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
29090 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
29091 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
29093 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
29094 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
29095 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
29096 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
29097 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
29099 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
29100 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
29101 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
29102 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
29103 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
29104 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
29106 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
29107 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
29108 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
29110 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
29111 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
29112 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
29113 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
29116 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
29119 # chown exim:exim new-params
29120 # chmod 0600 new-params
29121 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
29122 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
29123 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
29124 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
29125 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
29126 # chmod 0400 new-params
29127 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
29129 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
29130 stalling is removed.
29132 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
29133 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
29134 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
29135 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
29136 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
29137 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
29138 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
29139 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
29140 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
29141 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
29142 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
29144 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
29145 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
29146 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
29147 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
29149 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
29150 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
29151 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
29152 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
29153 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
29156 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
29157 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
29158 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
29159 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
29160 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
29161 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
29162 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
29163 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
29164 directly to this function call.
29165 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
29166 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
29167 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
29168 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
29171 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
29173 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
29174 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
29175 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
29178 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
29179 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
29180 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
29184 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
29187 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
29188 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
29191 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
29192 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
29194 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
29195 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
29198 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
29199 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
29200 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
29201 not be moved to the end of the list.
29204 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
29207 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
29208 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
29211 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29212 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
29213 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
29214 choice of clients used:
29216 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
29217 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29222 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
29224 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
29227 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
29228 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
29229 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
29230 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
29232 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
29234 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
29238 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
29240 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
29241 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
29242 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
29243 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
29244 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
29245 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
29246 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
29247 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
29248 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
29249 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
29251 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
29252 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
29254 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
29255 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
29256 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
29257 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
29258 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
29259 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
29261 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
29262 "Priority strings". This is online as
29263 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
29264 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
29265 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
29266 then the example code
29267 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
29268 on that site can be used to test a given string.
29272 # Disable older versions of protocols
29273 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
29276 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
29277 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
29278 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
29280 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29281 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
29282 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
29283 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
29287 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29293 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
29294 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
29295 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29296 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
29297 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
29298 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
29299 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
29300 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
29302 If STARTTLS is to be used you
29303 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
29305 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
29306 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
29307 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
29310 554 Security failure
29312 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
29313 rejected with a 554 error code.
29315 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
29316 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
29318 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
29319 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
29320 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
29321 from someone able to intercept the communication.
29323 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
29325 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
29327 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
29328 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
29330 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
29331 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
29332 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
29333 that goes with it. These files need to be
29334 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
29335 always be given as full path names.
29336 The key must not be password-protected.
29337 They can be the same file if both the
29338 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
29339 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
29340 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
29341 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
29342 the server's certificate.
29344 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
29345 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
29346 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
29347 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
29348 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
29349 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
29351 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
29352 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
29353 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
29355 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
29356 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
29357 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
29360 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
29361 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
29362 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
29364 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
29366 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
29367 with the parameters contained in the file.
29368 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
29373 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
29374 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
29375 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
29376 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
29382 for a way of generating file data.
29384 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
29385 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
29386 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
29387 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
29388 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
29390 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29391 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29392 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
29393 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
29394 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
29395 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
29396 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
29397 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
29398 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
29400 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
29401 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
29402 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
29403 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
29404 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
29405 documentation for more details.
29407 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
29408 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
29411 .subsection "Requesting and verifying client certificates"
29412 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29413 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29414 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
29415 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
29416 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
29417 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
29418 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
29419 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
29420 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
29421 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
29422 an explicit file or,
29423 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
29424 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
29426 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
29429 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
29430 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
29431 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
29433 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
29435 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
29437 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
29438 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
29440 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
29441 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
29442 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
29443 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
29444 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
29445 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
29446 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
29447 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
29448 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
29449 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
29451 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29452 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
29453 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
29454 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
29456 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29457 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
29458 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
29459 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
29460 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
29461 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
29464 .subsection "Caching of static server configuration items" "SSECTserverTLScache"
29465 .cindex certificate caching
29466 .cindex privatekey caching
29467 .cindex crl caching
29468 .cindex ocsp caching
29469 .cindex ciphers caching
29470 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
29471 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
29472 .cindex tls_certificate caching
29473 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
29474 .cindex tls_crl caching
29475 .cindex tls_ocsp_file caching
29476 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
29477 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
29478 .cindex caching certificate
29479 .cindex caching privatekey
29480 .cindex caching crl
29481 .cindex caching ocsp
29482 .cindex caching ciphers
29483 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
29484 If any of the main configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&,
29485 &%tls_crl%& and &%tls_ocsp_file%& have values with no
29486 expandable elements,
29487 then the associated information is loaded at daemon startup.
29488 It is made available
29489 to child processes forked for handling received SMTP connections.
29491 This caching is currently only supported under Linux and FreeBSD.
29493 If caching is not possible, for example if an item has to be dependent
29494 on the peer host so contains a &$sender_host_name$& expansion, the load
29495 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
29497 The cache is invalidated and reloaded after any changes to the directories
29498 containing files specified by these options.
29500 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29501 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
29502 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
29503 The latter case is not automatically invalidated;
29504 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
29505 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
29506 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
29507 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
29509 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
29510 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executavble.
29512 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
29513 save siginificant time and processing on every TLS connection
29519 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
29520 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29521 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29522 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29523 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
29524 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
29525 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
29526 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
29527 within the &(smtp)& transport.
29529 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29530 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
29531 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
29532 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
29533 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
29534 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
29536 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
29537 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
29538 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
29539 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
29540 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
29543 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
29544 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
29545 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
29546 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
29547 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
29548 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
29549 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
29550 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
29551 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
29552 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
29555 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
29556 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
29558 This is an optional thing for TLS connections, although either end
29560 If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
29561 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
29563 &*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
29564 for client use (they are usable for server use).
29565 As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
29566 in failed connections.
29568 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
29569 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
29571 the system default set (depending on library version),
29573 or (depending on library version) a directory.
29574 The client verifies the server's certificate
29575 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
29576 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
29577 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
29578 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
29580 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
29581 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
29582 or need not succeed respectively.
29584 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
29585 name checks are made on the server certificate.
29586 The match against this list is, as per other Exim usage, the
29587 IP for the host. That is most closely associated with the
29588 name on the DNS A (or AAAA) record for the host.
29589 However, the name that needs to be in the certificate
29590 is the one at the head of any CNAME chain leading to the A record.
29591 The option defaults to always checking.
29593 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
29594 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
29595 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
29597 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
29598 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
29599 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
29602 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
29603 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
29604 for OCSP to be relevant.
29607 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
29608 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
29609 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
29610 alternative hosts, if any.
29613 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
29614 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
29615 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
29619 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
29620 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
29621 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
29622 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
29623 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
29625 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
29626 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
29627 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
29628 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
29629 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
29630 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
29631 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
29632 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
29633 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
29634 outgoing connection.
29638 .subsection "Caching of static client configuration items" SECTclientTLScache
29639 .cindex certificate caching
29640 .cindex privatekey caching
29641 .cindex crl caching
29642 .cindex ciphers caching
29643 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
29644 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
29645 .cindex tls_certificate caching
29646 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
29647 .cindex tls_crl caching
29648 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
29649 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
29650 .cindex caching certificate
29651 .cindex caching privatekey
29652 .cindex caching crl
29653 .cindex caching ciphers
29654 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
29655 If any of the transport configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&
29656 and &%tls_crl%& have values with no
29657 expandable elements,
29658 then the associated information is loaded per smtp transport
29659 at daemon startup, at the start of a queue run, or on a
29660 command-line specified message delivery.
29661 It is made available
29662 to child processes forked for handling making SMTP connections.
29664 This caching is currently only supported under Linux.
29666 If caching is not possible, the load
29667 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
29669 The cache is invalidated in the daemon
29670 and reloaded after any changes to the directories
29671 containing files specified by these options.
29673 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29674 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
29675 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
29676 The latter case is not automatically invaludated;
29677 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
29678 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
29679 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
29680 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
29682 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
29683 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executavble.
29685 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
29686 save siginificant time and processing on every TLS connection
29692 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
29693 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
29696 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
29697 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
29698 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
29699 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
29700 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
29701 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
29702 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
29703 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
29706 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
29707 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
29710 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
29711 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
29712 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
29713 be of limited use in that environment.
29715 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
29716 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
29717 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
29718 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
29719 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
29721 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
29722 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
29723 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
29724 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
29725 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
29727 If DANE validated the connection attempt then the value of the &%tls_sni%& option
29728 is forced to the name of the destination host, after any MX- or CNAME-following.
29730 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
29731 received from a client.
29732 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
29734 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
29735 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
29736 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
29739 &%tls_certificate%&
29745 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29750 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
29751 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
29752 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
29753 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
29754 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
29755 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
29756 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
29758 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
29761 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
29762 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
29763 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
29764 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
29766 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
29767 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
29768 built, then you have SNI support).
29772 .cindex ALPN "general information"
29773 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
29774 There is a TLS feature related to SNI
29775 called Application Layer Protocol Name (ALPN).
29776 This is intended to declare, or select, what protocol layer will be using a TLS
29778 The client for the connection proposes a set of protocol names, and
29779 the server responds with a selected one.
29780 It is not, as of 2021, commonly used for SMTP connections.
29781 However, to guard against misdirected or malicious use of web clients
29782 (which often do use ALPN) against MTA ports, Exim by default check that
29783 there is no incompatible ALPN specified by a client for a TLS connection.
29784 If there is, the connection is rejected.
29786 As a client Exim does not supply ALPN by default.
29787 The behaviour of both client and server can be configured using the options
29788 &%tls_alpn%& and &%hosts_require_alpn%&.
29789 There are no variables providing observability.
29790 Some feature-specific logging may appear on denied connections, but this
29791 depends on the behavious of the peer
29792 (not all peers can send a feature-specific TLS Alert).
29794 This feature is available when Exim is built with
29795 OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later or GnuTLS 3.2.0 or later;
29796 the macro _HAVE_TLS_ALPN will be defined when this is so.
29800 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
29802 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
29803 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
29804 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
29805 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
29806 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
29807 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
29808 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
29809 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
29810 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
29811 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
29813 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
29814 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
29815 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
29816 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
29817 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
29818 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
29819 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
29821 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
29822 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
29823 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
29824 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
29825 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
29826 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
29827 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
29828 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
29829 and delay other deliveries to that host.
29831 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
29832 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
29833 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
29834 information is recorded.
29836 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
29837 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
29838 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
29843 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
29844 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
29845 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
29846 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
29847 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
29848 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
29850 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
29851 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
29852 document is currently at
29854 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
29856 and their FAQ is at
29858 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
29861 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
29862 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
29864 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
29865 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
29866 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
29867 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
29870 .subsection "Certificate chains" SECID186
29871 A file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
29872 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
29873 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
29874 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
29875 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
29876 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
29877 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
29878 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
29879 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
29880 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
29881 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
29882 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
29884 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
29885 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
29886 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
29887 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
29891 .subsection "Self-signed certificates" SECID187
29892 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
29893 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
29894 with OpenSSL, like this:
29895 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
29896 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
29898 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
29901 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
29902 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
29903 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
29904 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
29905 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
29906 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
29907 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
29909 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
29910 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
29911 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
29912 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
29913 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
29914 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
29916 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
29917 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
29918 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
29919 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
29920 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
29921 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
29922 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
29923 be a sensible resolution).
29925 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
29926 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
29927 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
29929 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
29930 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
29931 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
29932 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
29933 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
29934 signed with that self-signed certificate.
29936 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
29937 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
29938 Open-source PKI book, available online at
29939 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
29942 .subsection "Revoked certificates"
29943 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
29944 .cindex "revocation list"
29945 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
29946 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
29947 There are three ways for a certificate to be made unusable
29951 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
29952 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
29953 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
29954 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
29955 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
29957 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
29958 file from every certificate authority they know of.
29961 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
29962 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
29963 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
29964 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
29965 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
29966 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
29968 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
29969 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
29970 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
29971 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
29974 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
29975 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
29976 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
29977 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
29978 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
29979 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
29980 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
29981 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
29983 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
29984 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
29985 support for OCSP stapling is included.
29987 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
29988 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
29989 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
29990 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
29991 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
29993 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
29994 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
29995 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
29996 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
29997 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
30000 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
30001 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
30004 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
30005 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
30006 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
30007 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
30008 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
30009 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30011 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
30012 not any of the chain from CA to it.
30014 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
30017 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
30018 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
30019 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
30021 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
30022 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
30023 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
30028 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
30029 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
30032 .section "TLS Resumption" "SECTresumption"
30033 .cindex TLS resumption
30034 TLS Session Resumption for TLS 1.2 and TLS 1.3 connections can be used (defined
30035 in RFC 5077 for 1.2). The support for this requires GnuTLS 3.6.3 or OpenSSL 1.1.1
30038 Session resumption (this is the "stateless" variant) involves the server sending
30039 a "session ticket" to the client on one connection, which can be stored by the
30040 client and used for a later session. The ticket contains sufficient state for
30041 the server to reconstruct the TLS session, avoiding some expensive crypto
30042 calculation and (on TLS1.2) one full packet roundtrip time.
30045 Operational cost/benefit:
30047 The extra data being transmitted costs a minor amount, and the client has
30048 extra costs in storing and retrieving the data.
30050 In the Exim/Gnutls implementation the extra cost on an initial connection
30051 which is TLS1.2 over a loopback path is about 6ms on 2017-laptop class hardware.
30052 The saved cost on a subsequent connection is about 4ms; three or more
30053 connections become a net win. On longer network paths, two or more
30054 connections will have an average lower startup time thanks to the one
30055 saved packet roundtrip. TLS1.3 will save the crypto cpu costs but not any
30058 .cindex "hints database" tls
30059 Since a new hints DB is used on the TLS client,
30060 the hints DB maintenance should be updated to additionally handle "tls".
30065 The session ticket is encrypted, but is obviously an additional security
30066 vulnarability surface. An attacker able to decrypt it would have access
30067 all connections using the resumed session.
30068 The session ticket encryption key is not committed to storage by the server
30069 and is rotated regularly (OpenSSL: 1hr, and one previous key is used for
30070 overlap; GnuTLS 6hr but does not specify any overlap).
30071 Tickets have limited lifetime (2hr, and new ones issued after 1hr under
30072 OpenSSL. GnuTLS 2hr, appears to not do overlap).
30074 There is a question-mark over the security of the Diffie-Helman parameters
30075 used for session negotiation.
30080 The &%log_selector%& "tls_resumption" appends an asterisk to the tls_cipher "X="
30083 The variables &$tls_in_resumption$& and &$tls_out_resumption$&
30084 have bits 0-4 indicating respectively
30085 support built, client requested ticket, client offered session,
30086 server issued ticket, resume used. A suitable decode list is provided
30087 in the builtin macro _RESUME_DECODE for in &%listextract%& expansions.
30092 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& main option specifies a hostlist for which
30093 exim, operating as a server, will offer resumption to clients.
30094 Current best practice is to not offer the feature to MUA connection.
30095 Commonly this can be done like this:
30097 tls_resumption_hosts = ${if inlist {$received_port}{587:465} {:}{*}}
30099 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30100 is offered and/or accepted.
30102 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& smtp transport option performs the
30103 equivalent function for operation as a client.
30104 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30105 is attempted (if a stored session is available) or the information
30106 stored (if supplied by the peer).
30112 In a resumed session:
30114 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_cipher$& will have values different
30115 to the original (under GnuTLS).
30117 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_ocsp$& will be "not requested" or "no response",
30118 and the &%hosts_require_ocsp%& smtp trasnport option will fail.
30119 . XXX need to do something with that hosts_require_ocsp
30125 .section DANE "SECDANE"
30127 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
30128 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
30129 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
30130 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
30131 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
30132 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
30134 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
30135 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
30136 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
30138 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
30139 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
30141 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and communicate via side-channel) copies of server certificates
30142 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
30143 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
30145 DANE requires a server operator to do three things:
30147 Run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
30148 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
30149 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
30152 Add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
30154 Offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
30157 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
30158 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
30159 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
30160 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
30162 .subsection "DNS records"
30163 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
30164 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
30165 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
30166 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
30168 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
30169 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
30170 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
30171 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
30172 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
30173 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
30175 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
30176 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
30177 does require careful arrangement.
30178 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
30179 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
30180 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
30181 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
30182 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
30184 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
30185 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
30187 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
30188 "MTA-STS", described below.
30190 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
30191 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
30192 connections to you.
30193 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
30194 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
30195 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
30196 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
30197 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
30198 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
30200 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
30201 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
30202 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
30203 random serial numbers.
30204 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
30205 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
30206 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
30207 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
30209 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
30210 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
30212 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
30215 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
30216 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
30221 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
30223 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
30226 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
30229 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
30230 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
30233 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
30235 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
30236 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
30237 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
30238 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
30240 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
30241 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
30243 .subsection "Interaction with OCSP"
30244 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
30245 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
30246 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
30249 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
30250 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
30254 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
30255 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
30256 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
30257 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
30258 control the OCSP request.
30260 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
30261 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
30264 .subsection "Client configuration"
30265 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
30266 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
30267 The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
30268 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
30269 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
30271 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
30273 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using DNSSEC.
30274 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
30275 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
30276 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
30278 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
30279 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
30280 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
30281 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
30282 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
30283 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
30284 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
30286 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
30290 tls_try_verify_hosts
30291 tls_verify_certificates
30293 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
30297 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
30298 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
30300 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
30301 set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
30303 .subsection Observability
30304 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
30306 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
30307 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
30308 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
30309 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
30311 .cindex DANE reporting
30312 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
30313 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
30314 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
30315 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
30316 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
30317 Section 4.3 of that document.
30319 .subsection General
30320 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
30322 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
30323 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
30325 There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
30326 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
30327 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
30328 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
30329 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
30330 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
30333 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
30334 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
30335 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
30337 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
30338 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
30339 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
30340 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
30341 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
30342 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
30343 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
30347 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30348 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30350 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
30351 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
30352 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
30353 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
30354 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
30355 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
30356 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
30357 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
30358 one very small ACL:
30362 accept hosts = one.host.only
30364 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
30365 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
30367 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
30368 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
30369 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
30370 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
30371 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
30372 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
30373 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
30374 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30377 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
30378 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
30379 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30382 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
30383 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
30384 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
30385 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
30386 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
30387 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30388 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
30389 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
30390 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30391 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30392 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
30393 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
30394 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
30395 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
30396 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
30397 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
30398 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30399 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30400 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
30401 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30404 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
30405 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
30406 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
30407 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
30408 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
30409 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
30410 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
30411 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
30412 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
30413 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
30414 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
30415 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
30416 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
30417 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
30418 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
30419 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
30420 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
30421 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
30422 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
30423 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
30426 For example, if you set
30428 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
30430 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
30431 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
30432 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
30433 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
30434 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
30435 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
30436 testing as possible at RCPT time.
30439 .subsection "The non-SMTP ACLs" SECID190
30440 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30441 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
30442 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
30443 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
30444 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
30445 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
30446 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
30447 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
30448 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
30449 in any of these ACLs.
30451 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
30452 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
30453 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
30454 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
30455 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
30456 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
30457 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
30458 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
30460 control = suppress_local_fixups
30462 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
30463 run, it is too late.
30465 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30466 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30468 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
30469 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
30470 temporary error for these kinds of message.
30473 .subsection "The SMTP connect ACL" SECID191
30474 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30475 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
30476 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
30477 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
30478 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
30479 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
30480 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
30481 &%smtp_banner%& option.
30483 For tls-on-connect connections, the ACL is run after the TLS connection
30484 is accepted (however, &%host_reject_connection%& is tested before).
30487 .subsection "The EHLO/HELO ACL" SECID192
30488 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30489 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30490 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
30491 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
30492 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
30493 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
30494 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
30495 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
30497 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
30498 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
30499 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
30501 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
30502 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
30503 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
30504 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
30508 .subsection "The DATA ACLs" SECID193
30509 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30510 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
30511 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
30512 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
30513 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
30514 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
30515 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
30516 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
30517 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
30519 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
30520 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
30521 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
30522 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
30523 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
30524 associated with the DATA command.
30526 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
30527 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
30528 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
30529 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
30530 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
30531 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
30532 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
30533 the data specified is received.
30535 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
30536 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
30537 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
30538 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
30539 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
30542 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
30543 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
30544 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
30545 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
30547 .subsection "The SMTP DKIM ACL" SECTDKIMACL
30548 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
30549 enabled (which is the default).
30551 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
30552 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
30553 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
30555 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30557 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30560 .subsection "The SMTP MIME ACL" SECID194
30561 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30562 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30564 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30567 .subsection "The SMTP PRDR ACL" SECTPRDRACL
30568 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30569 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
30570 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
30571 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
30572 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
30573 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
30576 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
30577 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
30578 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
30579 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
30580 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
30581 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
30582 for some or all recipients.
30584 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
30585 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
30586 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
30587 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
30588 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
30590 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
30591 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
30592 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
30594 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
30595 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
30597 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30598 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
30599 the feature was not requested by the client.
30601 .subsection "The QUIT ACL" SECTQUITACL
30602 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
30603 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
30604 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
30605 does not in fact control any access.
30606 For this reason, it may only accept
30607 or warn as its final result.
30609 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
30610 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
30611 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
30612 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
30614 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
30615 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
30617 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
30618 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
30621 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
30622 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
30623 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
30624 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
30625 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
30628 .subsection "The not-QUIT ACL" SECTNOTQUITACL
30629 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
30630 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
30631 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
30632 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
30633 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
30634 situation even worse.
30636 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
30637 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
30638 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
30641 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
30642 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
30643 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
30644 connection. The possible values are:
30646 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
30647 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
30648 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
30649 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
30650 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
30651 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
30652 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
30653 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
30654 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
30655 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
30657 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
30658 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
30659 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
30660 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
30661 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
30665 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
30666 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
30667 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
30668 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
30670 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
30671 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
30673 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
30674 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
30675 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
30676 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
30677 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
30679 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
30680 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
30681 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
30684 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
30685 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
30686 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
30687 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
30688 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
30689 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
30691 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
30692 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
30693 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
30695 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
30696 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
30697 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
30698 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
30700 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
30701 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
30702 matches the string.
30704 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
30705 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
30706 want to have something like
30708 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
30710 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
30711 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
30717 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
30718 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
30719 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
30720 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
30721 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
30722 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
30723 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
30724 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
30725 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
30727 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
30728 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
30729 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
30732 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
30733 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
30734 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
30735 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
30737 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
30738 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
30739 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
30740 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
30741 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
30742 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
30743 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
30745 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
30746 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
30749 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
30750 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
30751 recipients; it may create new recipients.
30755 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
30756 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
30757 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
30758 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
30759 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
30760 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
30762 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
30763 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
30764 used to accept or reject anything.
30766 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
30767 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
30768 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
30769 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
30771 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
30772 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
30773 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
30774 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
30775 configuration file.
30780 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
30781 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
30783 .vindex &$local_part$&
30784 .vindex &$sender_address$&
30785 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
30786 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
30787 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
30788 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
30789 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
30790 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
30791 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
30792 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
30794 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
30795 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
30796 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
30799 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
30800 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
30801 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
30802 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
30803 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
30806 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
30807 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
30808 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
30809 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
30810 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
30811 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
30812 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
30813 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
30819 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
30820 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
30821 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
30822 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
30823 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
30824 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
30825 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
30826 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
30827 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
30828 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
30829 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
30830 unencrypted connections.
30833 accept encrypted = *
30834 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
30836 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
30838 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
30839 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
30840 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
30841 option to do this.)
30845 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
30846 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
30847 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
30848 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
30849 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
30850 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
30851 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
30853 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
30854 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
30855 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
30858 deny dnslists = list1.example
30859 dnslists = list2.example
30861 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
30862 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
30863 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
30864 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
30865 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
30868 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
30869 The ACL verbs are as follows:
30872 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
30873 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
30874 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
30875 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
30876 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
30877 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
30878 check a RCPT command:
30880 accept domains = +local_domains
30884 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
30885 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
30886 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
30887 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
30890 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
30891 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
30892 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
30895 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
30896 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
30897 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
30898 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
30899 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
30900 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
30902 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
30903 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
30905 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
30906 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
30907 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
30909 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
30910 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
30911 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
30916 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
30917 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
30918 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
30919 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
30920 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
30921 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
30922 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
30926 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
30927 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
30928 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
30931 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30933 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
30937 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
30938 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
30939 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
30940 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
30941 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
30942 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
30943 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
30944 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
30945 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
30947 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
30948 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
30949 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
30953 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
30954 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
30955 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
30957 drop condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
30958 message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
30960 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
30961 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
30964 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
30965 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
30966 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
30967 example, when checking a RCPT command,
30969 require message = Sender did not verify
30972 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
30973 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
30974 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
30975 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
30978 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30979 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
30980 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
30981 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
30982 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
30983 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
30984 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
30986 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
30987 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
30988 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
30989 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
30990 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
30992 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
30993 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
30994 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
30995 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
30996 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
30997 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
31001 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31002 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
31003 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
31004 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
31006 warn !verify = sender
31007 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
31011 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
31013 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
31014 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
31015 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
31016 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
31017 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
31021 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
31022 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
31023 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
31024 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
31025 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
31026 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
31027 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
31028 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
31029 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
31030 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
31032 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
31033 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
31034 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
31035 on the same SMTP connection.
31037 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
31038 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
31039 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
31042 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
31043 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
31044 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
31046 accept hosts = whatever
31047 set acl_m4 = some value
31048 accept authenticated = *
31049 set acl_c_auth = yes
31051 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
31052 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
31053 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
31055 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
31056 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
31057 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
31058 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
31059 error is generated.
31061 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
31062 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
31065 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
31066 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
31067 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
31068 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
31070 deny domains = *.dom.example
31071 !verify = recipient
31073 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
31074 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
31075 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
31076 two statements are equivalent:
31078 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
31079 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
31081 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
31082 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
31084 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
31085 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
31086 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
31088 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31089 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
31090 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31091 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
31093 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
31094 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
31095 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
31096 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
31097 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
31098 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
31099 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
31101 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
31102 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
31103 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
31104 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
31105 message is handled.
31107 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
31108 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
31109 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
31110 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
31112 require message = Can't verify sender
31114 message = Can't verify recipient
31116 message = This message cannot be used
31118 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
31119 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
31120 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
31121 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
31122 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
31123 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
31125 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
31126 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
31127 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
31128 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
31131 !senders = *@my.domain.example
31132 message = Invalid sender from client host
31134 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
31135 by which time Exim has set up the message.
31139 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
31140 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
31141 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
31144 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31145 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
31146 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
31147 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31149 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31150 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
31151 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
31152 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
31153 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
31154 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
31155 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
31156 write rather ugly lines like this:
31158 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
31160 Instead, all you need is
31162 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
31165 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31166 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31167 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
31168 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
31169 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
31170 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
31171 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
31172 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
31174 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
31175 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
31176 in several different ways. For example:
31178 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
31179 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
31180 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
31184 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
31186 accept ...some conditions
31189 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
31190 other words, when the conditions are all true.
31193 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
31195 accept ...some conditions...
31197 ...some more conditions...
31199 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
31200 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
31201 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
31205 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
31206 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
31209 warn ...some conditions...
31213 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
31214 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
31218 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
31219 &%require%& verb. For example:
31221 require control = no_multiline_responses
31225 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
31226 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
31228 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
31229 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
31230 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
31231 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
31232 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
31233 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
31235 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
31238 deny ...some conditions...
31241 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
31242 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
31245 ...some conditions...
31247 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
31248 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
31250 warn ...some conditions...
31256 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
31257 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
31258 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
31259 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
31260 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
31261 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
31262 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
31266 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
31267 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
31268 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
31269 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
31270 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
31271 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
31272 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
31275 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31276 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
31277 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
31278 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
31280 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
31281 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
31283 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
31286 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
31287 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
31289 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
31290 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
31291 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
31294 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
31295 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
31296 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
31297 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
31298 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
31299 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
31302 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31303 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
31304 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
31307 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
31308 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
31309 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
31310 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
31311 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
31312 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
31314 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
31315 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
31316 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
31317 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
31318 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
31319 logging rejections.
31322 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
31323 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
31324 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
31325 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
31326 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
31327 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
31328 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
31329 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
31331 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
31332 &` log_reject_target =`&
31334 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
31335 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
31339 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31340 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
31341 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
31342 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
31343 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
31344 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
31345 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
31348 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
31349 &` control = freeze`&
31350 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
31352 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
31353 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
31354 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
31357 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
31358 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
31362 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31363 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
31364 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
31365 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
31366 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
31367 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
31368 &%accept%& for details.)
31370 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
31371 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
31372 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
31373 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
31374 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
31376 require message = Host not recognized
31379 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
31382 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
31383 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
31384 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
31385 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
31386 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
31387 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
31388 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
31389 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
31390 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
31393 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
31394 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
31395 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
31397 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
31398 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
31400 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
31401 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
31402 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
31405 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
31406 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
31408 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
31409 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
31410 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
31413 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31414 While the text is being expanded, the &$acl_verify_message$& variable
31415 contains any message previously set.
31416 Afterwards, &$acl_verify_message$& is cleared.
31418 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
31419 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
31420 However, the original message is available in the variable
31421 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
31422 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
31423 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
31424 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
31426 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
31427 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
31428 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
31429 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
31430 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
31431 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
31435 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31436 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
31437 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
31438 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
31440 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
31442 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
31443 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
31444 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
31445 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
31448 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31449 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
31450 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
31451 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
31454 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
31455 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
31456 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
31457 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
31460 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
31461 .cindex "UDP communications"
31462 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
31463 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
31464 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
31465 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
31466 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
31467 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
31468 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
31471 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
31472 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
31479 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
31480 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31481 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
31484 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
31485 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
31486 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
31487 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
31488 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
31489 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
31490 not work without it. For example:
31492 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
31493 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
31495 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
31496 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
31497 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
31498 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
31499 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
31502 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
31503 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
31504 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
31505 .cindex "case of local parts"
31506 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31507 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
31508 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
31509 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
31510 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
31511 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
31514 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
31515 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
31516 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
31517 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
31518 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
31520 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
31521 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
31524 warn control = caseful_local_part
31525 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
31527 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
31529 control = caselower_local_part
31531 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
31532 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
31535 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
31536 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
31537 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
31538 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
31540 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
31541 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
31542 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
31543 is used for all recipients of the message,
31544 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
31545 and data is copied from one to the other.
31547 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
31548 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
31549 If a recipient-verify callout
31551 connection is subsequently
31552 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
31553 any subsequent recipients and the data,
31554 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
31556 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
31557 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
31558 Note also that headers cannot be
31559 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
31560 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
31561 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
31562 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
31563 this will affect the timestamp.
31565 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
31566 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
31567 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
31568 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
31571 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
31572 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
31573 before the entire message has been received from the source.
31574 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
31578 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
31579 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
31580 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
31581 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
31582 before the acceptance "<=" line.
31584 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
31586 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
31587 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
31588 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
31589 and does not queue the message.
31590 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
31592 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
31594 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
31597 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
31598 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
31599 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
31600 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
31601 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
31602 by default called &'debuglog'&.
31604 Logging set up by the control will be maintained across spool residency.
31606 Options are a slash-separated list.
31607 If an option takes an argument, the option name and argument are separated by
31608 an equals character.
31609 Several options are supported:
31611 tag=<&'suffix'&> The filename can be adjusted with thise option.
31612 The argument, which may access any variables already defined,
31613 is appended to the default name.
31615 opts=<&'debug&~options'&> The argument specififes what is to be logged,
31616 using the same values as the &`-d`& command-line option.
31618 stop Logging started with this control may be
31619 stopped by using this option.
31621 kill Logging started with this control may be
31622 stopped by using this option.
31623 Additionally the debug file will be removed,
31624 providing one means for speculative debug tracing.
31626 pretrigger=<&'size'&> This option specifies a memory buffuer to be used
31627 for pre-trigger debug capture.
31628 Debug lines are recorded in the buffer until
31629 and if) a trigger occurs; at which time they are
31630 dumped to the debug file. Newer lines displace the
31631 oldest if the buffer is full. After a trigger,
31632 immediate writes to file are done as normal.
31634 trigger=<&'reason'&> This option selects cause for the pretrigger buffer
31635 see above) to be copied to file. A reason of $*now*
31636 take effect immediately; one of &*paniclog*& triggers
31637 on a write to the panic log.
31640 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
31644 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
31645 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
31646 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
31647 control = debug/kill
31648 control = debug/opts=+all/pretrigger=1024/trigger=paniclog
31649 control = debug/trigger=now
31653 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
31654 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
31655 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
31656 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
31657 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
31660 .vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
31661 .cindex "disable DMARC verify"
31662 .cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
31663 This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
31664 the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
31667 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
31668 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
31669 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
31670 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
31671 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
31672 strings or to numeric value.
31673 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
31674 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
31675 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
31677 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
31678 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
31679 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
31680 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
31681 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
31684 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
31685 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
31686 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
31687 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
31688 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
31689 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
31690 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
31691 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
31693 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
31694 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
31695 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
31696 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
31697 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
31698 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
31702 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
31703 .cindex "fake defer"
31704 .cindex "defer, fake"
31705 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
31706 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
31707 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
31708 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
31709 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
31711 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
31712 .cindex "fake rejection"
31713 .cindex "rejection, fake"
31714 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
31715 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
31716 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
31717 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
31718 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
31719 the same SMTP connection.
31721 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
31722 message is supplied, the following is used:
31724 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
31725 550-kept for evaluation.
31726 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
31727 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
31729 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
31731 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
31732 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
31733 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
31734 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
31735 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
31736 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
31739 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
31740 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
31741 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
31742 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
31744 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
31745 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
31746 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
31747 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
31748 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
31749 disables such output flushing.
31751 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
31752 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31753 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
31754 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
31755 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
31756 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
31758 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
31759 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
31760 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
31761 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
31762 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
31763 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
31764 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
31765 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
31766 to be useful in production.
31768 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
31769 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
31770 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
31771 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
31772 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
31774 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
31775 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
31776 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
31777 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
31778 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
31779 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
31782 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
31783 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
31784 verification failed"&) is sent.
31786 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
31790 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
31791 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
31793 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
31794 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
31795 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
31796 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
31797 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
31798 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
31799 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
31800 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
31802 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
31803 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
31804 .oindex "&%queue%&"
31805 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
31806 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
31807 .cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
31808 .cindex "first pass routing"
31809 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
31810 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
31811 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
31813 If used with no options set,
31814 no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
31815 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
31817 If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
31818 the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
31819 a delivery process is started which stops short of making
31820 any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
31821 the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
31822 able to send all such messages on a single connection.
31824 The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
31825 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
31827 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
31828 .cindex "message" "submission"
31829 .cindex "submission mode"
31830 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
31831 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
31832 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
31833 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
31834 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
31835 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
31836 late (the message has already been created).
31838 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
31839 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
31840 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
31841 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
31842 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
31844 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
31845 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
31846 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
31847 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
31848 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
31851 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
31852 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
31854 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
31856 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
31859 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
31860 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
31861 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31862 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
31865 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
31866 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
31868 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
31869 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
31871 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
31875 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
31876 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
31879 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
31881 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
31882 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
31884 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
31886 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
31891 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
31892 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
31893 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
31894 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
31895 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
31896 to an incoming message, as in this example:
31898 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31899 dialup.mail-abuse.org
31900 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
31902 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
31903 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
31904 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
31905 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
31906 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
31909 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
31910 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
31912 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
31913 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
31914 contains one or more newlines that
31915 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
31916 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
31917 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
31919 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
31920 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
31921 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
31922 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
31923 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
31924 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
31925 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
31926 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
31927 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
31928 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
31929 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
31931 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
31932 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
31934 until they are added to the
31935 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
31936 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
31937 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
31938 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
31939 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
31940 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
31941 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
31943 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
31945 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
31946 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
31948 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
31949 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
31951 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
31952 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
31954 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
31955 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
31956 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
31957 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
31960 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
31961 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
31962 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
31963 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
31964 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
31965 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
31966 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
31969 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
31970 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
31971 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
31972 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
31973 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
31975 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
31976 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
31977 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
31978 to be a header name first.) For example:
31980 warn add_header = \
31981 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
31983 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
31984 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
31985 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
31986 up in reverse order.
31988 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
31989 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
31990 system filter or in a router or transport.
31994 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
31995 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
31996 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
31997 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
31998 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
31999 from an incoming message, as in this example:
32001 warn message = Remove internal headers
32002 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32004 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32005 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32006 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32007 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
32008 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
32009 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
32011 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
32012 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32014 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
32015 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
32016 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
32017 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
32018 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
32020 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
32021 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32022 warn message = Remove internal headers
32023 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
32025 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32026 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32027 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
32028 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
32029 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
32030 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
32031 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
32032 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
32033 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
32034 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
32035 would have been removed.
32037 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
32038 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
32039 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
32040 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
32041 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
32042 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
32043 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
32044 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
32045 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32047 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32048 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32050 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
32051 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32053 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32054 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
32056 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
32057 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
32058 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
32059 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
32062 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32063 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
32064 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
32069 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
32070 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
32071 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
32072 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
32073 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
32074 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32076 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
32077 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
32078 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
32079 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
32080 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
32081 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
32082 The conditions are as follows:
32086 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
32087 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
32088 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
32089 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
32090 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
32091 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
32092 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
32093 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
32094 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
32095 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
32096 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
32097 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
32099 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
32100 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
32101 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
32102 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
32103 The name and values are expanded separately.
32104 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
32105 will act as argument separators.
32107 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
32108 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
32109 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
32110 conditions are tested.
32112 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
32113 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
32114 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
32115 for different local users or different local domains.
32117 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32118 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
32119 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
32120 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
32121 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
32122 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
32123 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
32128 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
32129 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
32130 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
32131 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
32132 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
32133 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
32134 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
32135 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
32136 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
32137 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
32138 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
32139 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
32142 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
32143 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
32144 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32145 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32146 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
32147 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
32148 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
32149 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32151 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
32152 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
32153 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32154 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32155 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32156 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
32157 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
32158 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
32159 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
32160 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
32162 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32163 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
32164 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
32165 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
32166 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
32167 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the domain
32168 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
32169 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
32170 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
32173 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
32174 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
32177 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32178 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
32179 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
32180 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
32181 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
32182 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
32183 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
32189 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
32190 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
32191 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
32192 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
32193 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
32194 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
32195 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
32197 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32199 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
32200 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
32201 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
32203 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
32204 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
32205 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
32206 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
32207 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
32208 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
32210 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
32211 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
32213 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32214 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
32216 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
32217 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
32218 statement can then check the IP address.
32220 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
32221 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
32222 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
32223 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
32225 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
32226 message = $host_data
32228 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
32230 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
32231 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
32232 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
32233 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
32234 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
32235 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the local
32236 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
32237 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
32238 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
32239 the next &%local_parts%& test.
32241 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
32242 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
32243 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
32244 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
32245 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32246 content-scanning extension
32247 and only after a DATA command.
32248 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
32249 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32251 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32252 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
32253 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32254 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32255 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32256 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
32257 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
32260 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32261 .cindex "rate limiting"
32262 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
32263 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
32265 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32266 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
32267 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
32268 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
32269 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks the entire
32270 recipient address against a list of recipients.
32272 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32273 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
32274 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32275 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32276 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
32277 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
32278 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32280 .vitem &*seen&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32281 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
32282 This condition can be used to test if a situation has been previously met,
32283 for example for greylisting.
32284 Details are given in section &<<SECTseen>>&.
32286 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32287 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
32288 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32289 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
32290 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32291 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
32292 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
32293 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
32294 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
32295 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
32296 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
32297 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
32298 influence the sender checking.
32300 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
32301 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
32303 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32304 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
32305 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32306 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
32307 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
32308 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
32312 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
32313 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
32315 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
32316 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
32317 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
32318 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32319 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
32320 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32322 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
32323 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32324 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
32325 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
32326 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
32327 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
32328 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
32329 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
32330 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
32331 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
32333 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
32334 .cindex "CSA verification"
32335 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
32336 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
32337 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
32339 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
32340 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32341 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
32342 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
32343 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
32344 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32346 This usually means an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
32347 It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
32348 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
32349 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
32351 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
32352 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
32353 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
32355 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
32356 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32357 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
32358 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
32359 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
32360 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
32361 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32362 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
32363 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
32364 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
32365 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
32366 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
32367 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
32368 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
32369 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
32371 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
32372 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
32373 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
32374 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
32377 !verify = header_sender
32378 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
32381 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
32382 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32383 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
32384 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
32385 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
32386 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32387 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
32388 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
32389 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
32390 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
32391 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
32392 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
32393 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
32396 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
32397 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
32401 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
32402 common as they used to be.
32404 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
32405 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32406 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
32407 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
32408 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
32409 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
32410 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
32411 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
32412 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
32413 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
32414 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
32415 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
32416 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
32418 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
32419 option), this condition is always true.
32422 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
32423 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
32424 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
32425 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
32426 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
32427 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
32428 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
32429 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
32430 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
32432 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
32433 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
32435 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
32436 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
32439 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
32440 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32441 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
32442 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
32443 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
32444 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
32445 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
32446 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
32447 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
32448 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
32449 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
32450 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
32451 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
32452 value for the child address.
32454 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
32455 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32456 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
32457 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
32458 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
32459 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
32460 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
32461 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
32462 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
32463 original IP address.
32465 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
32466 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
32468 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
32469 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
32471 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
32472 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32473 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
32474 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
32475 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
32476 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
32477 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
32478 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
32479 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
32481 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
32482 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
32483 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
32484 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
32485 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
32486 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
32487 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
32489 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
32490 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
32491 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
32493 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
32494 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32495 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
32496 verified as a sender.
32498 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
32499 (eg. is generated from the received message)
32500 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
32502 verify = sender=${listquote{/}{${address:$h_sender:}}}
32508 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
32509 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32510 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32511 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32512 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
32513 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
32514 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
32515 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
32516 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
32517 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
32519 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
32520 dialups.mail-abuse.org
32522 the following records are looked up:
32524 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32525 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
32527 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
32528 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
32529 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
32530 use two separate conditions:
32532 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32533 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
32535 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
32536 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
32537 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
32540 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
32541 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
32542 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
32543 following special items in the list:
32544 .itable none 0 0 2 25* left 75* left
32545 .irow "+include_unknown" "behave as if the item is on the list"
32546 .irow "+exclude_unknown" "behave as if the item is not on the list (default)"
32547 .irow "+defer_unknown " "give a temporary error"
32549 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
32550 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
32551 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
32552 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
32554 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
32556 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
32557 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
32559 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32560 warn dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
32561 message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
32563 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
32565 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
32566 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
32567 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
32568 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
32569 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
32570 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
32572 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
32573 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
32574 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
32578 .subsection "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" SECID201
32579 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
32580 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
32581 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
32582 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
32584 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
32586 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
32587 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
32588 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
32589 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
32594 .subsection "DNS lists keyed on domain names" SECID202
32595 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
32596 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
32597 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
32598 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
32599 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
32600 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
32602 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
32603 message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
32605 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
32606 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
32607 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
32608 up by this example is
32610 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
32612 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
32613 addresses. For example:
32615 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32616 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
32618 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
32619 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
32624 .subsection "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" SECTmulkeyfor
32625 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
32626 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
32627 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
32628 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
32629 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
32630 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
32631 either to double the separators like this:
32633 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
32635 or to change the separator character, like this:
32637 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
32639 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
32640 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
32641 occurs. Consider this condition:
32643 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
32645 The DNS lookups that occur are:
32647 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
32648 a.domain.black.list.tld
32650 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
32651 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
32652 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
32653 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
32654 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
32655 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
32656 error for a previous item.
32658 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
32659 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
32661 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
32662 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
32664 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
32665 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
32667 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
32668 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
32669 $sender_address_domain} }} }
32670 message = The mail servers for the domain \
32671 $sender_address_domain \
32672 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
32675 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
32676 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
32677 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
32678 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
32680 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
32682 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
32683 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
32685 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
32686 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
32691 .subsection "Data returned by DNS lists" SECID203
32692 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
32693 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
32694 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
32695 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
32696 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
32697 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
32698 .irow 127.1.0.1 "RBL"
32699 .irow 127.1.0.2 "DUL"
32700 .irow 127.1.0.3 "DUL and RBL"
32701 .irow 127.1.0.4 "RSS"
32702 .irow 127.1.0.5 "RSS and RBL"
32703 .irow 127.1.0.6 "RSS and DUL"
32704 .irow 127.1.0.7 "RSS and DUL and RBL"
32706 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
32707 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
32708 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
32710 Values returned by a properly running DBSBL should be in the 127.0.0.0/8
32711 range. If a DNSBL operator loses control of the domain, lookups on it
32712 may start returning other addresses. Because of this, Exim now ignores
32713 returned values outside the 127/8 region.
32716 .subsection "Variables set from DNS lists" SECID204
32717 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
32718 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
32719 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
32720 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
32721 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
32722 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
32723 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
32724 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
32725 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
32726 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
32727 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
32728 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
32729 cases, for example:
32731 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
32733 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
32734 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
32735 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
32736 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
32738 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
32740 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
32741 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
32743 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
32744 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
32745 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
32746 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
32747 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
32750 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
32751 &-- even if these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
32752 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
32754 deny hosts = !+local_networks
32755 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
32757 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
32762 .subsection "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" SECTaddmatcon
32763 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
32764 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
32765 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
32768 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
32770 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
32771 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
32772 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
32773 describes how multiple records are handled.
32775 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
32776 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
32777 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
32779 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32781 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
32782 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
32783 first. For example:
32785 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
32786 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
32789 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
32790 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
32791 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
32792 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
32793 tested. For example:
32795 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
32797 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
32798 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
32799 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
32801 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
32803 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
32808 .subsection "Negated DNS matching conditions" SECID205
32809 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
32812 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32814 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
32815 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
32817 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32819 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
32820 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
32821 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
32822 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
32824 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
32825 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
32827 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
32828 previous example is precisely equivalent to
32830 deny dnslists = a.b.c
32831 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32833 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
32834 Consider this example:
32836 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32838 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
32841 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
32843 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32845 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
32846 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
32847 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
32849 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
32851 Negation can also be used with a bitwise-and restriction.
32852 The dnslists condition with only be trus if a result is returned
32853 by the lookup which, anded with the restriction, is all zeroes.
32856 deny dnslists = zen.spamhaus.org!&0.255.255.0
32862 .subsection "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" SECThanmuldnsrec
32863 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
32864 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
32865 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
32866 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
32867 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
32869 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
32871 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
32872 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
32873 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
32874 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
32875 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
32876 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
32879 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
32880 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
32881 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
32883 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
32884 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
32887 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
32889 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32890 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
32892 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
32894 for the condition to be true.
32897 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
32898 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
32900 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
32901 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
32903 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
32905 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32906 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
32908 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
32909 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
32911 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
32913 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32914 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
32916 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
32918 for the condition to be false.
32920 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
32921 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
32926 .subsection "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" SECTmordetinf
32927 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
32928 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
32929 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
32930 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
32931 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
32932 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
32933 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
32934 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
32937 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
32938 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
32939 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
32940 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
32941 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
32942 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
32943 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
32946 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
32947 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
32949 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
32950 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
32952 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
32953 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
32954 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
32955 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
32956 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
32957 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
32959 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
32960 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
32961 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
32964 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
32965 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
32966 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
32967 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
32969 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
32970 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
32971 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
32975 .subsection "DNS lists and IPv6" SECTmorednslistslast
32976 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
32977 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
32978 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
32979 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
32980 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
32982 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
32983 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32985 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
32986 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
32987 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
32989 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
32991 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
32992 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
32994 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
32995 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
32997 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
32998 dnslists = some.list.example
33001 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
33002 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
33003 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
33005 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
33009 .section "Previously seen user and hosts" "SECTseen"
33010 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
33011 .cindex greylisting
33012 The &%seen%& ACL condition can be used to test whether a
33013 situation has been previously met.
33014 It uses a hints database to record a timestamp against a key.
33015 The syntax of the condition is:
33017 &`seen =`& <&'optional flag'&><&'time interval'&> &`/`& <&'options'&>
33022 defer seen = -5m / key=${sender_host_address}_$local_part@$domain
33024 in a RCPT ACL will implement simple greylisting.
33026 The parameters for the condition are
33027 a possible minus sign,
33029 then, slash-separated, a list of options.
33030 The interval is taken as an offset before the current time,
33031 and used for the test.
33032 If the interval is preceded by a minus sign then the condition returns
33033 whether a record is found which is before the test time.
33034 Otherwise, the condition returns whether one is found which is since the
33037 Options are read in order with later ones overriding earlier ones.
33039 The default key is &$sender_host_address$&.
33040 An explicit key can be set using a &%key=value%& option.
33042 If a &%readonly%& option is given then
33043 no record create or update is done.
33044 If a &%write%& option is given then
33045 a record create or update is always done.
33046 An update is done if the test is for &"since"&.
33047 If none of those hold and there was no existing record,
33048 a record is created.
33050 Creates and updates are marked with the current time.
33052 Finally, a &"before"& test which succeeds, and for which the record
33053 is old enough, will be refreshed with a timestamp of the test time.
33054 This can prevent tidying of the database from removing the entry.
33055 The interval for this is, by default, 10 days.
33056 An explicit interval can be set using a
33057 &%refresh=value%& option.
33059 Note that &"seen"& should be added to the list of hints databases
33060 for maintenance if this ACL condition is used.
33063 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
33064 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
33065 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
33066 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
33067 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
33068 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
33069 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
33070 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
33071 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
33072 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
33074 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
33076 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
33077 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
33079 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
33080 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
33081 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
33084 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
33085 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
33086 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
33087 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
33088 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
33089 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
33090 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
33091 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
33092 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
33094 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
33095 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
33096 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
33097 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
33099 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
33100 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
33101 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
33102 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
33103 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
33104 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
33105 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
33106 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
33107 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
33108 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
33110 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
33111 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
33112 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
33115 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
33116 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
33117 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
33118 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
33119 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
33120 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
33122 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
33123 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
33124 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
33125 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
33126 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
33127 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
33128 the &%count=%& option.
33131 .subsection "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" ratoptmea
33132 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
33135 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33136 This option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
33137 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
33138 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
33141 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33142 This option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
33143 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
33144 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
33145 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
33148 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33149 This option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
33150 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
33151 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
33152 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
33153 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
33154 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
33155 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
33158 .cindex "rate limiting" per_rcpt
33159 This option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
33160 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
33161 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, or &%acl_smtp_data%& ACLs. In
33162 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
33163 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
33164 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
33165 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
33168 .cindex "rate limiting" per_addr
33169 This option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
33170 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
33171 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
33172 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
33176 .cindex "rate limiting" per_cmd
33177 This option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
33178 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
33179 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
33180 multiple different commands.
33183 .cindex "rate limiting" count
33184 This option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
33186 A value is required, after an equals sign.
33187 For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
33188 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&.
33189 If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
33190 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
33191 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&).
33192 The count does not have to be an integer.
33195 .cindex "rate limiting" unique
33196 This option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
33200 .subsection "Ratelimit update modes" ratoptupd
33201 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
33202 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
33203 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
33204 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
33206 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
33207 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
33209 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
33210 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
33211 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
33212 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
33216 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
33217 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33218 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33221 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
33222 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33223 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33226 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
33227 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
33228 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
33229 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
33230 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
33231 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
33234 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
33235 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
33236 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
33237 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
33238 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
33241 .subsection "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" ratoptfast
33242 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
33243 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
33244 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
33245 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
33246 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
33249 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
33250 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
33251 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
33252 up to the given limit.
33253 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
33254 consists of refusing the message, and
33255 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
33256 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
33257 likely not what is wanted.
33259 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
33260 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
33261 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
33262 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
33263 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
33264 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
33265 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
33266 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
33268 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
33272 .subsection "Limiting the rate of different events" ratoptuniq
33273 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
33274 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
33275 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
33276 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
33277 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
33278 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
33279 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
33280 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
33282 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
33283 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
33284 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
33285 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
33286 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
33287 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
33289 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
33290 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
33293 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
33294 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
33295 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
33296 required increases with larger limits.
33298 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
33299 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
33300 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
33301 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
33302 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
33303 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
33304 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
33305 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
33306 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
33310 .subsection "Using rate limiting" useratlim
33311 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
33312 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
33313 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
33314 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
33315 message. For example:
33317 # Log all senders' rates
33318 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
33319 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
33321 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
33322 # at the decimal point.
33323 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
33324 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
33325 $sender_rate_limit }s
33327 # Keep authenticated users under control
33328 deny authenticated = *
33329 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
33331 # System-wide rate limit
33332 defer ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
33333 message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
33335 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
33336 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
33337 defer ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
33338 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
33339 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
33340 message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
33341 messages per $sender_rate_period
33343 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
33344 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
33345 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
33346 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
33347 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
33348 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
33349 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
33353 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
33354 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
33355 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
33356 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
33357 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
33358 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
33359 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
33360 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
33361 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
33363 verify = sender/callout
33364 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
33366 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
33367 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
33368 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
33369 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
33370 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
33371 The available options are as follows:
33374 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
33375 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
33376 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
33378 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
33379 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
33380 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
33381 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
33383 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
33384 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
33386 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
33387 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
33388 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
33389 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
33391 If the &%quota%& option is specified for recipient verify,
33392 successful routing to an appendfile transport is followed by a call into
33393 the transport to evaluate the quota status for the recipient.
33394 No actual delivery is done, but verification will succeed if the quota
33395 is sufficient for the message (if the sender gave a message size) or
33396 not already exceeded (otherwise).
33399 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
33400 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
33401 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
33402 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
33403 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
33404 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
33407 warn !verify = sender
33408 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
33410 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
33411 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
33412 verification failure.
33413 This variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
33415 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
33416 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
33419 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
33420 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
33422 &%route%&: Routing failed.
33424 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
33425 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
33426 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
33428 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
33430 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
33432 &%quota%&: The quota check for a local recipient did non pass.
33435 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
33436 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
33438 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
33439 address verification to:
33442 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
33448 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
33449 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
33450 .cindex "callout" "verification"
33451 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
33452 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
33453 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
33454 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
33455 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
33456 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
33457 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
33458 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
33459 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
33462 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
33463 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
33464 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
33465 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
33466 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
33467 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
33469 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
33470 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
33471 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
33472 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
33473 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
33475 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
33476 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
33477 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
33478 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
33479 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
33480 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
33481 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
33482 supplies a host list.
33483 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
33485 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
33486 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
33487 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
33488 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
33489 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
33490 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
33491 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
33493 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
33494 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
33495 following SMTP commands are sent:
33497 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
33499 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
33502 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
33505 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
33508 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
33509 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
33510 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
33511 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
33512 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
33513 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
33515 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
33516 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
33517 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
33518 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
33519 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
33521 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
33522 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
33523 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
33524 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
33525 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
33527 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
33528 .cindex "de-tainting" "using recipient verify"
33529 A recipient callout which gets a 2&'xx'& code
33530 will assign untainted values to the
33531 &$domain_data$& and &$local_part_data$& variables,
33532 corresponding to the domain and local parts of the recipient address.
33537 .subsection "Additional parameters for callouts" CALLaddparcall
33538 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
33539 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
33540 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
33542 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
33544 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
33545 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
33546 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
33550 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
33551 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
33552 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
33555 verify = sender/callout=5s
33557 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
33558 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
33559 the &%connect%& parameter.
33562 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
33563 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
33564 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
33565 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
33567 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
33569 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
33571 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
33572 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
33573 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
33574 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
33575 updated in this circumstance.
33577 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
33578 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
33579 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
33580 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
33581 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
33582 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
33585 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
33586 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
33587 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
33588 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
33589 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
33590 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
33591 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
33592 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
33593 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
33594 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
33596 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
33598 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
33601 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
33602 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
33603 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
33606 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
33608 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
33609 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
33610 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
33611 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
33612 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
33615 .vitem &*no_cache*&
33616 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
33617 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
33618 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
33620 .vitem &*postmaster*&
33621 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
33622 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
33623 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
33624 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
33625 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
33626 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
33627 made, until the cache record expires.
33629 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
33630 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
33631 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
33634 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
33636 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
33637 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
33639 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
33641 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
33642 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
33643 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
33644 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
33648 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
33649 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
33650 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
33651 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
33652 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
33654 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
33656 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
33657 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
33658 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
33659 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
33660 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
33662 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
33663 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
33664 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
33666 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
33668 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33669 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
33670 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
33671 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
33672 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
33674 .vitem &*use_sender*&
33675 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
33677 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
33679 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
33680 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
33681 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
33682 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
33683 usefulness of callout caching.
33686 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
33688 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
33690 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
33691 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
33692 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
33693 when that is used for the connections.
33694 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
33695 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
33696 if the use_sender option is used,
33697 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
33698 and if no other callouts intervene.
33701 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
33702 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
33703 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
33704 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
33705 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
33706 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
33707 these circumstances.
33709 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
33710 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
33711 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
33712 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
33713 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
33714 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
33715 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
33717 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
33718 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
33719 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
33720 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
33725 .subsection "Callout caching" SECTcallvercache
33726 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
33727 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
33728 .cindex "caching" "callout"
33729 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
33730 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
33731 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
33732 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
33733 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
33734 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
33736 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
33737 the failure. However, for subsequent failures that use the cache data, this message
33740 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
33741 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
33742 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
33744 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
33745 commands up to and including
33749 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
33750 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
33751 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
33752 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
33753 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
33754 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
33755 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
33757 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
33758 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
33759 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
33760 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
33761 will eventually be noticed.
33763 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
33764 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
33765 behaviour will be the same.
33769 .section "Quota caching" "SECTquotacache"
33770 .cindex "hints database" "quota cache"
33771 .cindex "quota" "cache, description of"
33772 .cindex "caching" "quota"
33773 Exim caches the results of quota verification
33774 in order to reduce the amount of resources used.
33775 The &"callout"& hints database is used.
33777 The default cache periods are five minutes for a positive (good) result
33778 and one hour for a negative result.
33779 To change the periods the &%quota%& option can be followed by an equals sign
33780 and a number of optional paramemters, separated by commas.
33783 verify = recipient/quota=cachepos=1h,cacheneg=1d
33785 Possible parameters are:
33787 .vitem &*cachepos&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
33788 .cindex "quota cache" "positive entry expiry, specifying"
33789 Set the lifetime for a positive cache entry.
33790 A value of zero seconds is legitimate.
33792 .vitem &*cacheneg&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
33793 .cindex "quota cache" "negative entry expiry, specifying"
33794 As above, for a negative entry.
33796 .vitem &*no_cache*&
33797 Set both positive and negative lifetimes to zero.
33799 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
33800 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
33801 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
33802 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
33803 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
33804 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
33807 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
33809 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
33810 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
33811 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
33812 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
33813 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
33814 550 Sender verification failed
33816 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
33817 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
33818 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
33819 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
33822 verify = sender/no_details
33825 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
33826 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
33827 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
33828 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
33829 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
33830 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
33831 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
33834 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
33835 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
33836 verification also fails.
33838 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
33839 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
33842 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
33843 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
33844 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
33847 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
33849 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
33850 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
33851 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
33852 verification to succeed.
33854 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
33855 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
33856 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
33857 option. For example:
33859 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
33861 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
33862 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
33864 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
33865 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
33866 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
33867 address and a report is output for each of them.
33871 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
33872 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
33873 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
33874 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
33875 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
33876 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
33877 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
33881 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
33882 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
33883 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
33884 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
33885 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
33886 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
33888 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
33889 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
33890 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
33891 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
33894 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
33896 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
33898 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
33899 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
33901 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
33902 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
33905 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
33906 use for the DNS query. The default is:
33908 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
33910 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
33911 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
33912 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
33913 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
33916 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
33918 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
33919 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
33920 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
33922 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
33923 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
33924 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
33925 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
33926 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
33927 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
33928 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
33929 of legitimate HELO domains.
33931 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
33932 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
33933 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
33934 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
33937 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
33939 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
33940 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
33941 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
33946 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
33947 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
33948 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
33949 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
33950 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
33951 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
33952 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
33953 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
33955 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
33956 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
33957 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
33958 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
33959 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
33960 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
33961 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
33962 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
33964 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
33965 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
33968 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
33969 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
33972 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
33973 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
33976 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
33978 recipients = +batv_senders
33979 message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
33981 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
33983 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
33984 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
33985 !condition = $prvscheck_result
33986 message = Invalid reverse path signature.
33988 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
33989 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
33990 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
33991 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
33992 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
33994 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
33995 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
33996 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
33997 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
33998 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
33999 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
34000 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
34002 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
34003 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
34004 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
34005 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
34009 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
34011 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
34012 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
34013 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
34016 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
34019 external_smtp_batv:
34021 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
34022 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
34023 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
34024 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
34027 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
34031 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
34032 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
34033 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
34034 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
34035 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
34036 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
34037 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
34038 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
34039 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
34040 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
34042 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
34043 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
34044 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
34045 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
34046 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
34047 same host is fulfilling both functions,
34049 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
34051 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
34052 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
34053 system to arbitrary domains.
34056 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
34057 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
34058 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
34059 example, suppose you want to do the following:
34062 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
34063 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
34064 &'my.dom2.example'&.
34066 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
34067 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
34069 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
34070 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
34074 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
34076 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
34077 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
34078 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
34080 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
34084 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
34085 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
34087 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
34088 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
34089 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
34090 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
34091 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
34092 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
34093 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
34097 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
34098 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
34099 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
34100 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
34101 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
34106 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34107 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34109 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
34110 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
34111 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
34112 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
34113 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
34114 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
34117 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
34118 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
34119 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
34120 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
34121 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
34123 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
34124 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
34125 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
34128 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
34129 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
34131 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
34132 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
34133 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
34135 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
34136 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
34138 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
34141 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
34144 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
34145 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
34146 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
34147 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
34148 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
34149 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
34151 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
34152 temporarily created in a file called:
34154 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
34156 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
34157 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
34158 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
34159 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
34160 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
34162 control = no_mbox_unspool
34164 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
34165 same directory by default.
34169 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
34170 .cindex "virus scanning"
34171 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
34172 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
34173 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
34174 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
34175 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
34176 in memory and thus are much faster.
34178 Since message data needs to have arrived,
34179 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
34181 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
34182 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
34185 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
34186 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
34188 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
34189 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
34190 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
34191 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
34193 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
34195 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
34197 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
34199 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
34201 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
34202 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
34203 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
34207 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
34208 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
34209 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
34210 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
34211 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
34212 This scanner type takes one option,
34213 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34214 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34215 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34216 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34217 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
34218 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
34219 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
34221 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
34222 If &`pass_unscanned`&
34223 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
34224 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
34229 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34230 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34231 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
34233 If you omit the argument, the default path
34234 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
34236 If you use a remote host,
34237 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
34238 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
34239 For information about available commands and their options you may use
34241 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
34247 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
34248 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
34249 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
34251 .vitem &%aveserver%&
34252 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34253 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
34254 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
34255 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
34258 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
34263 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
34264 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
34265 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
34266 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
34267 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
34269 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
34270 a UNIX socket specification,
34271 a TCP socket specification,
34272 or a (global) option.
34274 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
34275 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
34276 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
34277 and the second a port number,
34278 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
34279 These per-server options are supported:
34281 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
34284 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
34285 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
34287 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
34291 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
34292 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
34293 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
34294 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
34295 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
34297 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
34299 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
34300 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
34301 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
34302 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
34304 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
34305 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
34306 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
34307 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
34308 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
34309 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
34310 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
34311 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
34312 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
34314 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
34315 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
34316 (Connection refused)
34319 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
34320 contributing the code for this scanner.
34323 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
34324 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
34325 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
34326 type takes 3 mandatory options:
34329 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
34330 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
34333 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
34334 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
34335 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
34336 the &"trigger"& expression.
34339 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
34340 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
34341 &"name"& expression.
34344 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
34346 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
34348 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
34349 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
34350 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
34351 configuration setting:
34353 av_scanner = cmdline:\
34354 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
34355 found in file:'(.+)'
34358 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
34359 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
34361 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34362 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34363 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34364 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34367 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
34368 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
34370 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
34371 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
34374 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
34375 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
34376 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
34380 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
34382 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
34384 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
34385 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
34386 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
34387 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
34390 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
34392 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
34395 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
34396 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
34397 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
34399 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
34401 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
34402 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
34404 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
34405 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34406 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
34407 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
34408 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
34411 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
34413 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
34416 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
34417 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
34418 though some documentation was available in English.
34419 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
34420 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
34421 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
34423 The only option for this scanner type is
34424 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
34425 provided that mksd has
34426 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
34428 av_scanner = mksd:2
34430 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
34433 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
34434 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
34435 running on the local machine.
34436 There are four options:
34437 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
34438 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
34439 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
34440 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
34441 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
34444 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
34446 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
34447 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
34448 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
34449 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
34450 specify an empty element to get this.
34453 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
34454 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
34455 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
34456 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
34457 client communication. For example:
34459 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
34461 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
34465 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
34466 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
34469 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
34470 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
34471 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
34472 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
34473 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
34474 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
34477 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
34478 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
34479 The first element can then be one of
34482 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
34483 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
34486 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
34487 the condition fails immediately.
34489 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
34490 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
34491 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
34492 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
34493 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
34496 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
34497 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
34498 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
34500 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
34501 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
34504 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
34506 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
34508 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
34509 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
34510 is set to record the actual address used.
34512 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
34513 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
34514 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
34515 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
34518 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
34519 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
34521 Here is a very simple scanning example:
34524 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34526 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
34528 deny malware = */defer_ok
34529 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34531 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
34532 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
34534 av_scanner = $acl_m0
34536 in the main Exim configuration.
34538 deny set acl_m0 = sophie
34540 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34542 deny set acl_m0 = aveserver
34544 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34548 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
34549 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
34550 .cindex "spam scanning"
34551 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
34553 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
34554 score and a report for the message.
34555 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
34557 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
34558 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
34559 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
34561 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
34563 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
34565 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
34566 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
34569 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
34570 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
34571 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
34572 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
34573 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
34574 configuration as follows (example):
34576 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
34578 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
34579 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
34580 iptables firewall, consider setting
34581 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
34582 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
34583 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
34584 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
34588 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
34590 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
34592 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
34595 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
34596 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
34597 filename instead of an address/port pair:
34599 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
34601 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
34602 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
34603 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
34604 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
34606 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
34607 192.168.2.11 783 : \
34610 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
34611 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
34612 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
34615 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
34616 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
34617 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
34618 take care to not double the separator.
34620 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
34621 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
34622 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
34623 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
34625 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
34627 The supported options are:
34629 pri=<priority> Selection priority
34630 weight=<value> Selection bias
34631 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
34632 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
34633 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
34634 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
34637 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
34638 higher values being tried first.
34639 The default priority is 1.
34641 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
34642 Within a priority set
34643 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
34644 The default value for selection bias is 1.
34646 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
34647 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
34648 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
34649 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
34651 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
34652 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
34654 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
34655 The default value is two minutes.
34657 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
34658 a failed connect is made.
34659 The default is to not retry.
34661 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
34662 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
34663 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
34666 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
34667 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
34668 is set to record the actual address used.
34670 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
34671 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
34674 message = This message was classified as SPAM
34676 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
34677 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
34678 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
34679 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
34680 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
34683 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
34684 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
34685 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
34686 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
34687 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
34689 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
34690 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
34692 or the use of PRDR,
34693 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
34694 are needed to use this feature.
34696 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
34697 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
34698 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
34701 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
34702 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
34703 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
34706 deny condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
34708 message = This message was classified as SPAM
34711 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
34712 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
34713 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
34714 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
34716 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
34717 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
34719 Except for &$spam_report$&,
34720 these variables are saved with the received message so are
34721 available for use at delivery time.
34724 .vitem &$spam_score$&
34725 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
34726 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
34728 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
34729 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
34730 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
34731 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
34732 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
34734 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
34735 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
34736 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
34737 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
34738 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
34739 spam bar is 50 characters.
34741 .vitem &$spam_report$&
34742 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
34743 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
34744 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
34745 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
34746 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
34747 unencoded in headers.
34749 .vitem &$spam_action$&
34750 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
34751 spam score versus threshold.
34752 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
34756 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
34757 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
34758 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
34760 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
34761 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
34762 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
34763 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
34764 spam condition, like this:
34766 deny spam = joe/defer_ok
34767 message = This message was classified as SPAM
34769 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
34771 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
34774 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
34775 warn spam = nobody:true
34776 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
34777 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
34779 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
34780 # is over threshold
34782 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
34784 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
34785 deny spam = nobody:true
34786 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
34787 message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
34792 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
34793 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
34794 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
34795 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
34796 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
34797 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
34798 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
34799 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
34800 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
34801 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
34804 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
34805 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
34806 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
34807 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
34808 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
34809 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
34810 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
34812 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
34813 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
34814 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
34815 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
34816 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
34818 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
34819 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
34820 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
34821 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
34822 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
34825 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
34827 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
34831 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
34833 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
34834 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
34835 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
34836 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
34838 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
34839 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
34840 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
34841 the full path and filename.
34843 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
34844 filename, and the default path is then used.
34846 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
34847 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
34848 a file with its original, proposed filename using
34850 decode = $mime_filename
34852 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
34853 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
34854 automatically unlinked.
34856 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
34857 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
34858 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
34859 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
34860 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
34862 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
34863 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
34864 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
34866 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
34867 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
34868 available in the MIME ACL:
34871 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
34872 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
34873 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
34874 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
34875 If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
34876 the detected issue.
34878 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
34879 .vindex &$mime_boundary$&
34880 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
34881 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
34882 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
34883 contains the empty string.
34885 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
34886 .vindex &$mime_charset$&
34887 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
34888 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
34894 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
34895 case-insensitively.
34897 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
34898 .vindex &$mime_content_description$&
34899 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
34900 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
34901 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
34902 only used for display purposes.
34904 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
34905 .vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
34906 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
34907 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
34909 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
34910 .vindex &$mime_content_id$&
34911 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
34912 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
34914 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
34915 .vindex &$mime_content_size$&
34916 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
34917 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
34918 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
34919 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
34921 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
34922 .vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
34923 This variable contains the normalized content of the
34924 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
34925 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
34927 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
34928 .vindex &$mime_content_type$&
34929 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
34930 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
34931 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
34935 application/octet-stream
34939 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
34942 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
34943 .vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
34944 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
34945 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
34946 containing the decoded data.
34951 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
34952 .vindex &$mime_filename$&
34953 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
34954 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
34955 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
34958 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
34960 found, this variable contains the empty string.
34962 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
34963 .vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
34964 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
34965 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
34966 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
34968 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
34969 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
34973 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
34976 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
34977 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
34980 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
34981 and the rest are attachments.
34984 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
34987 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
34988 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
34989 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
34991 deny !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
34992 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
34993 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
34994 message = HTML mail is not accepted here
34997 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
34998 .vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
34999 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
35000 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
35001 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
35002 want to carry out specific actions on them.
35004 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35005 .vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35006 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
35007 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
35008 decoding is fully recursive.
35010 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
35011 .vindex &$mime_part_count$&
35012 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
35013 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
35014 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
35015 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
35016 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
35017 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
35022 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
35023 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
35024 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
35025 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
35026 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
35028 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
35029 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
35030 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
35031 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
35032 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
35034 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
35035 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
35036 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
35037 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
35038 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
35039 32K characters are checked.
35041 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
35042 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
35043 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
35044 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
35045 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
35047 deny regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
35048 message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
35050 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
35051 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
35052 matching regular expression.
35053 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
35054 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
35056 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
35064 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35065 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35067 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
35068 "Local scan function"
35069 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
35070 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
35071 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
35072 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
35073 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
35075 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
35076 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
35077 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
35078 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
35079 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
35081 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
35082 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
35083 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
35084 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
35086 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
35087 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
35088 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
35089 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
35091 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
35092 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
35093 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
35094 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
35095 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
35096 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
35097 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
35098 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
35099 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
35103 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
35104 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
35105 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
35106 function is before building Exim, by setting
35107 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
35108 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
35109 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
35110 directory, so you might set
35112 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
35113 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
35115 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
35116 the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
35117 and then #include "local_scan.h".
35119 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
35120 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
35121 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
35122 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
35123 _src/local_scan.c_.
35125 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
35126 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
35128 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35130 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
35135 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
35136 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
35137 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
35138 You must include this line near the start of your code:
35141 #include "local_scan.h"
35143 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
35144 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
35145 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
35146 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
35147 It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
35148 strings and pointers to character strings:
35150 #define CS (char *)
35151 #define CCS (const char *)
35152 #define CSS (char **)
35153 #define US (unsigned char *)
35154 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
35155 #define USS (unsigned char **)
35157 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
35159 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
35161 The arguments are as follows:
35164 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
35165 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
35166 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
35168 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
35169 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
35170 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
35171 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
35172 case this changes in some future version.
35174 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
35175 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
35178 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
35181 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
35182 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
35183 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
35184 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
35185 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
35186 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
35188 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
35189 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35190 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
35192 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
35193 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35194 queued without immediate delivery.
35196 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
35197 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
35198 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
35199 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
35200 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
35203 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
35204 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
35205 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
35208 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35209 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
35210 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
35211 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
35212 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
35213 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
35214 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35216 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35217 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
35218 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35221 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
35222 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
35223 &%-oe%& command line options.
35227 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
35228 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
35229 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
35230 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
35231 want to do this, you must have the line
35233 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35235 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
35236 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
35237 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
35240 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
35241 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
35242 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
35243 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
35244 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
35245 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
35247 static int my_integer_option = 42;
35248 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
35250 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
35251 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
35252 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
35255 int local_scan_options_count =
35256 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
35258 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
35259 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
35263 my_string = some string of text...
35265 The available types of option data are as follows:
35268 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
35269 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
35270 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
35271 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
35272 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
35273 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
35276 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
35277 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
35278 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
35279 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
35282 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
35283 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
35286 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
35287 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
35288 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
35289 printed with the suffix K or M.
35291 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
35292 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
35293 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
35294 always output in octal.
35296 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
35297 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
35298 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
35300 .vitem &*opt_time*&
35301 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
35302 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
35305 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
35306 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
35310 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
35311 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
35312 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
35313 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
35314 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
35315 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
35316 C variables are as follows:
35319 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
35320 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
35321 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
35323 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
35324 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
35325 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
35327 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
35328 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
35329 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
35330 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
35333 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
35334 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
35335 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
35338 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
35339 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
35343 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
35344 selected, you should use code like this:
35346 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
35347 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
35349 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
35350 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
35351 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
35353 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
35354 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
35357 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
35358 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
35360 .vitem &*const&~uschar&~*headers_charset*&
35361 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
35363 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
35364 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
35365 &%-bh%& command line option.
35367 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
35368 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
35369 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
35371 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
35372 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
35373 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
35374 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
35376 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
35377 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
35378 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
35380 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
35381 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35383 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
35384 The number of accepted recipients.
35386 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
35387 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
35388 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
35389 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
35390 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
35391 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
35392 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
35393 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
35394 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
35395 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
35396 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
35397 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
35399 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
35400 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
35402 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
35403 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
35404 locally-submitted messages.
35406 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
35407 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
35408 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
35410 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
35411 The name of the sending host, if known.
35413 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
35414 The port on the sending host.
35416 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
35417 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
35419 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
35420 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
35422 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
35423 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
35424 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
35428 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
35429 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
35430 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
35431 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
35436 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
35437 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
35439 .vitem &*int&~type*&
35440 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
35441 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
35442 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
35443 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
35444 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
35445 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
35447 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
35448 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
35451 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
35452 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
35453 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
35458 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
35459 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
35462 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
35463 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
35465 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
35466 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
35467 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
35468 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
35470 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
35471 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
35472 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
35473 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
35474 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
35475 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
35476 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
35477 is NULL for all recipients.
35482 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
35483 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
35484 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
35485 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
35489 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
35490 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
35492 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
35493 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
35494 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
35495 for the process in &%newumask%&.
35497 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
35498 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
35499 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
35500 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
35501 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
35503 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
35505 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
35506 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
35507 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
35508 return value is as follows:
35513 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
35519 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
35525 The process timed out.
35529 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
35532 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
35533 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
35534 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
35535 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
35536 forks a subprocess that is running
35538 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
35540 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
35541 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
35542 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
35543 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
35545 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
35546 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
35547 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
35548 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
35551 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
35552 *sender_authentication)*&
35553 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
35556 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
35558 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
35561 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
35562 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
35563 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
35564 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
35565 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
35567 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
35568 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
35571 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
35572 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
35573 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
35574 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
35575 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
35576 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
35577 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
35578 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
35580 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
35581 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
35582 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
35583 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
35584 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
35585 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
35587 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
35588 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
35589 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
35590 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
35592 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
35593 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
35594 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
35595 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
35596 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
35597 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
35598 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
35599 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
35600 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
35601 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
35603 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
35604 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
35606 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
35607 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
35610 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
35611 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
35612 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
35613 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
35614 match the specification, the function does nothing.
35617 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
35618 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
35619 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
35620 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
35621 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
35622 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
35624 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
35626 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
35627 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
35628 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
35629 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
35630 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
35633 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
35634 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
35635 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
35636 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
35637 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
35638 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
35639 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
35640 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
35642 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
35643 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
35644 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
35645 .itable none 0 0 2 15* left 85* left
35646 .irow &`OK`& "match succeeded"
35647 .irow &`FAIL`& "match failed"
35648 .irow &`DEFER`& "match deferred"
35650 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
35651 inability to contact a database.
35653 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
35655 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
35656 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
35657 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
35659 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
35661 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
35662 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
35663 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
35665 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
35667 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
35670 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
35672 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
35673 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
35674 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
35675 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
35676 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
35677 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
35680 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
35682 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
35683 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
35684 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
35685 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
35686 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
35687 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
35690 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
35691 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
35692 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
35693 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
35695 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
35696 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
35697 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
35698 value afterwards. For example:
35700 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
35701 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
35702 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
35705 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
35706 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
35707 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
35708 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
35715 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
35716 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
35717 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
35718 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
35719 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
35720 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
35721 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
35722 binary string is returned with an error message.
35724 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
35725 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
35726 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
35728 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
35729 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
35730 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
35731 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
35732 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
35734 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
35735 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
35736 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
35738 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
35739 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
35740 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
35741 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
35745 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
35746 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
35749 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
35750 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
35751 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
35752 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
35753 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
35754 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
35755 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
35756 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
35759 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
35760 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
35762 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
35763 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
35764 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
35765 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
35767 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
35768 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
35769 ABI version number was incremented.
35771 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
35772 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
35773 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
35774 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
35775 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
35776 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
35777 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
35779 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
35780 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
35782 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
35783 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
35784 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
35785 multiple output lines.
35787 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
35789 guarantee a flush of
35790 pending output, and therefore does not test
35791 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
35792 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
35793 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
35794 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
35795 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
35798 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
35799 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
35800 chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
35801 The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
35802 data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
35803 FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
35804 Exim bombs out if it ever
35805 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
35807 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
35808 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
35809 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
35811 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
35814 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
35817 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
35818 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
35819 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
35820 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
35821 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
35822 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
35828 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
35829 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
35830 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
35831 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
35832 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
35833 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
35834 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
35837 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
35838 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
35839 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
35840 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
35842 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
35843 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
35845 store_pool = POOL_PERM
35847 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
35848 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
35849 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
35850 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
35852 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
35853 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
35854 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
35855 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
35862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35863 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35865 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
35866 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
35867 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
35868 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
35869 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
35870 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
35871 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
35872 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
35874 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
35875 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
35876 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
35877 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
35878 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
35880 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
35881 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
35882 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
35883 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
35884 .cindex retry condition
35885 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
35886 prevent it happening on retries.
35888 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35889 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35890 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
35891 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
35892 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
35893 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
35894 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
35895 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
35898 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
35899 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
35900 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
35901 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
35902 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
35903 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
35904 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
35906 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
35907 system_filter_user = exim
35909 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
35910 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
35911 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
35912 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
35913 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
35914 by the &%reply%& command.
35917 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
35918 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
35919 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
35920 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
35922 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
35923 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
35927 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
35928 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
35929 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
35930 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
35931 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
35932 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
35935 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
35936 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
35937 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
35938 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
35939 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
35940 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
35941 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
35943 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
35944 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
35945 succeed, it will not be tried again.
35946 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
35947 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
35949 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
35950 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
35951 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
35952 to which users' filter files can refer.
35956 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
35957 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
35958 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
35959 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
35960 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
35964 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
35965 .cindex "freezing messages"
35966 .cindex "message" "freezing"
35967 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
35968 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
35969 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
35970 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
35971 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
35972 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
35973 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
35974 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
35975 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
35977 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
35979 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
35981 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
35982 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
35983 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
35984 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
35985 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
35988 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
35989 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
35990 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
35991 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
35993 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
35994 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
35995 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
35996 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
35997 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
35998 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
35999 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
36000 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
36001 message. For example:
36003 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
36004 because it contains attachments that we are \
36005 not prepared to receive."
36008 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
36009 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
36010 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
36011 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
36012 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
36013 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
36016 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
36017 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
36019 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
36020 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
36021 generated by the filter.
36023 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
36025 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
36026 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
36032 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
36033 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
36038 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
36039 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
36040 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
36041 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
36042 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
36044 headers add <string>
36045 headers remove <string>
36047 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
36048 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
36049 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
36050 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
36051 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
36053 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
36054 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
36055 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
36058 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
36059 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
36062 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
36063 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
36064 space after input continuations is ignored.
36066 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
36067 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
36068 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
36069 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
36070 header with the same name, they are all removed.
36072 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
36073 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
36074 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
36075 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
36076 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
36077 used for all recipients of the message.
36079 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
36080 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
36081 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
36082 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
36083 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
36084 until the message is actually being written (see section
36085 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
36087 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
36088 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
36089 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
36090 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
36091 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
36092 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
36093 modified more than once.
36095 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
36096 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
36099 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
36100 headers remove "Subject"
36101 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
36102 headers remove "Old-Subject"
36107 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
36108 .cindex "envelope from"
36109 .cindex "envelope sender"
36110 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
36112 errors_to <some address>
36114 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
36115 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
36116 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
36119 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
36121 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
36122 address if its delivery failed.
36126 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
36127 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
36128 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
36129 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
36130 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
36131 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
36132 such as &$local_part_data$& and &$domain_data$& can be used,
36133 and indeed, the choice of filter file could be made dependent on them.
36134 This is an example of a router which implements such a filter:
36139 domains = +local_domains
36140 file = /central/filters/$local_part_data
36145 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
36146 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
36147 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
36148 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
36150 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
36151 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
36152 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
36153 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
36155 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
36156 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
36157 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
36164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36165 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36167 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
36168 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
36169 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
36170 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
36171 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
36172 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
36173 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
36174 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
36176 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
36177 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
36178 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
36179 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
36180 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
36182 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
36183 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
36184 loopback interface specially in any way.
36186 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
36187 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
36192 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
36193 .cindex "message" "submission"
36194 .cindex "submission mode"
36195 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
36196 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
36197 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
36198 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
36200 control = submission
36202 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
36203 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
36204 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
36205 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
36206 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
36207 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
36209 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
36210 control = submission
36212 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
36213 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
36214 is used to separate options. For example:
36216 control = submission/sender_retain
36218 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
36219 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
36220 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
36221 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
36222 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
36223 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
36224 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
36226 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
36227 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
36230 control = submission/domain=some.domain
36232 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
36233 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
36234 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
36235 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
36237 accept authenticated = *
36238 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
36239 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
36240 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
36242 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
36243 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
36244 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
36246 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
36248 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
36251 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
36253 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
36254 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
36255 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
36256 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
36258 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
36259 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
36260 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
36261 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
36262 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
36263 spoof another's address.
36265 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
36266 .cindex "line endings"
36267 .cindex "carriage return"
36269 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
36270 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
36271 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
36272 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
36273 use CRLF or just CR.
36275 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
36276 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
36277 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
36278 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
36279 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
36280 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
36281 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
36282 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
36286 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
36288 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
36291 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
36292 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
36295 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
36296 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
36297 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
36298 people trying to play silly games.
36300 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
36301 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
36309 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
36310 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
36311 .cindex "address" "qualification"
36312 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
36313 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
36314 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
36315 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
36316 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
36318 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
36319 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
36320 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
36321 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
36322 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
36324 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
36325 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
36326 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
36327 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
36328 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
36329 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
36330 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
36331 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
36336 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
36337 .cindex "&""From""& line"
36338 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
36339 .cindex "sender" "address"
36340 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
36341 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
36342 .cindex "envelope from"
36343 .cindex "envelope sender"
36344 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
36345 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
36346 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
36347 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
36349 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
36350 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
36352 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
36353 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
36354 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
36355 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
36356 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
36357 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
36358 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
36359 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
36360 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
36362 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
36363 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
36364 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
36365 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
36366 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
36367 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
36368 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
36370 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
36371 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
36372 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
36374 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
36375 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
36376 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
36377 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
36381 .section "Header lines"
36382 .subsection "Resent- header lines" SECID220
36384 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
36385 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
36386 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
36387 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
36388 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
36391 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
36392 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
36395 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
36396 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
36400 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
36401 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
36403 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
36404 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
36405 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
36407 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
36410 For a locally-submitted message,
36411 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
36412 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
36413 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
36414 included in log lines in this case.
36416 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
36417 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
36423 .subsection Auto-Submitted: SECID221
36424 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
36425 includes the header line:
36427 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
36430 .subsection Bcc: SECID222
36431 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
36432 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
36433 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
36434 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
36435 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
36438 .subsection Date: SECID223
36440 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
36441 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
36442 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
36444 .subsection Delivery-date: SECID224
36445 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
36446 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
36447 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
36448 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
36449 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
36450 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
36451 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
36455 .subsection Envelope-to: SECID225
36456 .chindex Envelope-to:
36457 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
36458 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
36459 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
36460 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
36461 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
36462 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
36466 .subsection From: SECTthefrohea
36468 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
36469 .cindex "message" "submission"
36470 .cindex "submission mode"
36471 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
36472 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
36475 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
36476 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
36478 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
36479 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
36481 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
36482 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
36483 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
36485 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
36486 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
36488 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
36489 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
36493 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
36495 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
36496 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
36497 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
36498 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
36499 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
36500 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
36501 &%qualify_domain%&.
36503 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
36504 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
36505 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
36506 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
36509 .subsection Message-ID: SECID226
36510 .chindex Message-ID:
36511 .cindex "message" "submission"
36512 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
36513 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
36514 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
36515 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
36516 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
36517 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
36518 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
36519 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
36520 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
36521 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
36524 .subsection Received: SECID227
36526 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
36527 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
36528 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
36530 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
36531 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
36532 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
36533 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
36535 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
36536 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
36537 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
36540 .subsection References: SECID228
36541 .chindex References:
36542 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
36543 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
36544 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
36545 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
36546 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
36547 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
36548 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
36549 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
36550 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
36554 .subsection Return-path: SECID229
36555 .chindex Return-path:
36556 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
36557 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
36558 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
36559 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
36560 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
36561 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
36565 .subsection Sender: SECTthesenhea
36566 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
36567 .cindex "message" "submission"
36569 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
36570 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
36571 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
36572 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
36575 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
36576 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
36577 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
36578 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
36579 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
36580 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
36581 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
36582 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
36583 line is added to the message.
36585 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
36586 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
36587 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
36588 options true at the same time.
36590 .cindex "submission mode"
36591 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
36592 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
36593 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
36594 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
36596 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
36597 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
36598 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
36599 created as follows:
36602 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
36603 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
36604 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
36606 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
36607 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
36609 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
36610 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
36613 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
36614 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
36615 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
36616 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
36618 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
36619 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
36620 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
36621 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
36625 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
36626 "SECTheadersaddrem"
36627 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
36628 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
36629 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
36630 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
36631 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
36632 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
36633 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
36635 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
36636 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
36637 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
36638 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
36639 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
36640 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
36642 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
36643 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
36644 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
36646 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
36647 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
36648 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
36650 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
36651 X-added-second: another added header line
36653 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
36655 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
36656 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
36657 Each header-line is separately expanded.
36659 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
36660 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
36661 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
36662 not part of the names. For example:
36664 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
36667 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
36668 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
36669 Each item is separately expanded.
36670 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
36671 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
36672 will act as list separators.
36674 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
36675 items are expanded at routing time,
36676 and then associated with all addresses that are
36677 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
36678 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
36679 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
36681 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
36682 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
36683 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
36684 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
36686 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
36687 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
36688 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
36691 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
36692 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
36693 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
36694 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
36695 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
36696 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
36697 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
36699 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
36700 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
36701 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
36702 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
36704 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
36705 the following consequences:
36708 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
36709 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
36710 to it, at all times.
36712 Header lines that are added by a router's
36713 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
36714 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
36716 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
36717 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
36719 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
36720 a later router or by a transport.
36722 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
36723 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
36725 headers_remove = subject
36726 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
36730 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
36731 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
36737 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
36738 .cindex "address" "constructed"
36739 .cindex "constructed address"
36740 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
36743 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
36747 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
36749 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
36750 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
36751 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
36752 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
36753 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
36754 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
36755 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
36756 there is no password file entry.
36759 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
36760 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
36761 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
36762 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
36763 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
36764 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
36765 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
36766 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
36770 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
36771 .cindex "case of local parts"
36772 .cindex "local part" "case of"
36773 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
36774 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
36775 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
36776 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
36777 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
36778 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
36781 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
36782 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
36783 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
36784 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
36785 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
36789 domains = +local_domains
36790 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
36791 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
36794 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
36795 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
36796 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
36797 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
36798 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
36802 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
36803 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
36804 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
36805 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
36806 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
36807 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
36808 empty components for compatibility.
36812 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
36813 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
36814 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
36815 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
36816 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
36817 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
36819 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
36820 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
36821 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
36822 example, a header such as
36826 might get rewritten as
36828 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
36830 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
36831 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
36834 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
36835 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
36836 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
36837 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
36838 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
36839 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
36840 .ecindex IIDmesproc
36844 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36845 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36847 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
36848 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
36849 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
36850 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
36851 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
36852 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
36853 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
36856 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
36858 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
36860 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
36863 For mail delivery, the following are available:
36866 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
36868 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
36871 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
36874 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
36875 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
36878 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
36879 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
36880 used to contain the envelope information.
36884 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
36885 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
36886 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
36887 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
36888 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
36891 .cindex "SIZE" "option on MAIL command"
36892 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
36893 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
36894 processing is the same in both cases.
36896 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
36897 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
36898 extension is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
36899 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
36900 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
36901 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
36902 .cindex "transport" "filter"
36903 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
36904 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
36907 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
36908 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
36909 required for the transaction.
36911 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
36912 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
36913 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
36914 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
36915 is called for verification.
36917 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
36918 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
36919 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
36921 .cindex "carriage return"
36923 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
36924 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
36925 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
36928 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
36929 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
36930 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
36931 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
36932 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
36933 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
36934 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
36935 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
36936 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
36938 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
36939 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
36940 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
36941 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
36943 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
36944 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
36945 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
36946 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
36948 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36949 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
36950 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
36951 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
36952 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
36953 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
36954 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
36955 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
36956 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
36957 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
36959 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
36960 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
36962 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36963 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
36964 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
36965 square bracket of the IP address.
36970 .subsection "Errors in outgoing SMTP" SECToutSMTPerr
36971 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
36972 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
36973 .cindex "host" "error"
36974 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
36975 message errors, and recipient errors.
36978 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
36979 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
36980 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
36983 Connection refused or timed out,
36985 Any error response code on connection,
36987 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
36989 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
36991 I/O errors at any time,
36993 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
36994 the &"."& at the end of the data.
36997 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
36998 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
36999 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
37000 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
37001 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
37002 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
37003 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
37004 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
37006 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
37007 .cindex "message" "error"
37008 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
37009 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
37010 message errors are:
37013 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
37016 Timeout after MAIL,
37018 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
37019 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
37020 connection at any other time.
37023 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
37024 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
37025 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
37026 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
37027 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
37028 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
37029 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
37030 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
37031 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
37032 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
37034 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
37035 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
37036 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
37039 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
37040 .cindex "recipient" "error"
37041 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
37042 recipient errors are:
37045 Any error response to RCPT,
37047 Timeout after RCPT.
37050 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
37051 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
37052 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
37053 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
37054 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
37055 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
37056 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
37057 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
37058 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
37059 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
37060 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
37061 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
37062 the retry clock is reset.
37064 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
37065 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
37066 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
37067 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
37068 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
37069 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
37070 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
37071 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
37072 recipient's retry time.
37075 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
37076 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
37077 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
37078 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
37079 until the next delivery attempt.
37081 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
37082 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
37083 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
37084 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
37085 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
37088 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
37089 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
37090 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
37091 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
37092 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
37093 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
37094 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
37096 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
37097 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
37098 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
37099 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
37100 then to be treated as a host error.
37102 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
37103 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
37104 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
37105 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
37106 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
37111 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
37112 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
37113 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
37116 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
37117 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
37118 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
37120 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
37122 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
37123 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
37124 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
37125 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
37126 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
37127 stream and exits with an error code.
37129 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
37130 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
37131 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
37132 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
37134 .cindex "carriage return"
37136 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37137 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
37138 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37140 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
37141 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
37142 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
37144 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
37145 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
37146 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
37147 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
37148 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
37149 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
37150 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
37151 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
37153 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
37154 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
37155 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
37156 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
37157 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
37158 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
37159 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
37160 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
37161 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
37163 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
37164 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
37165 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
37167 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
37168 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
37169 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
37170 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
37171 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
37173 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
37174 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
37175 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
37176 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
37177 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
37178 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
37179 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
37181 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
37182 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
37183 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
37184 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
37185 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
37187 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
37188 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
37189 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
37190 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
37191 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
37192 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
37193 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
37194 a delivery process.
37196 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
37197 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
37198 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
37199 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
37200 however, available with &'inetd'&.
37202 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
37203 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
37204 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
37205 section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&.
37207 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
37208 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
37209 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
37213 .subsection "Unrecognized SMTP commands" SECID234
37214 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
37215 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
37216 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
37217 the error response to the last command. The default value for
37218 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
37219 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
37220 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
37223 .subsection "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" SECID235
37224 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
37225 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
37226 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
37227 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
37228 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
37229 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
37230 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
37231 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
37232 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
37233 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
37237 .subsection "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" SECID236
37238 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
37239 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
37240 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
37241 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
37242 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
37243 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
37244 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
37246 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
37247 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
37248 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
37249 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
37250 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
37253 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
37254 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
37255 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
37257 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
37258 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
37259 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
37260 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
37261 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
37266 .subsection "The VRFY and EXPN commands" SECID237
37267 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
37268 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
37269 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
37271 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
37272 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
37273 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
37274 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
37275 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
37276 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
37277 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
37278 SMTP response codes.
37280 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
37281 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
37282 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
37283 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
37284 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
37285 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
37286 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
37287 VRFY verification failures are logged in the main log for consistency with
37292 .subsection "The ETRN command" SECTETRN
37293 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
37294 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
37295 RFC 1985 describes an ESMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
37296 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
37297 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
37298 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
37299 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
37301 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
37302 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
37303 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
37304 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
37305 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
37306 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
37307 argument. For example,
37315 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
37316 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
37317 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
37318 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
37319 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
37321 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
37322 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
37323 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
37324 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
37325 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
37326 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
37327 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
37328 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
37330 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
37331 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
37332 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
37333 whatever the form of its argument. For
37336 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
37337 $sender_host_address
37339 .vindex "&$domain$&"
37340 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
37341 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
37342 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
37343 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
37344 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
37345 for it to change them before running the command.
37349 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
37350 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
37351 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
37352 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
37353 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
37354 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
37355 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
37356 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
37357 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
37358 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
37359 runs for RCPT commands:
37363 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
37367 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
37368 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
37369 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
37370 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
37371 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
37372 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
37373 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
37374 envelope along with the message.
37376 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
37377 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
37378 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
37379 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
37380 can be used to specify it.
37382 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
37383 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
37384 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
37385 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
37386 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
37389 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
37390 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
37391 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
37396 driver = manualroute
37397 transport = smtp_appendfile
37398 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
37402 driver = appendfile
37403 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
37408 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
37409 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
37410 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
37414 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
37415 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
37416 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
37417 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
37418 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
37419 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
37420 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
37421 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
37422 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
37423 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
37425 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
37426 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
37428 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
37429 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
37430 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
37431 make some use of automatically, for example:
37433 554 Unexpected end of file
37434 Transaction started in line 10
37435 Error detected in line 14
37437 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
37440 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
37441 The error message was:
37443 501 '>' missing at end of address
37445 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
37446 The error was detected in line 12.
37447 The SMTP command at fault was:
37449 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
37451 1 previous message was successfully processed.
37452 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
37454 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
37455 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
37457 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
37458 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
37462 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37463 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37465 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
37466 "Customizing messages"
37467 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
37468 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
37469 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
37470 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
37471 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
37473 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
37474 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
37475 option. Exim also adds the line
37477 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
37479 to all warning and bounce messages,
37482 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
37483 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
37484 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
37485 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
37486 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
37487 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
37488 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
37490 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
37491 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
37492 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
37493 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
37494 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
37497 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
37498 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
37499 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
37500 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
37501 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
37502 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
37503 option, rounded to a whole number.
37505 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
37508 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
37509 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
37511 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
37512 failing addresses with their error messages.
37514 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
37515 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
37517 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
37518 The fields exist for back-compatibility
37521 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
37522 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
37523 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
37525 Subject: Mail delivery failed
37526 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
37527 {: returning message to sender}}
37529 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
37531 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
37532 {that you sent }{sent by
37536 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
37537 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
37539 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
37541 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
37544 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
37546 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
37549 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
37550 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
37551 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
37552 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
37553 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
37557 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
37558 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
37560 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
37561 the delayed addresses.
37563 The third item then ends the message.
37566 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
37567 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
37569 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
37570 $warn_message_delay
37572 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
37574 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
37575 {that you sent }{sent by
37579 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
37580 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
37582 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
37583 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
37584 The date of the message is: $h_date
37586 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
37588 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
37589 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
37590 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
37591 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
37592 the message will be returned to you.
37594 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
37595 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
37596 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
37597 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
37598 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
37599 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
37600 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
37601 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
37607 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37610 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
37611 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
37612 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
37616 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
37617 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
37618 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
37619 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
37620 routing explicitly:
37622 send_to_smart_host:
37623 driver = manualroute
37624 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
37625 transport = remote_smtp
37627 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
37628 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
37629 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
37630 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
37631 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
37636 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
37637 .cindex "mailing lists"
37638 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
37639 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
37640 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
37642 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
37643 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
37644 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
37645 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
37649 domains = lists.example
37650 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
37653 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
37656 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
37657 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
37658 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
37659 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
37661 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
37662 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
37665 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
37666 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
37667 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
37668 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
37669 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
37671 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
37672 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
37673 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
37674 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
37675 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
37676 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
37677 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
37678 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
37679 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
37683 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
37684 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
37685 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
37686 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
37687 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
37688 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
37689 addresses are not rigorously checked.
37691 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
37692 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
37693 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
37694 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
37695 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
37699 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
37700 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
37701 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
37702 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
37703 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
37704 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
37705 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
37706 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
37707 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
37708 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
37710 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
37711 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
37712 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
37713 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
37714 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
37715 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
37716 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
37717 pre-existing messages.
37719 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
37720 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
37721 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
37722 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
37723 one level of expansion anyway.
37727 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
37728 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
37729 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
37730 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
37731 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
37732 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
37734 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
37735 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
37739 domains = lists.example
37740 local_part_suffix = -request
37741 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file {/usr/lists}}
37742 file = /usr/lists/${local_part_data}-request
37747 domains = lists.example
37748 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
37749 senders = ${if exists {$local_part_data} {lsearch;$local_part_data}{*}}
37750 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
37753 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
37758 domains = lists.example
37760 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
37762 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
37763 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
37764 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
37767 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
37768 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
37769 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
37770 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
37771 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
37772 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
37773 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
37774 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
37775 &"unrouteable address"& error.
37777 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
37778 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
37779 the address, giving a suitable error message.
37784 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
37786 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
37787 .cindex "envelope from"
37788 .cindex "envelope sender"
37789 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
37790 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
37791 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
37792 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
37793 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
37794 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
37796 .oindex &%errors_to%&
37797 .oindex &%return_path%&
37798 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
37799 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
37800 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
37801 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
37802 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
37803 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
37804 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
37810 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
37811 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
37813 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
37814 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
37815 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
37816 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
37817 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
37818 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
37819 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
37822 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
37824 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
37825 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
37826 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
37827 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
37828 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
37829 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
37831 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
37832 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
37833 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
37834 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
37838 domains = ! +local_domains
37840 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
37841 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
37844 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
37845 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
37846 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
37847 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
37850 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
37851 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
37852 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
37853 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
37854 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
37858 domains = ! +local_domains
37859 transport = remote_smtp
37861 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
37862 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
37865 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
37866 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
37867 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
37868 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
37871 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
37872 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
37873 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
37874 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
37875 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
37876 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
37884 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
37885 .cindex "virtual domains"
37886 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
37887 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
37891 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
37892 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
37893 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
37895 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
37896 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
37897 have login accounts on that host.
37900 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
37901 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
37902 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
37903 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
37904 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
37905 to a router of this form:
37909 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
37910 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
37913 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
37914 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
37915 domain that is being processed.
37916 The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
37917 being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
37919 When the router runs, it looks up the local
37920 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
37921 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
37922 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
37924 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
37925 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
37926 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
37927 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
37929 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
37930 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
37931 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
37935 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
37936 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
37937 transport = my_mailboxes
37939 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
37940 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
37941 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
37942 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
37943 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
37947 driver = appendfile
37948 file = /var/mail/$domain_data/$local_part_data
37951 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
37952 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
37954 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
37955 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
37956 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
37957 information about the domains.
37961 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
37962 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
37963 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
37964 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
37965 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
37966 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
37967 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
37968 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
37969 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
37970 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
37971 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
37972 example, consider this router:
37977 file = $home/.forward
37978 local_part_suffix = -*
37979 local_part_suffix_optional
37982 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
37983 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
37984 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
37985 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
37987 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
37988 save /home/$local_part_data/Mail/special
37991 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
37992 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
37993 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
37994 control over which suffixes are valid.
37996 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
37997 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
38003 local_part_suffix = -*
38004 local_part_suffix_optional
38005 file = ${lookup {.forward$local_part_suffix} dsearch,ret=full {$home} {$value}fail}
38008 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
38009 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
38010 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
38011 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
38012 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
38016 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
38017 .cindex "vacation processing"
38018 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
38019 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
38020 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
38021 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
38022 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
38025 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
38026 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
38027 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
38028 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
38030 spqr, vacation-spqr
38033 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
38034 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
38035 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
38036 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
38037 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
38041 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
38042 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
38046 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
38047 .cindex "message" "copying every"
38048 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
38049 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
38050 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
38051 each day's messages.
38053 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
38054 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
38055 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
38056 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
38060 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
38061 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
38062 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
38063 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
38064 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
38065 permanently connected.
38067 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
38068 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
38069 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
38072 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
38073 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
38074 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
38075 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
38076 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
38077 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
38078 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
38079 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
38081 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
38082 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
38083 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
38084 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
38085 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
38086 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
38089 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
38090 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
38091 intermittent host. For example:
38093 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
38095 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
38096 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
38097 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
38098 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
38099 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
38100 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
38103 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
38104 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
38105 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
38106 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
38107 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
38108 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
38109 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
38113 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
38114 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
38115 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
38116 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
38117 delivered immediately.
38119 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
38120 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
38121 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
38122 .cindex "first pass routing"
38123 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
38124 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
38125 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
38126 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
38127 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
38128 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
38129 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
38130 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
38131 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
38132 single SMTP connection.
38136 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38137 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38139 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
38140 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
38141 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
38142 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
38143 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
38144 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
38145 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
38146 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
38147 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
38148 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
38151 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
38152 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
38153 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
38154 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
38155 email is not desirable.
38157 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
38158 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
38159 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
38160 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
38161 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
38162 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
38163 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
38165 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
38166 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
38167 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
38168 before sending a message to the smart host.
38170 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
38171 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
38172 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
38174 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
38175 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
38176 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
38177 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
38178 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
38179 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
38180 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
38182 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
38186 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
38187 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
38189 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
38190 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
38191 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
38192 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
38193 successful, a zero return code is given.
38195 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
38196 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
38197 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
38198 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
38199 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
38202 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
38203 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
38204 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
38206 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
38207 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
38208 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
38209 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
38210 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
38212 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
38213 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
38214 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
38216 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
38217 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
38218 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
38219 are ever generated.
38221 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
38223 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
38224 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
38225 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
38228 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
38229 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
38230 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
38231 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
38232 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
38233 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
38238 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38239 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38241 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
38242 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
38243 .cindex "log" "types of"
38244 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
38249 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
38250 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
38251 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
38252 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
38253 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
38254 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
38255 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
38256 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
38258 .cindex "reject log"
38259 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
38260 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
38261 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
38262 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
38263 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
38264 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
38265 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
38266 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
38267 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
38270 .cindex "panic log"
38271 .cindex "system log"
38272 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
38273 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
38274 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
38275 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
38276 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
38277 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
38278 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
38279 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
38280 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
38283 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
38284 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
38285 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
38287 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
38290 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
38291 ways of changing this:
38294 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
38299 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
38301 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
38304 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
38308 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
38309 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
38310 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
38311 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
38312 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
38313 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
38318 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
38319 .cindex "log" "destination"
38320 .cindex "log" "to file"
38321 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
38323 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
38324 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
38325 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
38326 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
38327 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
38328 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
38329 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
38331 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
38332 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
38333 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
38334 references to the host name:
38336 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
38338 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
38339 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
38340 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
38341 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
38342 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
38345 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
38346 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
38347 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
38348 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
38349 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
38350 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
38351 implying the use of a default path.
38353 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
38354 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
38355 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
38356 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. If no such item exists, log
38357 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
38358 equivalent to the configuration file setting:
38360 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
38362 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
38363 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
38364 that is where the logs are written.
38366 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
38367 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
38369 Here are some examples of possible Makefile settings:
38371 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
38372 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
38373 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
38374 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
38376 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
38381 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
38382 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38383 .cindex "cycling logs"
38384 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38385 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
38386 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
38387 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
38388 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
38389 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
38390 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
38392 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
38393 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
38394 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
38395 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
38396 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
38397 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
38398 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
38399 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
38400 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
38401 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
38402 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
38407 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
38408 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
38409 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
38410 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
38411 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
38412 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
38413 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
38414 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
38416 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
38417 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
38418 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
38419 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
38421 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
38422 examples of names generated by the above examples:
38424 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
38425 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
38426 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
38427 /var/log/exim/main.200212
38429 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
38430 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
38431 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
38432 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
38434 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
38435 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
38436 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
38437 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
38438 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
38439 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
38442 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
38443 /var/log/exim-panic.log
38444 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
38445 /var/log/exim/panic
38449 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
38450 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
38451 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
38452 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
38453 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
38454 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
38455 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
38456 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
38457 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
38458 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
38459 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
38460 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
38461 the time and host name to each line.
38462 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
38465 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
38467 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
38469 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
38472 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
38473 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
38474 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
38475 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
38477 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
38478 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
38479 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
38480 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
38481 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
38482 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
38483 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
38484 RFC 3164, you should set
38486 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
38488 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
38489 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
38491 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
38492 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
38493 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
38494 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
38495 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
38496 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
38497 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
38498 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
38499 name, and pid as added by syslog:
38501 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
38502 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
38503 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
38504 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
38507 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
38510 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
38511 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
38512 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
38513 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
38515 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
38516 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
38517 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
38518 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
38519 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
38520 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
38522 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
38523 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
38524 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
38527 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
38529 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
38530 without modification.
38532 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
38533 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
38534 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
38539 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
38540 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
38541 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
38542 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
38543 timestamp. The flags are:
38544 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
38545 .irow &%<=%& "message arrival"
38546 .irow &%(=%& "message fakereject"
38547 .irow &%=>%& "normal message delivery"
38548 .irow &%->%& "additional address in same delivery"
38549 .irow &%>>%& "cutthrough message delivery"
38550 .irow &%*>%& "delivery suppressed by &%-N%&"
38551 .irow &%**%& "delivery failed; address bounced"
38552 .irow &%==%& "delivery deferred; temporary problem"
38556 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
38557 .cindex "log" "reception line"
38558 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
38559 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
38560 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
38562 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
38563 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
38564 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
38566 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
38567 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
38568 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
38572 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
38576 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
38577 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
38578 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
38579 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
38580 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
38581 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
38582 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
38583 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
38584 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
38585 name in parentheses.
38587 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
38588 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
38589 the log containing text like these examples:
38591 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
38592 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
38594 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
38597 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
38598 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
38601 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
38602 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
38603 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
38604 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
38605 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
38606 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
38607 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
38608 suite that was used.
38610 .cindex log protocol
38611 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
38612 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
38613 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
38614 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
38615 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
38616 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
38617 authenticator name.
38619 .cindex "size" "of message"
38620 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
38621 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
38622 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
38623 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
38626 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
38627 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
38631 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
38632 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
38633 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
38634 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
38635 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
38636 to fit it on the page:
38638 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
38639 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
38640 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
38641 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
38642 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
38644 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
38645 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
38646 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
38647 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
38648 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
38650 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
38651 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
38652 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
38653 option, this is logged too, as a second colon-separated list item.
38654 Optionally (see the &%smtp_mailauth%& &%log_selector%&) there may be a third list item.
38656 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
38657 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
38659 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
38661 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
38662 parentheses afterwards.
38664 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
38665 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
38666 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
38667 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
38668 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the
38669 remote IP address (and port if enabled)
38670 in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
38671 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
38672 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
38673 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
38674 TLS cipher information is still available.
38676 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
38677 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
38678 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
38679 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
38680 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
38682 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
38683 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
38685 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
38686 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
38689 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
38690 .cindex "discarded messages"
38691 .cindex "message" "discarded"
38692 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
38693 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
38694 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
38696 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
38697 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
38699 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
38700 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
38702 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
38703 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
38707 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
38708 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
38710 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
38711 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
38713 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
38714 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
38715 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
38717 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
38718 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
38720 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
38721 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
38722 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
38726 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
38727 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
38728 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
38729 following form is logged:
38731 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
38732 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
38734 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
38735 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
38737 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
38738 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
38739 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
38740 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
38741 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
38743 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
38744 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
38745 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
38746 flagged with &`**`&.
38750 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
38751 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
38752 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
38753 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
38754 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
38758 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
38761 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
38763 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
38764 at the end of its processing.
38769 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
38770 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
38771 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
38772 the following table:
38774 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
38775 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
38776 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
38777 &`CV `& certificate verification status
38778 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
38779 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
38780 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
38781 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
38782 &`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
38783 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
38784 &`H `& host name and IP address
38785 &`I `& local interface used
38786 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
38787 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
38788 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
38789 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
38790 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
38791 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
38792 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
38793 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
38794 &`Q `& alternate queue name
38795 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
38796 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
38797 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
38798 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
38799 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
38800 &`S `& size of message in bytes
38801 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
38802 &`ST `& shadow transport name
38803 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
38804 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
38805 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
38806 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
38807 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
38811 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
38812 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
38813 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
38816 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
38817 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
38818 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
38819 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
38820 during the first delivery attempt.
38822 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
38823 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
38824 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
38826 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
38827 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
38828 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
38829 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
38830 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
38833 .cindex "error" "ignored"
38834 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
38837 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
38838 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
38840 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
38841 failed. The delivery was discarded.
38843 A delivery set up by a router configured with
38844 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
38845 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
38849 failed. The delivery was discarded.
38852 .cindex DKIM "log line"
38853 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
38854 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
38861 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
38862 .cindex "log" "selectors"
38863 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
38864 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
38865 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
38868 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
38870 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
38871 selection marked by asterisks:
38872 .itable none 0 0 3 2.8in left 10pt center 3in left
38873 .irow &`8bitmime`& "received 8BITMIME status"
38874 .irow &`acl_warn_skipped`& * "skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL"
38875 .irow &`address_rewrite`& "address rewriting"
38876 .irow &`all_parents`& "all parents in => lines"
38877 .irow &`arguments`& "command line arguments"
38878 .irow &`connection_reject`& * "connection rejections"
38879 .irow &`delay_delivery`& * "immediate delivery delayed"
38880 .irow &`deliver_time`& "time taken to attempt delivery"
38881 .irow &`delivery_size`& "add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines"
38882 .irow &`dkim`& * "DKIM verified domain on <= lines"
38883 .irow &`dkim_verbose`& "separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature"
38884 .irow &`dnslist_defer`& * "defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups"
38885 .irow &`dnssec`& "DNSSEC secured lookups"
38886 .irow &`etrn`& * "ETRN commands"
38887 .irow &`host_lookup_failed`& * "as it says"
38888 .irow &`ident_timeout`& "timeout for ident connection"
38889 .irow &`incoming_interface`& "local interface on <= and => lines"
38890 .irow &`incoming_port`& "remote port on <= lines"
38891 .irow &`lost_incoming_connection`& * "as it says (includes timeouts)"
38892 .irow &`millisec`& "millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times"
38893 .irow &`msg_id`& * "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value"
38894 .irow &`msg_id_created`& "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added"
38895 .irow &`outgoing_interface`& "local interface on => lines"
38896 .irow &`outgoing_port`& "add remote port to => lines"
38897 .irow &`queue_run`& * "start and end queue runs"
38898 .irow &`queue_time`& "time on queue for one recipient"
38899 .irow &`queue_time_exclusive`& "exclude recieve time from QT times"
38900 .irow &`queue_time_overall`& "time on queue for whole message"
38901 .irow &`pid`& "Exim process id"
38902 .irow &`pipelining`& "PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines"
38903 .irow &`proxy`& "proxy address on <= and => lines"
38904 .irow &`receive_time`& "time taken to receive message"
38905 .irow &`received_recipients`& "recipients on <= lines"
38906 .irow &`received_sender`& "sender on <= lines"
38907 .irow &`rejected_header`& * "header contents on reject log"
38908 .irow &`retry_defer`& * "&<quote>&retry time not reached&</quote>&"
38909 .irow &`return_path_on_delivery`& "put return path on => and ** lines"
38910 .irow &`sender_on_delivery`& "add sender to => lines"
38911 .irow &`sender_verify_fail`& * "sender verification failures"
38912 .irow &`size_reject`& * "rejection because too big"
38913 .irow &`skip_delivery`& * "delivery skipped in a queue run"
38914 .irow &`smtp_confirmation`& * "SMTP confirmation on => lines"
38915 .irow &`smtp_connection`& "incoming SMTP connections"
38916 .irow &`smtp_incomplete_transaction`& "incomplete SMTP transactions"
38917 .irow &`smtp_mailauth`& "AUTH argument to MAIL commands"
38918 .irow &`smtp_no_mail`& "session with no MAIL commands"
38919 .irow &`smtp_protocol_error`& "SMTP protocol errors"
38920 .irow &`smtp_syntax_error`& "SMTP syntax errors"
38921 .irow &`subject`& "contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines"
38922 .irow &`tls_certificate_verified`& * "certificate verification status"
38923 .irow &`tls_cipher`& * "TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines"
38924 .irow &`tls_peerdn`& "TLS peer DN on <= and => lines"
38925 .irow &`tls_resumption`& "append * to cipher field"
38926 .irow &`tls_sni`& "TLS SNI on <= lines"
38927 .irow &`unknown_in_list`& "DNS lookup failed in list match"
38928 .irow &`all`& "&*all of the above*&"
38930 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
38931 section &<<SECID99>>&
38933 More details on each of these items follows:
38937 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
38938 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
38939 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
38940 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
38941 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
38942 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
38944 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
38945 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
38946 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
38947 this log selector is set.
38949 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
38950 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
38951 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
38952 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
38953 such users cannot access the log).
38955 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
38956 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
38957 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
38958 parentheses between them.
38960 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
38961 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
38962 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
38963 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
38964 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
38965 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
38966 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
38967 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
38968 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
38969 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
38970 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
38971 between the caller and Exim.
38973 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
38974 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
38975 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
38977 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
38978 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
38979 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
38980 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
38981 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
38982 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
38984 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
38985 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
38986 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
38987 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38988 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
38990 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
38991 .cindex "size" "of message"
38992 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
38993 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
38995 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
38996 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
38997 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
38998 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
39000 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39001 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39002 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
39004 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
39005 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
39006 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
39007 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
39008 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
39011 .cindex dnssec logging
39012 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
39013 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
39014 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
39015 It does not cover helo-name verification.
39016 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
39018 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
39019 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
39020 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
39021 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
39022 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
39023 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
39025 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
39026 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
39027 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
39028 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
39029 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
39031 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
39032 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
39033 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
39034 client's ident port times out.
39036 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
39037 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39038 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39039 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39040 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39041 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39042 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
39043 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
39044 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
39045 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
39046 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing
39047 &"=>"&, &"->"&, &"=="& and &"**"& lines.
39048 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39050 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
39051 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
39052 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
39053 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
39054 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
39055 on a proxied connection
39056 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
39057 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
39059 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
39060 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
39061 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
39062 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
39063 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
39064 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
39065 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
39066 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
39067 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
39068 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
39069 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
39071 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
39072 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
39073 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
39075 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
39076 .cindex millisecond logging
39077 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
39078 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
39079 appended to the seconds value.
39081 .cindex "log" "message id"
39082 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
39084 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
39085 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
39086 (submission mode) without one.
39087 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
39089 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39090 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39091 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39092 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39093 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39094 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
39095 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
39096 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
39097 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39099 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
39100 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
39101 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
39102 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
39103 containing => tags) following the IP address.
39104 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
39105 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
39106 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
39107 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
39108 local port is a random ephemeral port.
39110 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
39111 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
39112 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
39113 immediately after the time and date.
39115 .cindex log pipelining
39116 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
39117 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
39118 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
39119 The field is a single "L".
39121 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
39122 the field has a minus appended.
39124 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
39125 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
39126 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
39127 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
39128 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
39131 .cindex "log" "queue run"
39132 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
39133 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
39135 .cindex "log" "queue time"
39136 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
39137 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
39139 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39140 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
39142 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
39143 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
39144 example, &`QT=3m45s`&.
39146 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
39147 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
39148 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
39149 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39150 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
39152 .cindex "log" "recipients"
39153 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
39154 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
39155 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
39156 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
39158 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
39161 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
39162 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
39163 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
39164 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
39166 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
39167 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
39168 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
39169 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
39170 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
39172 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
39173 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
39174 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
39175 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
39178 .cindex "log" "return path"
39179 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
39180 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
39181 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
39182 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
39184 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
39185 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
39186 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
39187 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
39188 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
39190 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
39191 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
39192 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
39193 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
39196 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
39197 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
39200 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
39201 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
39202 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
39203 queue run because it another process is already delivering it or because
39205 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
39206 .cindex "&""message is frozen""&"
39207 The message that is written is either &"spool file is locked"& or
39208 &"message is frozen"&.
39210 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
39211 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
39212 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
39213 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
39214 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
39215 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
39218 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
39219 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
39220 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
39221 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
39222 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
39223 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
39224 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
39225 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
39226 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
39227 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
39229 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
39230 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
39231 reset if the daemon is restarted.
39232 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
39233 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
39234 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
39235 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
39236 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
39238 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
39239 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
39240 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
39241 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
39242 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
39243 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
39245 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
39246 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
39247 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
39248 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
39249 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
39250 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
39251 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
39252 already have their own log lines.
39254 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
39255 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
39256 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
39257 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
39258 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
39259 the same logging options.
39261 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
39262 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
39266 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
39267 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
39268 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
39269 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
39270 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
39272 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
39273 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
39274 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
39275 was accepted or used.
39277 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
39278 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
39279 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
39280 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
39281 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
39282 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
39283 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
39284 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
39286 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
39287 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
39288 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
39289 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
39290 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
39291 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
39292 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
39293 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
39294 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
39296 .cindex "log" "subject"
39297 .cindex "subject, logging"
39298 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
39299 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
39300 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
39301 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
39302 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
39304 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
39306 .cindex DANE logging
39307 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
39308 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
39310 using a CA trust anchor,
39311 &`CV=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
39312 and &`CV=no`& if not.
39314 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
39315 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
39316 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39317 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
39319 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
39320 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
39321 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39322 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
39323 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
39325 .cindex "log" "TLS resumption"
39326 .cindex "TLS" "logging session resumption"
39327 &%tls_resumption%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39328 connection and the TLS session resumed one used on a previous TCP connection,
39329 an asterisk is appended to the X= cipher field in the log line.
39331 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
39332 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
39333 .cindex SNI logging
39334 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
39335 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
39336 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
39338 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
39339 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
39340 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
39344 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
39345 .cindex "message" "log file for"
39346 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
39347 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
39348 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
39349 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
39350 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
39351 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
39352 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
39353 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
39354 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
39355 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
39356 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
39358 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
39359 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
39360 &%message_logs%& option false.
39366 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39367 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39369 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
39370 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
39371 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
39372 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
39373 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
39375 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
39376 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
39377 "list what Exim processes are doing"
39378 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
39379 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
39380 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
39381 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
39383 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
39384 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
39385 "extract statistics from the log"
39386 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
39387 "check address acceptance from given IP"
39388 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
39389 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
39390 .irow &<<SECTdumpdb>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
39391 .irow &<<SECTtidydb>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
39392 .irow &<<SECTfixdb>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
39393 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
39396 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
39397 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
39398 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
39403 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
39404 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
39405 .cindex "process, querying"
39407 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
39408 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
39409 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
39410 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
39411 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
39412 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
39413 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
39414 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
39416 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
39417 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
39418 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
39421 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
39422 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
39423 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
39424 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
39425 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
39427 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
39428 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD`& "the command for running &'ps'&"
39429 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG`& "the argument for &'ps'&"
39430 .irow &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG`& "the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output"
39431 .irow &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG`& "the argument for the &'kill'& command"
39433 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
39435 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
39436 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
39437 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
39438 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
39439 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
39440 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
39442 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
39443 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
39447 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
39448 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
39449 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
39450 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
39454 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
39458 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
39459 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
39462 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
39463 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
39464 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
39468 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
39469 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
39470 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
39472 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
39473 Match against the size field.
39475 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
39476 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
39478 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
39479 Match messages that are older than the given time.
39482 Match only frozen messages.
39485 Match only non-frozen messages.
39487 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
39488 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
39491 The following options control the format of the output:
39495 Display only the count of matching messages.
39498 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
39502 Display message ids only.
39505 Brief format &-- one line per message.
39508 Display messages in reverse order.
39511 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
39514 The following options give alternates for configuration:
39517 .vitem &*-C*&&~<&'config&~file'&>
39518 is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
39519 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
39521 .vitem &*-E*&&~<&'path'&>
39522 can be used to specify a path for the exim binary,
39523 overriding the built-in one.
39526 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
39527 At least one selection option, or either the &*-c*& or &*-h*& option, must be given.
39531 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
39532 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
39533 .cindex "queue" "summary"
39534 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
39535 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
39536 running a command such as
39538 exim -bp | exiqsumm
39540 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
39541 it, as in the following example:
39543 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
39545 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
39546 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
39547 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
39548 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
39550 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
39551 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
39552 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
39553 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
39554 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
39555 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
39558 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
39559 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
39560 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
39561 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
39562 level"& addresses).
39567 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
39569 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
39570 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
39571 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
39572 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
39573 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
39574 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
39575 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
39576 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
39577 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
39578 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
39580 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
39582 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
39584 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
39585 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
39586 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
39588 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
39589 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
39590 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
39591 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
39592 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
39594 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
39595 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
39596 regular expression.
39598 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
39599 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
39601 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
39602 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
39606 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
39607 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
39608 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
39609 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
39610 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
39611 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
39614 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
39615 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
39616 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
39617 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
39618 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
39621 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
39622 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
39623 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
39624 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
39625 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
39626 the &%--help%& option.
39629 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
39630 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
39631 .cindex "cycling logs"
39632 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
39633 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
39634 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
39635 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
39636 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
39637 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
39638 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
39640 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
39641 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
39643 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
39644 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
39645 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
39649 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
39650 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
39651 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
39652 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
39653 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
39654 logs are handled similarly.
39656 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
39657 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
39658 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
39659 any existing log files.
39661 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
39662 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
39663 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
39664 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
39665 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
39667 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
39669 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
39670 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
39674 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
39675 .cindex "statistics"
39676 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
39677 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
39678 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
39679 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
39680 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
39682 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
39683 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
39684 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
39685 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
39686 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
39688 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
39690 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
39691 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
39692 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
39693 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
39694 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
39695 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
39696 also produced per user.
39698 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
39699 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
39700 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
39701 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
39702 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
39704 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
39705 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
39706 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
39707 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
39708 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
39709 an entirely separate message.
39711 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
39712 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
39713 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
39714 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
39715 least one address that failed.
39717 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
39718 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
39719 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
39720 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
39721 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
39722 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
39723 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
39725 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
39726 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
39727 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
39729 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
39730 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
39731 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
39733 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
39736 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
39737 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
39738 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
39739 .cindex "checking access"
39740 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
39741 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
39742 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
39743 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
39744 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
39745 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
39747 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
39748 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
39750 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
39752 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
39753 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
39754 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
39755 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
39758 550 Relay not permitted
39760 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
39761 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
39762 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
39763 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
39766 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
39767 -f himself@there.example
39769 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
39770 mandatory arguments.
39772 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
39773 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
39774 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
39778 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
39779 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
39780 .cindex "building DBM files"
39781 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
39782 .cindex "lower casing"
39783 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
39784 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
39785 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
39786 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
39787 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
39788 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
39790 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
39791 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
39792 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
39793 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
39796 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
39797 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
39798 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
39802 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
39803 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
39804 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
39805 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
39807 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
39809 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
39810 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
39812 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
39813 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
39814 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
39815 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
39816 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
39817 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
39819 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
39820 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
39821 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
39822 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
39823 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
39824 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
39825 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
39831 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
39832 .cindex "retry" "times"
39833 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
39834 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
39835 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
39836 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
39837 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
39838 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
39839 output. For example:
39841 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
39842 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
39843 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
39844 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
39845 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
39846 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
39847 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
39848 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
39849 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
39850 past final cutoff time
39852 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
39853 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
39854 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
39855 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
39856 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
39857 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
39860 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
39861 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
39862 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
39863 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
39864 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
39865 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
39869 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
39870 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
39871 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
39872 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
39873 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
39874 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
39875 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
39878 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
39880 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
39883 &'callout'&: the callout cache
39885 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
39887 &'tls'&: TLS session resumption data
39889 &'misc'&: other hints data
39892 The &'misc'& database is used for
39895 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
39897 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
39898 &(smtp)& transport)
39900 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
39906 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECTdumpdb"
39907 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
39908 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
39909 &'exim_dumpdb'& program,
39910 taking as arguments the spool and database names.
39911 An option &'-z'& may be given to request times in UTC;
39912 otherwise times are in the local timezone.
39913 An option &'-k'& may be given to dump only the record keys.
39914 For example, to dump the retry database:
39916 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
39918 For the retry database
39919 two lines of output are produced for each entry:
39921 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
39922 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
39924 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
39925 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
39926 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
39927 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
39928 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
39929 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
39930 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
39931 and a textual description of the error.
39933 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
39934 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
39935 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
39938 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
39939 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
39940 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
39941 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
39942 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
39943 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
39948 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECTtidydb"
39949 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
39950 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
39951 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
39952 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
39953 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
39954 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
39955 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
39956 updated sufficiently often.
39958 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
39959 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
39960 the retry database:
39962 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
39964 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
39965 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
39966 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
39967 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
39968 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
39969 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
39970 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
39971 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
39972 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
39973 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
39974 whenever it removes information from the database.
39976 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
39977 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
39978 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
39979 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
39980 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
39982 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
39983 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
39984 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
39985 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
39986 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
39987 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
39988 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
39991 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
39992 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
39997 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECTfixdb"
39998 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
39999 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
40000 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
40001 getting round problems in a live system. Its interface
40002 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
40003 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
40006 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
40007 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
40008 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
40009 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
40010 by new data, for example:
40014 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
40015 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
40016 used as optional separators.
40018 Both displayed and input times are in the local timezone by default.
40019 If an option &'-z'& is used on the command line, displayed times
40025 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
40026 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
40027 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
40028 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
40029 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
40030 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
40031 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
40032 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
40033 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
40034 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
40035 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
40036 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
40037 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
40041 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
40044 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
40047 .vitem &%-interval%&
40048 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
40049 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
40051 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
40052 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
40055 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
40058 Suppress verification output.
40060 .vitem &%-retries%&
40061 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
40062 the lock (default 10).
40064 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
40065 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
40066 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
40067 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
40070 .vitem &%-timeout%&
40071 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
40072 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
40073 default), a non-blocking call is used.
40076 Generate verbose output.
40079 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
40080 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
40081 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
40082 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
40083 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
40084 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
40085 more than 30 minutes old.
40087 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
40088 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
40089 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
40090 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
40091 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
40092 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
40094 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
40095 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
40096 suppresses all output except error messages.
40100 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
40102 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
40104 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
40105 <&'some commands'&>
40108 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
40109 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
40112 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
40113 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
40115 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
40116 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
40120 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40121 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40123 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
40124 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
40125 .cindex "X-windows"
40126 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
40127 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
40128 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
40129 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
40130 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
40131 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
40132 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
40133 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
40137 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
40138 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
40139 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
40140 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
40141 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
40142 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
40143 parameters are for.
40145 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
40146 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
40147 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
40149 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
40151 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
40152 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
40153 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
40154 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
40155 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
40157 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
40158 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
40160 Eximon*background: gray94
40162 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
40163 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
40164 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
40165 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
40166 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
40167 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
40168 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
40171 Eximon*highlight: gray
40174 .cindex "admin user"
40175 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
40176 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
40178 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
40179 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
40180 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
40181 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
40182 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
40184 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
40185 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
40186 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
40187 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
40188 different parts of the display.
40193 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
40194 .cindex "stripchart"
40195 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
40196 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
40197 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
40198 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
40199 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
40200 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
40201 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
40202 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
40203 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
40205 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
40206 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
40207 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
40208 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
40210 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
40211 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
40212 to a single partition.
40214 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
40215 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
40216 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
40217 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
40218 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
40219 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
40220 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
40225 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
40226 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
40227 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
40228 .cindex "window size"
40229 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
40230 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
40231 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
40232 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
40233 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
40234 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
40236 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
40237 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
40238 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
40239 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
40241 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
40242 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
40243 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
40244 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
40245 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
40246 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40248 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
40249 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
40250 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40254 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
40255 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
40256 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
40257 the main log is maintained.
40258 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
40259 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
40260 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
40261 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
40262 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
40264 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
40265 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
40266 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
40267 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
40268 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
40269 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
40270 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
40271 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
40272 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
40273 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
40274 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40276 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
40277 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
40278 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
40279 It cannot go further back up the log.
40281 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
40282 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
40283 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
40284 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
40285 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
40286 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
40288 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
40289 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
40290 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
40291 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
40292 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
40293 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
40295 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
40296 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
40297 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
40298 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
40299 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
40300 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
40301 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
40302 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
40303 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
40308 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
40309 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
40310 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
40311 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
40312 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
40313 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
40314 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
40315 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
40316 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
40317 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
40319 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
40320 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
40321 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
40322 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
40323 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
40324 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
40325 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
40327 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
40328 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
40329 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
40330 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
40331 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
40332 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
40333 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
40335 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
40336 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
40337 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
40338 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
40340 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
40341 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
40342 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
40343 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
40344 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
40345 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
40346 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
40349 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
40350 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
40352 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
40353 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
40354 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
40355 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
40356 display is updated.
40360 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
40361 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
40362 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
40363 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
40364 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
40367 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
40368 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
40369 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
40370 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
40371 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
40373 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
40375 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
40379 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
40380 in a new text window.
40382 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
40383 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
40384 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
40386 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
40387 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
40388 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
40389 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
40391 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
40392 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
40393 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
40394 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
40395 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
40397 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
40398 that the message be frozen.
40400 .cindex "thawing messages"
40401 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
40402 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
40403 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
40404 that the message be thawed.
40406 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
40407 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
40408 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
40409 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
40411 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
40412 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
40415 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
40416 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
40417 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
40418 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
40419 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
40420 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
40421 which case no action is taken.
40423 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
40424 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
40425 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
40426 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
40427 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
40428 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
40429 case no action is taken.
40431 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
40432 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
40434 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
40435 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
40436 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
40437 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
40438 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
40439 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
40440 the address is qualified with that domain.
40443 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
40444 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
40445 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
40446 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
40447 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
40448 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
40449 if no output is generated.
40451 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
40452 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
40453 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
40454 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
40456 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
40457 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
40458 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
40465 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40466 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40468 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
40469 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
40470 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
40471 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
40473 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
40474 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
40475 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
40476 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
40477 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
40478 its security as compared with other MTAs.
40480 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
40481 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
40482 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
40483 as soon as possible.
40486 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
40487 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
40488 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
40489 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
40490 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
40491 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
40494 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
40495 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
40496 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
40497 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
40498 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
40499 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
40501 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
40502 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
40503 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
40504 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
40507 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
40508 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
40509 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
40510 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
40511 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
40512 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
40513 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
40514 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
40515 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
40519 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
40520 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
40521 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
40522 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
40523 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
40524 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
40525 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
40527 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
40530 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
40531 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
40532 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
40533 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
40534 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
40539 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
40541 .cindex "root privilege"
40542 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
40543 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
40544 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
40545 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
40546 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
40547 is required for two things:
40550 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
40551 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
40554 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
40555 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
40559 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
40560 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
40561 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
40562 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
40563 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
40564 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
40565 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
40566 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
40568 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
40569 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
40570 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
40572 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
40573 uid and gid in the following cases:
40578 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
40579 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
40580 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
40581 the calling process.
40582 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
40583 option may not be used at all.
40584 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
40585 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
40586 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
40591 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
40592 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
40595 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
40596 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
40597 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
40598 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
40599 testing address verification
40602 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
40605 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
40606 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
40609 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
40612 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
40613 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
40614 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
40615 will be used during message reception.
40617 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
40618 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
40620 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
40621 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
40622 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
40623 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
40624 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
40625 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
40626 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
40627 generating bounce and warning messages.
40629 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
40630 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
40631 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
40632 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
40634 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
40635 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
40641 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
40642 .cindex "privilege, running without"
40643 .cindex "unprivileged running"
40644 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
40645 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
40646 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
40647 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
40648 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
40649 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
40650 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
40654 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
40655 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
40656 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
40657 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
40659 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
40660 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
40661 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
40662 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
40663 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
40665 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
40666 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
40667 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
40670 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
40671 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
40672 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
40674 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
40675 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
40676 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
40677 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
40678 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
40679 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
40680 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
40681 address this problem at this time.
40683 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
40684 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
40685 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
40686 be used in the most straightforward way.
40688 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
40689 number of restrictions on what you can do:
40692 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
40693 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
40694 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
40695 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
40696 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
40698 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
40699 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
40701 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
40702 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
40703 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
40704 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
40706 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
40707 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
40710 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
40711 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
40712 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
40714 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
40715 owned by the Exim user.
40717 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
40718 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
40719 mailboxes need to be created manually.
40724 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
40725 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
40726 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
40727 gives more security at essentially no cost.
40729 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
40730 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
40735 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
40736 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
40737 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
40741 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
40742 .cindex "security" "local commands"
40743 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
40744 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
40745 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
40746 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
40747 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
40750 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
40751 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
40752 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
40753 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
40754 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
40756 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
40757 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
40758 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
40759 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
40760 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
40761 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
40762 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
40764 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
40765 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
40766 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
40768 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
40769 taint checking might apply to their usage.
40771 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
40772 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
40773 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
40775 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
40776 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
40777 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
40779 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
40780 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
40781 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
40782 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
40788 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
40789 .cindex "security" "data sources"
40790 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
40791 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
40792 .cindex "PCRE2" "security"
40793 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
40794 are some issues to be aware of:
40797 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
40799 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
40801 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
40802 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE2. Be aware of what
40803 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
40804 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
40805 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
40806 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
40809 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
40810 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
40811 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
40813 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
40814 expected to yield one result.
40820 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
40821 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
40822 .cindex "IP source routing"
40823 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
40824 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
40825 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
40826 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
40830 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
40831 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
40832 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
40837 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
40838 .cindex "trusted users"
40839 .cindex "admin user"
40840 .cindex "privileged user"
40841 .cindex "user" "trusted"
40842 .cindex "user" "admin"
40843 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
40844 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
40845 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
40846 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
40847 permit a remote host to be specified.
40850 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
40851 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
40852 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
40853 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
40854 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
40855 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
40857 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
40858 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
40859 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
40860 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
40861 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
40863 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
40864 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
40865 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
40866 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
40867 includes the contents of files on the spool.
40871 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
40872 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
40873 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
40874 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
40875 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
40876 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
40878 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
40879 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
40880 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
40881 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
40882 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
40883 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
40886 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
40887 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
40888 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
40889 This affects most of the checking options,
40890 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
40893 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
40894 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
40895 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
40896 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
40897 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
40898 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
40902 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
40903 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
40904 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
40905 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
40906 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
40911 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
40912 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
40913 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
40914 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
40919 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
40920 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
40921 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
40922 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
40923 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
40927 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
40928 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
40929 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
40933 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
40934 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
40935 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
40936 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
40937 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
40938 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
40939 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
40941 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
40942 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
40947 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
40948 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
40949 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
40950 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
40954 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
40955 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
40956 enough to hold the result.
40957 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
40962 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40963 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40965 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
40966 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
40967 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
40968 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
40969 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
40970 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
40971 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
40972 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
40973 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
40974 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
40975 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
40976 themselves are recoverable.
40978 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
40979 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
40980 and should not be used as such.
40982 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
40983 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
40984 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
40987 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
40988 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
40989 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
40990 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
40991 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
40993 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
40994 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
40995 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
40996 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
40998 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
41000 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
41003 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
41005 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
41006 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
41007 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
41008 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
41009 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
41010 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
41011 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
41012 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
41015 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
41016 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
41017 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
41018 relics of crashes and can be removed.
41020 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
41021 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
41022 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
41023 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
41024 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
41025 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
41026 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
41027 normally the Exim user.
41029 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
41030 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
41031 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
41032 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
41033 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
41034 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
41035 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
41036 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
41038 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
41039 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
41040 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
41041 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
41043 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen.
41044 These contain variables, can appear in any
41045 order, and are omitted when not relevant.
41047 If there is a second hyphen after the first,
41048 the corresponding data is tainted.
41049 If there is a value in parentheses, the data is quoted for a lookup.
41051 The following word specifies a variable,
41052 and the remainder of the item depends on the variable.
41055 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41056 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
41057 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
41058 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
41059 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
41060 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
41061 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
41062 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
41063 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
41066 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41067 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
41068 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
41069 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
41070 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
41071 character. It may contain internal newlines.
41073 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41074 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
41075 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
41076 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
41077 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
41078 character. It may contain internal newlines.
41080 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
41081 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
41082 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
41084 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
41085 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
41086 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
41087 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
41088 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
41090 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
41091 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
41092 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
41093 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
41094 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
41096 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
41097 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
41098 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
41100 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
41101 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
41102 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
41104 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
41105 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
41106 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
41108 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
41109 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
41110 present if the number is greater than zero.
41112 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
41113 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
41114 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
41116 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
41117 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
41118 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
41120 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
41121 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
41124 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
41125 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
41126 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
41129 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
41130 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
41131 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
41132 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
41134 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
41135 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
41136 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
41138 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
41139 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
41140 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
41141 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
41142 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
41143 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
41145 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
41146 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
41147 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
41148 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
41149 supplied by the remote host, if any.
41151 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
41152 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
41153 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
41154 generated messages.
41157 The message is from a local sender.
41159 .vitem &%-localerror%&
41160 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
41162 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
41163 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
41164 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
41165 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
41167 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
41168 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
41169 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
41172 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
41173 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
41176 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
41177 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
41178 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
41180 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
41181 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
41182 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
41184 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
41185 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
41186 of &$spam_score_int$&.
41188 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
41189 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
41190 rather than Unix-format.
41191 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
41192 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
41194 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
41195 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
41196 certificate was verified by the server.
41198 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
41199 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
41200 name of the cipher suite that was used.
41202 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
41203 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
41204 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
41208 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
41209 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
41210 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
41211 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
41212 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
41213 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
41214 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
41215 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
41216 addresses are complete.
41218 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
41219 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
41220 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
41221 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
41222 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
41223 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
41225 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
41226 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
41227 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41229 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
41230 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
41231 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
41232 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
41236 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41237 darcy@austen.fict.example
41239 alice@wonderland.fict.example
41241 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
41242 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
41243 line is of the following form:
41245 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
41246 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
41248 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
41249 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
41250 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
41251 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
41252 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
41253 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
41254 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
41255 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
41258 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
41259 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
41260 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
41261 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
41262 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
41266 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
41267 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
41268 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
41269 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
41270 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
41271 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
41272 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
41273 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
41274 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
41275 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
41278 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
41279 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
41280 typical set of headers:
41282 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
41283 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
41284 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
41285 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
41286 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
41287 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
41288 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
41289 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41290 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
41291 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41292 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
41294 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
41295 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
41296 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
41297 .ecindex IIDforspo1
41298 .ecindex IIDforspo2
41299 .ecindex IIDforspo3
41301 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
41302 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
41303 an ASCII newline character.
41304 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
41305 can have an alternate format.
41306 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
41307 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
41308 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
41309 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
41310 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
41311 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
41313 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41314 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41316 .chapter "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
41317 "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC Support"
41319 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
41322 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
41323 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
41324 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
41325 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
41327 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
41328 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
41329 any original DKIM signature.
41331 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
41332 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41334 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
41336 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
41337 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
41338 (including transport filters)
41339 except cutthrough delivery.
41341 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
41342 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
41343 different signature contexts.
41346 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
41347 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
41348 Exim's standard controls.
41350 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
41351 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
41353 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
41354 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
41355 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
41356 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
41358 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
41359 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
41360 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
41361 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
41364 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
41365 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
41366 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
41367 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
41371 .subsection "Signing outgoing messages" SECDKIMSIGN
41372 .cindex DKIM signing
41374 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
41375 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
41377 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41379 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
41380 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
41383 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
41384 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
41385 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
41386 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
41387 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
41389 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
41390 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
41392 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
41393 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
41394 After expansion, this can be a list.
41395 Each element in turn,
41397 .vindex "&$dkim_domain$&"
41398 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
41399 while expanding the remaining signing options.
41400 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
41401 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
41403 .option dkim_selector smtp "string list&!!" unset
41404 This sets the key selector string.
41405 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
41406 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
41407 .vindex "&$dkim_selector$&"
41408 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
41409 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
41410 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
41411 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
41413 To do, for example, dual-signing with RSA and EC keys
41414 this could be be used:
41416 dkim_selector = ec_sel : rsa_sel
41417 dkim_private_key = KEYS_DIR/$dkim_selector
41420 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
41421 This sets the private key to use.
41422 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
41423 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
41424 The result can either
41426 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
41428 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
41429 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
41431 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
41434 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
41435 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
41439 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
41441 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
41442 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
41444 The result file from the first command should be retained, and
41445 this option set to use it.
41446 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
41447 for the DNS TXT record.
41448 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
41452 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
41453 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
41456 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41458 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
41459 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
41462 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
41463 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
41464 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
41465 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
41466 for some transition period.
41467 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
41470 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
41472 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
41473 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
41476 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
41478 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
41479 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
41482 Exim also supports an alternate format
41483 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
41484 of the standard, but not adopted.
41485 A future release will probably drop that support.
41487 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
41488 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
41490 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
41492 &`sha256`& &-- the default
41494 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
41497 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41499 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41502 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
41503 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
41504 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
41505 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
41506 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
41507 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
41509 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
41510 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
41511 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
41512 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
41513 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
41515 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
41516 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
41517 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
41518 either &"1"& or &"true"&, Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
41519 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
41522 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
41523 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
41524 list of header names.
41525 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
41526 in the message signature.
41527 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
41528 whether or not each header is present in the message.
41529 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
41530 &"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS"&
41531 and an oversigning variant is in &"_DKIM_OVERSIGN_HEADERS"&.
41533 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
41534 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
41535 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
41537 A name can be prefixed with either an &"="& or a &"+"& character.
41538 If an &"="& prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
41540 If a &"+"& prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
41541 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
41542 name will be appended.
41544 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
41545 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
41546 If not set, no such information will be included.
41547 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
41549 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
41550 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
41552 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
41555 .subsection "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" SECDKIMVFY
41556 .cindex DKIM verification
41558 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
41559 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
41560 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
41561 Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
41562 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
41563 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
41564 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
41566 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
41567 Performing verification sets up information used by the
41568 &%authresults%& expansion item.
41570 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
41571 of this section can be ignored.
41573 The results of verification are made available to the
41574 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
41575 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
41576 By default, the ACL is called once for each
41577 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
41578 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
41579 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
41580 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
41582 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
41583 a large number of expansion variables
41584 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
41585 runtime of the ACL.
41587 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
41588 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
41589 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
41590 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
41592 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
41593 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
41594 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
41595 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
41596 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
41597 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
41600 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
41602 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
41603 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
41604 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
41606 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
41608 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
41609 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
41610 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
41612 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
41615 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
41616 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
41618 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
41619 (such as the From: header)
41620 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
41621 and for the domain part if identities.
41622 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
41624 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
41625 for each matching signature.
41628 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
41629 available (from most to least important):
41633 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
41634 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
41635 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
41636 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
41638 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
41639 Within the DKIM ACL,
41640 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
41642 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
41643 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
41645 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
41646 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
41648 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
41649 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
41651 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
41654 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
41655 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
41656 hash-method or key-size:
41658 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
41659 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
41660 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
41661 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
41662 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
41663 set dkim_verify_status = fail
41664 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
41667 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
41668 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
41669 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
41670 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
41672 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
41673 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
41674 "fail" or "invalid". One of
41676 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
41677 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
41679 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
41680 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
41682 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
41683 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
41684 means that the message body was modified in transit.
41686 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
41687 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
41688 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
41689 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
41692 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
41694 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
41695 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
41696 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
41697 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
41699 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
41700 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
41701 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
41702 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
41704 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
41705 The key record selector string.
41707 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
41708 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
41709 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
41710 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
41711 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
41714 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41716 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41718 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
41719 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
41722 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
41723 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
41724 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
41725 processing of such signatures.
41727 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
41728 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
41730 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
41731 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
41733 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
41734 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
41735 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
41736 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
41737 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
41738 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
41740 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
41741 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
41742 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
41743 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
41744 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
41745 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
41746 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
41747 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
41749 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
41750 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
41751 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
41753 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
41754 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
41755 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
41756 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
41757 integer size comparisons against this value.
41758 Note that Exim does not check this value.
41760 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
41761 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
41763 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
41764 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
41766 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
41767 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
41769 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
41770 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
41773 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
41774 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
41777 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
41778 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
41780 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
41781 Number of bits in the key.
41782 Valid only once the key is loaded, which is at the time the header signature
41783 is verified, which is after the body hash is.
41785 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41787 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
41788 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
41791 This is enforced by the default setting for the &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%&
41796 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
41799 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
41800 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
41801 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
41802 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
41803 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
41806 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
41807 warn sender_domains = gmail.com
41808 dkim_signers = gmail.com
41810 log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
41813 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
41814 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
41816 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
41817 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
41818 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
41819 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
41822 deny sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
41823 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
41824 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
41825 message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
41828 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
41829 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
41830 for more information of what they mean.
41836 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
41837 .cindex SPF verification
41839 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
41840 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
41841 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
41842 the &url(http://openspf.org).
41843 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
41844 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
41845 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
41848 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
41849 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
41851 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
41852 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
41853 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
41854 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
41855 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
41857 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
41858 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
41859 Performing verification sets up information used by the
41860 &%authresults%& expansion item.
41863 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
41864 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
41865 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
41866 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
41867 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
41871 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
41874 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
41875 domain in the envelope-from address.
41877 .vitem &%softfail%&
41878 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
41882 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
41885 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
41886 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
41887 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
41889 .vitem &%permerror%&
41890 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
41891 You may deny messages when this occurs.
41893 .vitem &%temperror%&
41894 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
41895 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
41898 There was an error during processing of the SPF lookup
41901 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
41902 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
41903 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
41904 short-circuit fashion.
41909 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
41910 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
41911 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
41912 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why;\
41913 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
41914 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
41915 ip=$sender_host_address
41918 Note: The above mentioned URL may not be as helpful as expected. You are
41919 encouraged to replace the link with a link to a site with more
41922 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
41925 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
41927 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
41928 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
41929 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
41930 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
41931 it for logging purposes.
41933 .vitem &$spf_received$&
41934 .vindex &$spf_received$&
41935 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header (name and
41936 content) that can be added to the message. Please note that
41937 according to the SPF draft, this header must be added at the
41938 top of the header list, i.e. with
41940 add_header = :at_start:$spf_received
41942 See section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>& for further details.
41944 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
41945 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
41947 .vitem &$spf_result$&
41948 .vindex &$spf_result$&
41949 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
41950 currently one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror,
41951 temperror, or &"(invalid)"&.
41953 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
41954 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
41955 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
41956 and required in order to obtain a result.
41958 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
41959 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
41960 .vindex &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&
41961 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
41962 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
41963 The string is generated by the SPF library from the template configured in the main config
41964 option &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&.
41968 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
41969 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
41970 .cindex SPF "best guess"
41971 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
41972 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
41973 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
41975 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
41976 for a description of what it means.
41977 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
41979 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
41980 of the spf one. For example:
41983 deny spf_guess = fail
41984 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
41987 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
41988 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
41989 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
41992 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
41993 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
41995 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
41996 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
41997 &%spf_guess%& option.
41998 For example, the following:
42001 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
42004 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
42007 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
42009 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
42010 address as the key and an IP address
42015 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
42018 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
42019 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
42025 .subsection "SRS (Sender Rewriting Scheme)" SECTSRS
42026 .cindex SRS "sender rewriting scheme"
42028 SRS can be used to modify sender addresses when forwarding so that
42029 SPF verification does not object to them.
42030 It operates by encoding the original envelope sender in a new
42031 sender local part and using a domain run by the forwarding site
42032 as the new domain for the sender. Any DSN message should be returned
42033 to this new sender at the forwarding site, which can extract the
42034 original sender from the coded local part and forward the DSN to
42037 This is a way of avoiding the breakage that SPF does to forwarding.
42038 The constructed local-part will be longer than the original,
42039 leading to possible problems with very long addresses.
42040 The changing of the sender address also hinders the tracing of mail
42043 Exim can be built to include native SRS support. To do this
42044 SUPPORT_SRS=yes must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&.
42045 If this has been done, the macros _HAVE_SRS and _HAVE_NATIVE_SRS
42047 The support is limited to SRS0-encoding; SRS1 is not supported.
42049 .cindex SRS excoding
42050 To encode an address use this expansion item:
42052 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
42053 .cindex "&%srs_encode%& expansion item"
42054 .cindex SRS "expansion item"
42055 The first argument should be a secret known and used by all systems
42056 handling the recipient domain for the original message.
42057 There is no need to periodically change this key; a timestamp is also
42059 The second argument should be given as the envelope sender address before this
42060 encoding operation.
42061 If this value is empty the the expansion result will be empty.
42062 The third argument should be the recipient domain of the message when
42063 it arrived at this system.
42066 .cindex SRS decoding
42067 To decode an address use this expansion condition:
42069 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
42070 The first argument should be the recipient local prt as is was received.
42071 The second argument is the site secret.
42073 If the messages is not for an SRS-encoded recipient the condition will
42074 return false. If it is, the condition will return true and the variable
42075 &$srs_recipient$& will be set to the decoded (original) value.
42081 SRS_SECRET = <pick something unique for your site for this. Use on all MXs.>
42087 # if outbound, and forwarding has been done, use an alternate transport
42088 domains = ! +my_domains
42089 transport = ${if eq {$local_part@$domain} \
42090 {$original_local_part@$original_domain} \
42091 {remote_smtp} {remote_forwarded_smtp}}
42096 domains = +my_domains
42097 # detect inbound bounces which are SRS'd, and decode them
42098 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {SRS_SECRET}}
42099 data = $srs_recipient
42101 inbound_srs_failure:
42104 domains = +my_domains
42105 # detect inbound bounces which look SRS'd but are invalid
42106 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {}}
42108 data = :fail: Invalid SRS recipient address
42110 #... further routers here
42113 # transport; should look like the non-forward outbound
42114 # one, plus the max_rcpt and return_path options
42115 remote_forwarded_smtp:
42117 # modify the envelope from, for mails that we forward
42119 return_path = ${srs_encode {SRS_SECRET} {$return_path} {$original_domain}}
42126 .section DMARC SECDMARC
42127 .cindex DMARC verification
42129 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
42130 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
42131 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
42132 should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
42133 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
42135 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
42136 the libopendmarc library is used.
42138 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
42139 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
42140 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
42141 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
42142 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
42143 This description assumes
42144 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
42145 are in /usr/local/lib.
42147 .subsection Configuration SSECDMARCCONFIG
42148 .cindex DMARC configuration
42150 There are three main-configuration options:
42151 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
42153 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
42154 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
42155 defines the location of a text file of valid
42156 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
42157 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
42158 the most current version can be downloaded
42159 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
42160 See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
42161 The default for the option is unset.
42162 If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
42165 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
42166 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
42167 defines the location of a file to log results
42168 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
42169 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
42170 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
42171 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
42172 directory of this file is writable by the user
42174 The default is unset.
42176 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
42177 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
42178 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
42179 forensic report detailing alignment failures
42180 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
42181 and you have configured Exim to send them.
42182 If set, this is expanded and used for the
42183 From: header line; the address is extracted
42184 from it and used for the envelope from.
42185 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
42186 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
42189 .subsection Controls SSECDMARCCONTROLS
42190 .cindex DMARC controls
42192 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
42193 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
42194 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
42195 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
42196 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
42197 DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
42199 control = dmarc_disable_verify
42201 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
42202 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
42203 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
42204 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
42205 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
42206 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
42207 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
42208 exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
42209 configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
42210 construction might be inadequate.
42212 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
42214 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
42215 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
42216 your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
42219 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
42222 .subsection ACL SSECDMARCACL
42223 .cindex DMARC "ACL condition"
42225 DMARC checks can be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
42226 &"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
42227 call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
42228 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
42229 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
42230 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
42231 occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
42233 The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
42234 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
42235 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
42236 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
42237 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
42238 .irow &'accept'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email"
42239 .irow &'reject'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email"
42240 .irow &'quarantine'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection"
42241 .irow &'none'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral"
42242 .irow &'norecord'& "No policy section in the DMARC record for this RFC5322.From field"
42243 .irow &'nofrom'& "Unable to determine the domain of the sender"
42244 .irow &'temperror'& "Library error or dns error"
42245 .irow &'off'& "The DMARC check was disabled for this email"
42247 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
42248 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
42249 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
42250 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
42251 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
42252 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
42255 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
42256 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
42257 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
42259 Performing the check sets up information used by the
42260 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42262 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
42263 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
42264 expansion variables are available:
42267 .vitem &$dmarc_status$&
42268 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
42269 .cindex DMARC result
42270 A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
42271 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
42272 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
42273 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
42274 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
42276 .vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
42277 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
42278 Slightly longer, human readable status.
42280 .vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
42281 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
42282 The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
42284 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
42285 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
42286 The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
42287 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
42288 is any error, including no DMARC record.
42291 .subsection Logging SSECDMARCLOGGING
42292 .cindex DMARC logging
42294 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
42295 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
42296 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
42297 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
42298 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
42299 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
42300 processing or failure delivery issues).
42302 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
42303 tools, you need to:
42305 Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
42307 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
42308 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
42311 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
42313 Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
42315 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
42316 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
42319 .subsection Example SSECDMARCEXAMPLE
42320 .cindex DMARC example
42325 warn domains = +local_domains
42326 hosts = +local_hosts
42327 control = dmarc_disable_verify
42329 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
42330 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
42332 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
42333 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
42336 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
42338 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
42340 warn dmarc_status = !accept
42342 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
42344 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
42346 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
42347 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
42349 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
42350 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
42351 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
42353 deny dmarc_status = reject
42355 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
42357 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
42364 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42365 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42367 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
42369 .cindex "proxy support"
42370 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
42372 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
42373 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
42376 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
42377 .cindex proxy inbound
42378 .cindex proxy "server side"
42379 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
42380 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
42382 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
42383 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
42384 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
42387 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
42388 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
42390 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
42391 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
42392 to distribute load.
42393 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
42394 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
42395 There is no logging if a host passes or
42396 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
42397 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
42399 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
42400 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
42401 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
42402 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
42403 automatically determines which version is in use.
42405 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
42406 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
42407 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
42408 Exim and the proxy server. The Proxy Protocol header must be received
42409 within &%proxy_protocol_timeout%&, which defaults to 3s.
42411 The following expansion variables are usable
42412 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
42414 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
42415 .irow $proxy_external_address "IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy"
42416 .irow $proxy_external_port "Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy"
42417 .irow $proxy_local_address "IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy"
42418 .irow $proxy_local_port "Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy"
42419 .irow $proxy_session "boolean: SMTP connection via proxy"
42421 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
42422 there was a protocol error.
42423 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
42424 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
42426 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
42427 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
42428 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
42429 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
42430 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
42431 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
42432 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
42433 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
42434 A possible solution is:
42436 # Set max number of connections per host
42438 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
42439 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
42441 defer ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
42442 message = Too many connections from this IP right now
42447 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
42448 .cindex proxy outbound
42449 .cindex proxy "client side"
42450 .cindex proxy SOCKS
42451 .cindex SOCKS proxy
42452 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
42453 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
42454 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
42457 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
42458 on an smtp transport.
42459 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
42460 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
42461 Each proxy specifier is a list
42462 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
42463 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
42465 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
42466 The list of options is in the following table:
42467 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
42468 .irow &'auth'& "authentication method"
42469 .irow &'name'& "authentication username"
42470 .irow &'pass'& "authentication password"
42471 .irow &'port'& "tcp port"
42472 .irow &'tmo'& "connection timeout"
42473 .irow &'pri'& "priority"
42474 .irow &'weight'& "selection bias"
42477 More details on each of these options follows:
42480 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
42481 .cindex proxy authentication
42482 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
42483 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
42484 for access to the proxy.
42485 Default is &"none"&.
42487 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
42490 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
42493 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
42496 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
42499 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
42500 higher values being tried first.
42501 The default priority is 1.
42503 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
42504 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
42505 weighted by this value.
42506 The default value for selection bias is 1.
42509 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
42510 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
42511 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
42513 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
42514 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
42515 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
42516 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
42518 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42519 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42521 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
42522 "Internationalisation""
42523 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
42526 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
42528 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
42529 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
42530 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
42532 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
42533 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
42534 requirement, upon libidn2.
42536 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
42537 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
42538 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
42539 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
42540 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
42541 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
42542 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
42544 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
42545 international handling for the message is enabled and
42546 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
42548 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
42549 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
42550 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
42551 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
42553 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
42554 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
42555 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
42556 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
42558 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
42559 components expanded to a-label form,
42560 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
42563 .cindex log protocol
42564 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
42565 .cindex i18n logging
42566 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
42567 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
42569 The following expansion operators can be used:
42571 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
42572 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
42573 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
42574 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
42577 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
42578 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
42580 may use the following modifier:
42582 control = utf8_downconvert
42583 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
42585 This sets a flag requiring that envelope addresses are converted to
42586 a-label form before smtp delivery.
42587 This is usually for use in a Message Submission Agent context,
42588 but could be used for any message.
42590 If a value is appended it may be:
42591 .itable none 0 0 2 5* right 95* left
42592 .irow &`1`& "mandatory downconversion"
42593 .irow &`0`& "no downconversion"
42594 .irow &`-1`& "if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host"
42596 If no value is given, 1 is used.
42598 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
42599 is initially set to -1.
42601 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
42602 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
42603 or an empty string.
42604 If non-empty it overrides value previously set
42605 (due to mua_wrapper or by an ACL control).
42608 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
42609 Configurations supporting these should inspect
42610 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
42612 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
42613 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
42614 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
42616 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
42617 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
42621 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
42622 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
42623 the following expansion operator can be used:
42625 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
42628 The string is converted from the charset specified by
42629 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
42630 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
42632 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
42633 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
42634 (which has to be a single character)
42635 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
42636 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
42638 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
42639 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
42641 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
42642 by many other IMAP servers.
42646 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
42647 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
42648 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
42651 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
42652 must be representable in UTF-16.
42655 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42656 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42658 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
42662 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
42663 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
42664 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
42665 processing actions.
42667 Most installations will never need to use Events.
42668 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
42669 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
42671 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
42672 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
42673 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
42675 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
42676 An example might look like:
42677 .cindex logging custom
42679 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
42680 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
42681 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
42682 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
42683 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
42684 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
42685 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
42686 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
42687 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
42691 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
42692 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
42693 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
42695 The current list of events is:
42696 .itable all 0 0 4 25* left 10* center 15* center 50* left
42697 .row auth:fail after both "per driver per authentication attempt"
42698 .row dane:fail after transport "per connection"
42699 .row msg:complete after main "per message"
42700 .row msg:defer after transport "per message per delivery try"
42701 .row msg:delivery after transport "per recipient"
42702 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport "per recipient per host"
42703 .row msg:rcpt:defer after transport "per recipient"
42704 .row msg:host:defer after transport "per host per delivery try; host errors"
42705 .row msg:fail:delivery after transport "per recipient"
42706 .row msg:fail:internal after main "per recipient"
42707 .row tcp:connect before transport "per connection"
42708 .row tcp:close after transport "per connection"
42709 .row tls:cert before both "per certificate in verification chain"
42710 .row tls:fail:connect after main "per connection"
42711 .row smtp:connect after transport "per connection"
42712 .row smtp:ehlo after transport "per connection"
42714 New event types may be added in future.
42716 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
42717 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
42718 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
42720 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
42721 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
42722 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
42724 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
42725 should define the event action.
42727 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
42728 with the event type:
42729 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
42730 .row auth:fail "smtp response"
42731 .row dane:fail "failure reason"
42732 .row msg:defer "error string"
42733 .row msg:delivery "smtp confirmation message"
42734 .row msg:fail:internal "failure reason"
42735 .row msg:fail:delivery "smtp error message"
42736 .row msg:host:defer "error string"
42737 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer "error string"
42738 .row msg:rcpt:defer "error string"
42739 .row tls:cert "verification chain depth"
42740 .row tls:fail:connect "error string"
42741 .row smtp:connect "smtp banner"
42742 .row smtp:ehlo "smtp ehlo response"
42745 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
42747 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&,
42748 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
42749 the course of its processing:
42751 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
42754 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
42755 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
42757 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
42758 a useful way of writing to the main log.
42760 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
42761 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
42762 following will be forced:
42763 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
42764 .row auth:fail "log information to write"
42765 .row tcp:connect "do not connect"
42766 .row tls:cert "refuse verification"
42767 .row smtp:connect "close connection"
42769 All other message types ignore the result string, and
42770 no other use is made of it.
42772 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
42773 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
42776 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
42777 chain element received on the connection.
42778 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
42781 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42782 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42784 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
42785 "Adding drivers or lookups"
42786 .cindex "adding drivers"
42787 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
42788 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
42789 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
42790 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
42793 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
42794 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
42796 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
42798 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
42800 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
42801 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
42802 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
42804 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
42806 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
42809 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
42810 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
42812 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
42813 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
42814 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
42815 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
42816 simple form that most lookups have.
42818 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
42819 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
42820 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
42822 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
42823 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
42825 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
42828 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
42829 as for other drivers and lookups.
42832 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
42833 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
42834 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
42835 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
42836 searched using a binary chop procedure.
42838 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
42839 the interface that is expected.
42844 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42845 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42847 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42848 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
42849 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
42850 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
42852 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42857 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
42858 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
42862 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
42863 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
42864 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
42867 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42868 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////